Pioneer DVR DVR LX60D User Manual

HDD/DVD RECORDER  
DVR-LX60D  
®
®
Discover the benefits of registering your product online at  
http://www.pioneer.co.uk (or http://www.pioneer.eu)  
Operating Instructions  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Operating Environment  
CAUTION  
Operating environment temperature and humidity:  
+5 ºC to +35 ºC (+41 ºF to +95 ºF); less than 85 %RH  
(cooling vents not blocked)  
The STANDBY/ON switch on this unit will not  
completely shut off all power from the AC outlet.  
Since the power cord serves as the main disconnect  
device for the unit, you will need to unplug it from  
the AC outlet to shut down all power. Therefore,  
make sure the unit has been installed so that the  
power cord can be easily unplugged from the AC  
outlet in case of an accident. To avoid fire hazard,  
the power cord should also be unplugged from the  
AC outlet when left unused for a long period of time  
Do not install this unit in a poorly ventilated area, or in  
locations exposed to high humidity or direct sunlight (or  
strong artificial light)  
D3-4-2-1-7c_A_En  
VENTILATION CAUTION  
When installing this unit, make sure to leave space  
around the unit for ventilation to improve heat  
radiation (at least 10 cm at top, 10 cm at rear, and  
10 cm at each side).  
(for example, when on vacation).  
D3-4-2-2-2a_A_En  
WARNING  
Slots and openings in the cabinet are provided for  
ventilation to ensure reliable operation of the  
product, and to protect it from overheating. To  
prevent fire hazard, the openings should never be  
blocked or covered with items (such as newspapers,  
table-cloths, curtains) or by operating the  
This product is for general household purposes. Any  
failure due to use for other than household purposes  
(such as long-term use for business purposes in a  
restaurant or use in a car or ship) and which  
requires repair will be charged for even during the  
warranty period.  
K041_En  
equipment on thick carpet or a bed.  
D3-4-2-1-7b_A_En  
POWER-CORD CAUTION  
If the AC plug of this unit does not match the AC  
outlet you want to use, the plug must be removed  
and appropriate one fitted. Replacement and  
mounting of an AC plug on the power supply cord of  
this unit should be performed only by qualified  
service personnel. If connected to an AC outlet, the  
cut-off plug can cause severe electrical shock. Make  
sure it is properly disposed of after removal.  
Handle the power cord by the plug. Do not pull out the  
plug by tugging the cord and never touch the power  
cord when your hands are wet as this could cause a  
short circuit or electric shock. Do not place the unit, a  
piece of furniture, etc., on the power cord, or pinch the  
cord. Never make a knot in the cord or tie it with other  
cords. The power cords should be routed such that they  
are not likely to be stepped on. A damaged power cord  
can cause a fire or give you an electrical shock. Check  
the power cord once in a while. When you find it  
The equipment should be disconnected by removing  
the mains plug from the wall socket when left  
unused for a long period of time (for example, when  
damaged, ask your nearest PIONEER authorized  
service center or your dealer for a replacement. S002_En  
on vacation).  
D3-4-2-2-1a_A_En  
Replacement and mounting of an AC plug on the power supply cord of this unit should be performed only by qualified  
service personnel.  
IMPORTANT: THE MOULDED PLUG  
This appliance is supplied with a moulded three pin mains plug for your safety and convenience. A 5 amp fuse is fitted in this plug. Should the  
fuse need to be replaced, please ensure that the replacement fuse has a rating of 5 amps and that it is approved by ASTA or BSI to BS1362.  
Check for the ASTA mark  
or the BSI mark  
on the body of the fuse.  
If the plug contains a removable fuse cover, you must ensure that it is refitted when the fuse is replaced. If you lose the fuse cover the plug  
must not be used until a replacement cover is obtained. A replacement fuse cover can be obtained from your local dealer.  
If the fitted moulded plug is unsuitable for your socket outlet, then the fuse shall be removed and the plug cut off and disposed of  
safely. There is a danger of severe electrical shock if the cut off plug is inserted into any 13 amp socket.  
If a new plug is to be fitted, please observe the wiring code as shown below. If in any doubt, please consult a qualified electrician.  
IMPORTANT: The wires in this mains lead are coloured in accordance with the following code:  
Blue : Neutral Brown : Live  
As the colours of the wires in the mains lead of this appliance may not correspond with the coloured markings identifying the terminals in  
your plug, proceed as follows ;  
The wire which is coloured BLUE must be connected to the terminal which is marked with the  
letter N or coloured BLACK.  
The wire which is coloured BROWN must be connected to the terminal which is marked with the  
letter L or coloured RED.  
How to replace the fuse: Open the fuse compartment with a screwdriver and replace the fuse.  
D3-4-2-1-2-2_B_En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
01  
05 Using the GUIDE Plus+®  
Contents  
01 Before you start  
What’s in the box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6  
Putting the batteries in the remote  
control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6  
Using the remote control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6  
Disc/content format playback  
electronic programme guide  
The GUIDE Plus+® system . . . . . . . . . . 37  
Using the GUIDE Plus+® system . . . . . 37  
Areas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39  
GUIDE Plus+® FAQ and  
troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48  
06 Using the digital electronic  
programme guide  
The Digital EPG system . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51  
Using the Digital EPG. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52  
Setting timer programmes . . . . . . . . . . . 52  
Other useful EPG functions . . . . . . . . . . 57  
compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7  
About the internal hard disk drive . . . . . . 12  
Symbols used in this manual . . . . . . . . . 13  
02 Connections  
Rear panel connections. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14  
Front panel connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15  
Connecting a TV antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . 15  
Easy connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16  
Using other types of audio/  
video output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16  
Connecting to a cable box or satellite  
receiver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17  
Connecting an external  
07 Recording  
About DVD recording . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59  
About HDD recording. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60  
Recorded audio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60  
Restrictions on video recording . . . . . . . 61  
Using the built-in A.TV and  
D.TV tuners. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61  
Setting the picture quality/  
recording time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64  
Basic recording from the TV . . . . . . . . . . 64  
Pause Live TV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66  
About timer recordings . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68  
Timer recording FAQ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69  
Simultaneous recording and playback  
(Chase Play) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70  
Recording from an external  
component. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70  
Playing your recordings on other DVD  
players . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71  
Initializing recordable DVD discs . . . . . . 72  
DVD-RW Auto Initialize. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73  
decoder box (1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18  
Connecting an external  
decoder box (2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19  
Connecting to an AV amplifier/  
receiver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20  
Connecting using HDMI . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20  
Connecting other AV sources . . . . . . . . . 22  
Connecting a USB device . . . . . . . . . . . . 22  
Plugging in . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23  
03 Controls and displays  
Front panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24  
Common Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25  
Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26  
Remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27  
08 Playback  
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74  
Basic playback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74  
Using the Disc Navigator to browse the  
contents of a disc . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78  
Scanning discs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79  
Playing in slow motion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79  
Frame advance/frame reverse . . . . . . . . 80  
The Play Mode menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80  
Displaying and switching subtitles . . . . . 82  
04 Getting started  
Switching on and setting up . . . . . . . . . . 30  
For users receiving digital broadcast  
services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33  
Setting up the GUIDE Plus+®  
system. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33  
4
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Switching DVD and DivX  
14 The Disc Setup menu  
soundtracks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82  
Switching audio channels . . . . . . . . . . . . 83  
Switching camera angles . . . . . . . . . . . . 83  
Displaying disc information  
Basic settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121  
Initialize settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122  
Finalize settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122  
Optimize HDD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122  
Initialize HDD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123  
on-screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84  
09 Playing and recording from a DV  
camcorder  
Playing from a DV camcorder . . . . . . . . . 85  
Recording from a DV camcorder. . . . . . . 85  
About DV. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87  
15 The Video Adjust menu  
Setting the picture quality for TV and  
external inputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124  
Setting the picture quality for disc  
playback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125  
10 Editing  
Editing options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88  
The Disc Navigator screen. . . . . . . . . . . . 89  
16 The Initial Setup menu  
Using the Initial Setup menu . . . . . . . . 127  
Selecting other languages for  
language options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142  
Using Software Update  
(Digital tuner) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142  
11 Copying and backup  
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100  
One Touch Copy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100  
Using Copy Lists . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102  
Using disc backup. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106  
17 Additional information  
Setting up the remote to control  
your TV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143  
Minimum copying times. . . . . . . . . . . . 144  
Manual recording modes . . . . . . . . . . . 145  
Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146  
If the picture freezes and the front panel  
and remote control buttons stop  
12 Using the Jukebox  
Copying music to the HDD . . . . . . . . . . 108  
Copying files via USB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108  
Playing music from the Jukebox . . . . . . 111  
Editing Jukebox albums . . . . . . . . . . . . 112  
working . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150  
On-screen displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151  
Front-panel displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154  
Language code list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154  
Country/Area code list . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155  
Screen sizes and disc formats . . . . . . . 155  
Handling discs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156  
Cleaning the pickup lens . . . . . . . . . . . 156  
Condensation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156  
Hints on installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157  
Moving the recorder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157  
Resetting the recorder . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157  
Specifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158  
13 The PhotoViewer  
Locating JPEG picture files . . . . . . . . . . 113  
Changing the display style of the  
PhotoViewer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114  
Playing a slideshow. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114  
Reloading files from a disc or  
USB device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115  
Importing files to the HDD. . . . . . . . . . . 115  
Selecting multiple files or folders . . . . . 116  
Copying files to a DVD-R/-RW . . . . . . . . 116  
Copying selected files to a  
DVD-R/-RW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117  
Editing files on the HDD . . . . . . . . . . . . 118  
Printing files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120  
5
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Before you start  
01  
CBhaepfteor 1re you start  
• Remove batteries from equipment that  
isn’t going to be used for a month or  
more.  
What’s in the box  
Please confirm that the following  
accessories are in the box when you open it;  
• When disposing of used batteries,  
please comply with governmental  
regulations or environmental public  
instruction’s rules that apply in your  
country or area.  
• Remote control  
• AA/R6P dry cell batteries x 2  
• Audio/video cable (red/white/yellow)  
• G-LINK™ cable  
WARNING  
• RF antenna cable x 2  
• Power cable  
Do not use or store batteries in direct sunlight or  
other excessively hot place, such as inside a car or  
near a heater. This can cause batteries to leak,  
overheat, explode or catch fire. It can also reduce the  
• These operating instructions  
• Warranty card  
life or performance of batteries.  
D3-4-2-3-3_En  
Using the remote control  
Putting the batteries in the  
remote control  
Please keep in mind the following when  
using the remote control:  
• Make sure that there are no obstacles  
between the remote and the remote  
sensor on the unit.  
Insert two AA/R6P batteries into the  
battery compartment following the  
indications (,) inside the  
compartment.  
• Remote operation may become  
unreliable if strong sunlight or  
fluorescent light is shining on the unit’s  
remote sensor.  
• Remote controllers for different devices  
can interfere with each other. Avoid  
using remotes for other equipment  
located close to this unit.  
• Replace the batteries when you notice a  
fall off in the operating range of the  
remote.  
Important  
Incorrect use of batteries can result in  
hazards such as leakage and bursting.  
Please observe the following:  
• When the batteries run down or you  
change the batteries, the remote control  
mode is reset to Recorder 1. See Remote  
Control Mode on page 139.  
• Don’t mix new and old batteries  
together.  
• Use within the operating range in front of  
the remote control sensor on the front  
panel, as shown.  
• Don’t use different kinds of batteries  
together — although they may look  
similar, different batteries may have  
different voltages.  
• Make sure that the plus and minus ends  
of each battery match the indications in  
the battery compartment.  
7 m  
6
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Before you start  
01  
• You can control this recorder using the  
remote sensor of another Pioneer  
component via the CONTROL IN jack on  
the rear panel. See Rear panel  
connections on page 14 for more  
information.  
The following table shows older Pioneer DVD  
recorders’ limited compatibility with DVD-  
RW ver. 1.2 discs.  
Model  
Playable  
Recordable  
Yes*1,2,3  
DVR-7000  
No  
Yes*1  
DVR-3100/  
DVR-5100H  
No  
Disc/contentformatplayback  
compatibility  
*1 Discs should be finalized in this recorder before  
playing. Unfinalized VR mode and Video mode discs  
may not play.  
*2 Cannot read the CPRM information will show in  
the display when you load a disc. However, this will not  
affect playback.  
*3 Copy-once protected disc titles will not play.  
Compatible media  
• DVD-RW ver. 1.1 / 1x / 1x to 2x, ver. 1.2 /  
2x to 4x / 2x to 6x  
• DVD-R ver. 2.0 /1x / 1x to 4x /  
1x to 8x / 1x to 16x, ver. 2.1 / 1x to 8x / 1x  
to 16x  
Readable file system  
This recorder can play DVDs recorded under  
the following file systems : ISO 9660*, UDF  
1.02, UDF 1.50, UDF 2.00, UDF 2.01.  
* ISO 9660 Level 1 or 2 compliant. Romeo and  
Joliet file systems are both compatible with  
this recorder.  
• DVD+RW 1x to 2.4x / 1x to 4x / 3.3x to 8x  
• DVD+R 1x to 2.4x / 1x to 4x / 1x to 8x / 1x  
to 16x  
1
• DVD-RAM ver. 2.0 / 2x, ver. 2.1 / 2x / 2x to  
3x / 2x to 5x, ver. 2.2 / 2x / 2x to 3x / 2x to 5x  
• DVD-R DL ver. 3.0 / 2x to 4x / 2x to 8x  
• DVD+R DL 2.4x / 2.4x to 8x  
Note that older models of DVD recorders  
and DVD writers may reject DVD-RW ver. 1.2  
discs and/or corrupt the data on the disc. If  
you want to share DVD-RW discs between  
this recorder and an older recorder/writer,  
we recommend using ver. 1.1 discs.  
Note  
1 • Depending on the recording technique used, even files recorded in compatible file systems may not play  
correctly.  
• MP3/WMA files can be played back when recorded onto a DVD that contains no video files and uses the UDF  
1.02, UDF 1.50, UDF 2.01 or ISO 9660 file systems.  
7
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Before you start  
01  
HDD/DVD Recording and playback compatibility  
This recorder can play and record all widely-used DVD disc types, and additionally provides  
HDD functionality. The table below shows some specific compatibility differences between  
the different disc types.  
DVD  
+RW  
DVD-  
RAM  
HDD  
DVD-R  
DVD-RW  
DVD+R  
Marks used in this  
manual  
HDD  
DVD (VR)  
*1  
DVD (Video)  
DVD (VR)  
*1  
DVD (Video)  
DVD+R  
DVD+RW  
DVD-RAM  
*2  
*13, 16  
Logos  
*3  
*3  
*3  
*14  
Re-recordable/  
Erasable  
*4  
*4  
*4  
*4  
Editing of recorded  
programmes  
*12  
*12  
*12  
Recording of Copy-  
once protected  
material  
n/a  
*5  
*6  
*7  
*6  
*6, 15  
*8  
*9  
Playback in other  
players/recorders  
Chase play  
16:9 and 4:3  
programme  
recording  
*10, 11  
*11  
*11  
*11  
Bilingualbroadcast  
recording of both  
audio channels  
*13 Take the disc out of the cartridge before use. Only  
Panasonic and Maxell discs have been tested to work  
reliably with this recorder. Discs from other makers may  
become unusable when recorded or edited.  
*14 Erasing a title does not increase the available  
recording time, nor increase the number of recordable  
titles left.  
*15 Must be compatible with DVD+R playback.  
*16 Depending on the disc, it may have to be initialized  
before it can be recorded (page 122). In this case,  
initialization will take about an hour.  
Notes to table  
*1 Must be initialized for VR mode recording (page 122).  
*2 Must be initialized for Video mode recording  
(page 122).  
*3 Erasable, but free space does not increase.  
*4 Cannot erase sections, edit chapters or use playlist  
editing.  
*5 Must be compatible with DVD-R(VR) playback.  
*6 Finalize using this recorder (may not playback in  
some units) (page 71).  
*7 Must be compatible with DVD-RW(VR) playback.  
*8 Must be compatible with DVD+RW playback.  
*9 Must be compatible with DVD-RAM playback.  
*10 Only when HDD Recording Format is set to Video  
Mode Off (page 136).  
is a trademark of DVD Format/Logo  
Licensing Corporation.  
*11 Only when the recording mode is not set to LPCM.  
*12 CPRM-compatible discs only.  
8
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Before you start  
01  
The DVD side of a DualDisc plays in this  
product. DVD-Audio content will not play.  
Using DVD-R DL/DVD+R DL discs  
DVD-R DL (Dual-Layer) and DVD+R DL  
(Double-Layer) discs contain two recordable  
layers on a single side, giving about 1.8  
times the recording capacity of a  
conventional single-layer disc. This unit can  
record to both DVD-R DL and DVD+R DL  
discs.  
For more detailed information on the  
DualDisc specification, please refer to the  
disc manufacturer or disc retailer.  
Other disc compatibility  
In addition to DVD, this recorder is  
compatible with a wide range of disc types  
(media) and formats. Playable discs will  
generally feature one of the logos on the disc  
and/or disc packaging shown below. Note  
however that some disc types, such as  
recordable CD (and DVD), may be in an  
unplayable format — see below for further  
compatibility information.  
• If you intend to play DVD-R DL (Video  
mode) or DVD+R DL discs recorded on  
this unit on other DVD recorders/players,  
you must finalize them. (Note that some  
DVD recorders/players may not play  
even finalized DL discs.)  
• This logo indicates that the disc is a  
DVD-R DL or DVD+R DL disc:  
Audio CD  
CD-R  
CD-RW  
Video CD  
Super Video CD (Super VCD)  
Correct operation has been confirmed for  
DL discs:  
• DVD-R DL ver. 3.0/2x to 4x  
Mitsubishi Kagaku Media (Verbatim)  
CD-R/-RW compatibility  
This recorder cannot record CD-R or CD-RW  
discs.  
• DVD-R DL ver. 3.0/2x to 8x  
Mitsubishi Kagaku Media (Verbatim)  
That’s  
JVC  
• Readable formats: CD-Audio, Video CD/  
Super VCD, ISO 9660 CD-ROM*  
containing MP3, WMA, JPEG or DivX  
files  
* ISO 9660 Level 1 or 2 compliant. CD  
physical format: Mode1, Mode2 XA Form1.  
Romeo and Joliet file systems are both  
compatible with this recorder.  
• DVD+R DL 2.4x  
Mitsubishi Kagaku Media (Verbatim)  
RICOH  
• DVD+R DL 2.4x to 8x  
Mitsubishi Kagaku Media (Verbatim)  
RICOH  
• Multi-session playback: Yes (except CD-  
Audio and Video CD/Super VCD)  
About DualDisc playback  
A DualDisc is a new two -sided disc, one side  
of which contains DVD content –video,  
audio, etc. –while the other side contains  
non-DVD content such as digital audio  
material.  
• Unfinalized disc playback: CD-Audio  
only  
Compressed audio compatibility  
• Compatible media: DVD-ROM,  
DVD-R/-RW, DVD+R/+RW, DVD-RAM,  
CD-ROM, CD-R, CD-RW, USB  
The non-DVD, audio side of the disc is not  
compliant with the CD Audio specification  
and therefore may not play.  
• Compatible formats: MPEG-1 Audio  
Layer 3 (MP3), Windows Media Audio  
(WMA)  
It is possible that when loading or ejecting a  
DualDisc, the opposite side to that being  
played will be scratched. Scratched discs  
may not be playable.  
9
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Before you start  
01  
• Sampling rates: 32 kHz, 44.1 kHz or  
48 kHz  
DivX video compatibility  
• Bit-rates: Any (128 kbps or higher  
recommended)  
• Variable bit-rate (VBR) MP3 playback:  
Yes  
DivX is a compressed digital video format  
created by the DivX video codec from DivX,  
®
• VBR WMA playback: No  
Inc. This recorder can play DivX video files  
burned on CD-R/-RW/-ROM discs. Keeping  
the same terminology as DVD-Video,  
individual DivX video files are called “Titles”.  
When naming files/titles on a CD-R/-RW disc  
prior to burning, keep in mind that by default  
they will be played in alphabetical order.  
• WMA encoder compatibility: Windows  
Media Codec 8 (files encoded using  
Windows Media Codec 9 may be playable  
but some parts of the specification are not  
supported; specifically, Pro, Lossless,  
Voice and VBR)  
1
• DRM (Digital Rights Management) file  
®
• Official DivX Certified product.  
playback: No  
®
• Plays all versions of DivX video  
• File extensions: .mp3, .wma (these must  
be used for the recorder to recognize  
MP3 and WMA files – do not use for  
other file types)  
®
(including DivX 6) with standard  
®
playback of DivX media files.  
• File extensions: .avi and .divx (these  
must be used for the recorder to  
recognize DivX video files). Note that all  
files with the .avi extension are recognized  
as MPEG4, but not all of these are  
• File structure: Up to 99 folders/999 files  
(if these limits are exceeded, only files  
and folders up to these limits are  
playable)  
necessarily DivX video files and therefore  
may not be playable on this recorder.  
WMA (Windows Media™ Audio)  
compatibility  
This recorder can playback Windows Media  
Audio content.  
• File structure: Up to 99 folders or 999  
files.  
DivX, DivX Certified, and associated logos are  
trademarks of DivX, Inc. and are used under  
license.  
WMA is an acronym for Windows Media  
Audio and refers to an audio compression  
technology developed by Microsoft  
Corporation. WMA content can be encoded  
by using Windows Media Player for  
Windows XP, Windows Media Player 9 or  
Windows Media Player 10 series.  
Windows Media is a trademark of Microsoft  
Corporation.  
This product includes technology owned by  
Microsoft Corporation and cannot be used or  
distributed without a license from Microsoft  
Licensing, Inc.  
Note  
1 DRM (digital rights management) copy protection is a technology designed to prevent unauthorized copying by  
restricting playback, etc. of compressed audio files on devices other than the PC (or other recording equipment)  
used to record it. For detailed information, please see the instruction manuals or help files that came with your  
PC and/or software.  
10  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Before you start  
01  
®
• File extensions: .jpg, .jpeg, .jpe, .jif, .jfif  
(must be used for the recorder to  
recognize JPEG files – do not use for  
other file types)  
DivX VOD content  
DivX  
In order to play DivX VOD (video on demand)  
content on this recorder, you first need to  
register the recorder with your DivX VOD  
content provider. You do this by generating a  
DivX VOD registration code, which you  
submit to your provider.  
• File structure: The recorder can load up  
to 99 folders/999 files at one time (if there  
are more files/folders that this on the disc  
then more can be reloaded)  
PC-created disc compatibility  
Some DivX VOD content may only be  
playable a fixed number of times. When you  
load a disc containing this type of DivX VOD  
content, the remaining number of plays is  
shown on-screen and you then have the  
option of playing the disc (thereby using up  
one of the remaining plays), or stopping. If  
you load a disc that contains expired DivX  
VOD content (for example, content that has  
zero remaining plays), the message Rental  
Expired is displayed.  
Discs recorded using a personal computer  
may not be playable in this unit due to the  
setting of the application software used to  
create the disc. In these particular  
instances, check with the software publisher  
for more detailed information.  
Discs recorded in packet write mode (UDF  
format) are not compatible with this  
recorder.  
Check the DVD-R/-RW or CD-R/-RW  
software disc boxes for additional  
compatibility information.  
If your DivX VOD content allows an unlimited  
number of plays, then you may load the disc  
into your recorder and play the content as  
often as you like, and no message will be  
displayed.  
Dolby Digital  
Important  
• DivX VOD content is protected by a DRM  
system. This restricts playback of  
content to specific, registered devices.  
• If you load a disc that contains DivX VOD  
content not authorized for this recorder,  
the message Authorization Error is  
displayed and the content will not play.  
Manufactured under license from Dolby  
Laboratories. “Dolby” and the double-D  
symbol are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories.  
DTS  
• Resetting the recorder (as described in  
Resetting the recorder on page 157) will  
not cause you to lose your registration  
code.  
JPEG file compatibility  
• Compatible formats: Baseline JPEG and  
EXIF 2.2* still image files  
*File format used by digital still cameras  
“DTS” and “DTS Digital Out” are registered  
trademarks of DTS, Inc.  
• Sampling ratio: 4:4:4, 4:2:2, 4:2:0  
• Horizontal resolution: 160 to 5120 pixels  
• Vertical resolution: 120 to 3840 pixels  
• Progressive JPEG compatible: No  
11  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Before you start  
01  
• Do not move the recorder while it is on  
(this includes during EPG download  
when the display shows EPG).  
DVB  
The Digital Video Broadcasting Project, or  
DVB for short, is a set of open standards for  
digital broadcasting, covering terrestrial,  
cable and satellite broadcasts.  
• Install and use the recorder on a stable,  
level surface.  
Based around the MPEG-2 coding system,  
these open standards ensure that compliant  
systems are able to work together,  
independent of manufacturer.  
• Do not block the rear vent/cooling fan.  
• Do not use the recorder in excessively  
hot or humid places, or in places that  
may be subject to sudden changes in  
temperature. Sudden changes in  
temperature can cause condensation to  
form inside the recorder. This can be a  
cause of HDD failure.  
DVB is extremely flexible, being able to  
deliver virtually any kind of digital content to  
the home, including High Definition and  
Standard Definition TV, broadband  
multimedia content and interactive services.  
• While the recorder is switched on  
(including during EPG download when  
the display shows EPG), do not unplug  
from the wall socket or switch the  
electricity off from the breaker switch.  
DVB is a registered trademark of the DVB Project.  
• Do not move the recorder immediately  
after switching it off. If you need to move  
the recorder, please follow the steps  
below:  
About the internal hard disk  
drive  
1 After the message POWER OFF is  
shown on the front panel display, wait at  
least two minutes.  
The internal hard disk drive (HDD) is a fragile  
piece of equipment. When used without the  
proper care or in the wrong conditions, it is  
possible that recorded contents may be  
damaged or lost entirely, in some cases  
making even normal playback or recording  
impossible. Please understand that in the  
event of repair or replacement of the HDD or  
related components, all your HDD  
2 Unplug from the wall socket.  
3 Move the recorder.  
• If there’s a power failure while the  
recorder is on there is a chance that  
some data on the HDD will be lost.  
• The HDD is very delicate. If used over  
time in an improper manner or in an  
unsuitable environment, it is possible  
that the HDD will fail. Signs of problems  
include playback unexpectedly freezing  
and noticeable block noise (mosaic) in  
the picture. However, sometimes there  
will be no warning signs of HDD failure.  
If the HDD fails, no playback of recorded  
material will be possible. In this case it  
will be necessary to replace the HDD  
unit.  
recordings will be lost.  
Please use the recorder following the  
guidelines below to protect against possible  
HDD failure.  
The HDD should not be regarded as a place to  
store recordings permanently. We  
recommend that you back up your important  
recordings onto DVD discs in order to protect  
against accidental loss.  
Pioneer cannot under any circumstances  
accept responsibility for any direct or indirect  
loss arising from any inconvenience or loss of  
recorded material resulting from HDD failure.  
12  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Before you start  
01  
Optimizing HDD performance  
As you record and edit material on the HDD,  
the data on the disk becomes fragmented,  
eventually affecting the recorder’s  
performance. Before this happens, the  
recorder will warn you that it is time to  
optimize the HDD (which you can do from  
the Disc Setup menu; see Optimize HDD on  
page 122).  
Symbols used in this manual  
The following icons are provided to help you  
quickly identify which instructions you need  
for which kind of disc.  
HDD  
HDD  
DVD  
Any type of DVD disc  
(recordable or playback  
only), finalized or not.  
DVD-Video  
Commercially produced  
DVD, finalized Video mode  
DVD-R/-RW.  
DVD (Video)  
Video mode DVD-R/-RW  
(unfinalized)  
DVD (VR)  
VR mode DVD-R/-RW  
DVD+R  
DVD+R  
DVD+RW  
DVD+RW  
DVD-RAM  
DVD-RAM  
CD  
Audio CD  
Video CD  
Video CD  
Super VCD  
Super VCD  
WMA/MP3  
WMA or MP3 files  
DivX  
DivX files  
A L L  
All of the above  
13  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connections  
02  
CChoaptnern2 ections  
Rear panel connections  
1
2
3
4
5
AUDIO  
VIDEO  
R
L
ANTENNA  
DIGITAL  
AUDIO OUT  
IN  
S-VIDEO  
AC IN  
INPUT  
3
AV 2 (INPUT 1/DECODER)  
COAXIAL  
HDMI OUT  
ANTENNA(DIGITAL)  
IN  
G-LINK  
IN  
OUT  
OUTPUT  
OUT  
5 V 30 mA  
CONTROL  
Y
P
B
PR  
AV 1 (RGB) – TV  
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT  
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
1
ANTENNA IN (RF IN)/OUT  
8
AV1 (RGB)-TV AV connector  
Connect your TV antenna to the ANTENNA  
IN (RF IN) jack. The signal is passed through  
to the ANTENNA OUT jack for connection to  
your TV.  
Audio/video output SCART-type AV  
connector for connecting to a TV or other  
equipment with a SCART connector. The  
video output is switchable between video,  
S-video and RGB. See AV1 Out on page 131  
for how to set this up.  
2
INPUT 3  
Stereo analog audio, video and S-video  
inputs for connection to a VCR or other  
source component.  
9
G-LINK™  
Use to connect the supplied G-LINK™ cable  
to enable GUIDE Plus+® to control an  
external satellite receiver, etc.  
3
AV2 (INPUT 1/DECODER) AV  
connector  
Audio/video input/output SCART-type AV  
connector for connecting to a VCR, or other  
equipment with a SCART connector. The  
input accepts video, S-video and RGB. See  
AV2/L1 In on page 132 for how to set this up.  
10 CONTROL IN  
Use to control this recorder from the remote  
sensor of another Pioneer component with a  
CONTROL OUT terminal and bearing the  
Pioneer mark. Connect the CONTROL  
OUT of the other component to the  
CONTROL IN of this recorder using a mini-  
plug cord.  
4
HDMI OUT  
HDMI output for high quality digital audio  
and video.  
11 ANTENNA (DIGITAL) IN/OUT  
5
DIGITAL AUDIO OUT (COAXIAL)  
Connect your DTV antenna to the ANTENNA  
(DIGITAL) IN jack. The signal is passed  
through to the ANTENNA (DIGITAL) OUT  
jack for connection to your TV.  
Coaxial digital audio jack for connecting to  
an AV amplifier/receiver, Dolby Digital/DTS/  
MPEG decoder or other equipment with a  
digital input.  
12 AC IN – Power inlet  
6
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT  
A high-quality video output for connecting to  
a TV or monitor with a component video  
input.  
7
OUTPUT  
Stereo analog audio, video and S-video  
outputs for connection to a TV or AV  
amplifier/receiver.  
14  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connections  
02  
Antenna wall outlet  
or indoor antenna  
Front panel connections  
Antenna wall outlet  
On the front panel there is a flip-down cover  
that hides more connections.  
ANTENNA  
IN (RF IN)  
ANTENNA  
(DIGITAL) IN  
Left side:  
AUDIO  
VIDEO  
R
L
ANTENNA  
IN  
DIGITAL  
AUDIO OUT  
S-VIDEO  
DV IN  
USB  
AC IN  
INPUT  
3
AV (INPUT 1/DECODER)  
2
HDMI OUT  
COAXIAL  
ANTENNA(DIGITAL)  
IN  
G-LINK  
IN  
OUT  
5
OUTPUT  
OUT  
V
30 mA  
CONTROL  
Y
P
B
PR  
AV  
1
(RGB) – TV  
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT  
ANTENNA  
OUT  
13  
14  
15  
13 DV IN  
A DV input i.LINK connector, suitable for  
connecting a DV camcorder.  
To antenna input  
14 USB port (Type B)  
USB port for connecting a PictBridge-  
compatible printer or PC.  
TV  
Important  
15 USB port (Type A)  
USB port for connecting a digital camera,  
keyboard or other USB device.  
• If there is only one antenna outlet on  
your wall, use a divider.  
• Do not connect a component that can  
receive analog signals to the ANTENNA  
(DIGITAL) OUT.  
Right side:  
(
)
INPUT  
2
S-VIDEO  
VIDEO  
L
MONO  
R
AUDIO  
If your area is not yet served with terrestrial  
digital services, connect your antenna’s  
output to the ANTENNA IN (RF IN)  
16  
connector using one of the supplied RF  
antenna cables. Next, connect the recorder to  
your TV from the ANTENNA OUT connector.  
16 INPUT 2  
Audio/video input (stereo analog audio;  
composite and S-video), especially suitable  
for camcorders, game consoles, portable  
audio, etc.  
Antenna  
wall outlet  
ANTENNA  
IN (RF IN)  
AUDIO  
VIDEO  
R
L
ANTENNA  
IN  
DIGITAL  
AUDIO OUT  
Connecting a TV antenna  
S-VIDEO  
AC IN  
INPUT  
3
AV (INPUT 1/DECODER)  
2
HDMI OUT  
COAXIAL  
ANTENNA(DIGITAL)  
IN  
G-LINK  
IN  
OUT  
5
OUTPUT  
OUT  
V
30 mA  
CONTROL  
Y
P
B
PR  
AV  
1
(RGB) – TV  
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT  
This recorder has separate built-in TV tuners  
for terrestrial digital and terrestrial analog TV  
broadcasts.  
ANTENNA  
OUT  
If you are ready to receive digital broadcasts  
now, use one of the supplied RF antenna  
cables connect an antenna (either an  
antenna wall outlet or indoor antenna) to the  
ANTENNA (DIGITAL) IN connector. Next,  
connect the other supplied RF antenna  
cable to connect an antenna to the  
ANTENNA IN (RF IN) connector. Lastly,  
connect the recorder to your TV from the  
ANTENNA OUT connector.  
To antenna input  
TV  
We strongly recommend using an outdoor  
antenna for better broadcast picture quality.  
If, however, you want to use an indoor  
antenna, use one with a signal amplifier  
rated at 5 V, 30 mA and set Aerial Power to  
On in the Initial Setup menu (see page 129).  
15  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connections  
02  
1
Connect your TV antenna to the  
Easy connections  
recorder and TV.  
The setup described below is a basic setup  
that allows you to watch and record TV  
programmes, and play discs. Other types of  
connections are explained starting on the  
following page.  
See Connecting a TV antenna on page 15 for  
details.  
• If you want to incorporate a VCR in your  
setup, connect it before the recorder (i.e.,  
between the antenna wall outlet and the  
antenna input on the recorder).  
Important  
2
Use a SCART cable (not supplied) to  
• These connections use SCART cables  
(not supplied). If your TV (or VCR) does  
not have a SCART connection, and you  
want to use the supplied audio/video  
cable, see Using the supplied audio/video  
cable below.  
connect theAV1 (RGB)-TV AV connector on  
this recorder to the SCART AV connector on  
your TV.  
3
Use another SCART cable to connect the  
AV2 (INPUT 1/DECODER) AV connector to  
a SCART AV connector on your VCR.  
• The AV1 (RGB)-TV AV connector can  
output ordinary (composite), S-video or  
RGB video, plus stereo analog audio. The  
AV2 (INPUT 1/DECODER) connector  
accepts ordinary, S-video and RGB video  
input, as well as stereo analog audio.  
See AV1 Out on page 131 and AV2/L1 In  
on page 132 for how to setup these  
options.  
Tip  
• This recorder has a ‘through’ function  
which allows you to record a TV  
programme from the built-in TV tuner in  
this recorder while watching a video  
playing on your VCR (To use this feature  
when the recorder is in standby, Power  
Save must be set to Off — see Power  
Save on page 127).  
• Before making or changing any rear  
panel connections, make sure that all  
components are switched off and  
unplugged from the wall outlet.  
Using other types of audio/  
video output  
1
If you can’t use the SCART AV connector to  
connect your TV to this recorder, there are  
standard audio/video output jacks, as well as  
an S-video and component video output.  
Antenna/cable TV  
To antenna input  
wall outlet  
From antenna output  
VCR  
From SCART AV  
connector  
To recorder's  
antenna input  
Using the supplied audio/video  
cable  
3
AV2 (INPUT 1/  
DECODER)  
AUDIO  
VIDEO  
R
L
ANTENNA  
IN  
DIGITAL  
AUDIO OUT  
S-VIDEO  
AC IN  
INPUT  
3
AV (INPUT 1/DECODER)  
2
HDMI OUT  
COAXIAL  
ANTENNA(DIGITAL)  
IN  
G-LINK  
IN  
OUT  
5
OUTPUT  
To audio input  
OUT  
V
30 mA  
CONTROL  
Y
P
B
PR  
AV  
1
(RGB) – TV  
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT  
AV1 (RGB) - TV  
To video input  
TV  
2
AUDIO  
VIDEO  
OUTPUT  
OUTPUT  
V
R
DIGITAL  
2
1
AUDIO OUT  
IN  
S-VIDEO  
To SCART AV  
connector  
AC IN  
INPUT  
3
AV (INPUT 1/DECODER)  
2
HDMI OUT  
COAXIAL  
ANTENNA(DIGITAL)  
IN  
G-LINK  
IN  
OUT  
5
OUTPUT  
OUT  
V
30 mA  
CONTROL  
Y
P
B
PR  
AV  
1
(RGB) – TV  
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT  
16  
En  
TV  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connections  
02  
1
Connect the VIDEO OUTPUT jack to a  
2
Connect the AUDIO OUTPUT jacks to  
video input on your TV.  
Use the yellow jack of the supplied audio/  
the corresponding audio inputs on your  
TV.  
video cable for the video connection.  
You can use the supplied audio/video cable,  
leaving the yellow video plug disconnected.  
Make sure you match up the left and right  
outputs with their corresponding inputs for  
correct stereo sound.  
2
Connect the AUDIO OUTPUT jacks to  
the corresponding audio inputs on your TV.  
Use the red and white jacks of the supplied  
audio/video cable for the audio connection.  
Make sure you match up the left and right  
outputs with their corresponding inputs for  
correct stereo sound.  
Connecting to a cable box or  
satellite receiver  
Using the S-video or component  
video output  
If you have a cable box or satellite receiver  
with a built-in decoder, connect it to this  
recorder and your TV as shown on this  
To component video input  
1
page. If you are using a separate decoder  
box for your cable/satellite TV, set up  
following the instructions on the next page.  
To video input  
To audio input  
Using the setup on this page you can:  
2
TV  
• Record any channel by selecting it on  
the cable box, satellite receiver or digital  
terrestrial receiver.  
1
AUDIO  
OUTPUT  
S-VIDEO  
OUTPUT  
AUDIO  
VIDEO  
ANTENNA  
IN  
DIGITAL  
AUDIO OUT  
AC IN  
INPUT  
3
AV (INPUT 1/DECODER)  
2
• Change channels and set timer  
recordings on the external receiver using  
the GUIDE Plus+® system (via the  
G-LINK™ cable, and after setting up).  
HDMI OUT  
COAXIAL  
ANTENNA(DIGITAL)  
IN  
G-LINK  
IN  
OUT  
5
OUTPUT  
OUT  
V
30 mA  
CONTROL  
Y
P
B
PR  
AV  
1
(RGB) – TV  
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT  
COMPONENT  
VIDEO OUT  
1
Connect the S-video or component  
Important  
video output to a similar input on your  
TV.  
For an S-video connection, use an S-video  
cable (not supplied) to connect the S-VIDEO  
OUTPUT jack to an S-video input on your TV.  
• Do not connect this recorder to your TV  
‘through’ your VCR, satellite receiver or  
other component. Always connect each  
component directly to your TV or AV  
amplifier/receiver.  
For a component video connection, use a  
component video cable (not supplied) to  
connect the COMPONENT VIDEO OUT  
jacks to a component video input on your TV.  
• When using the GUIDE Plus+ system to  
make a timer recording from an external  
receiver, make sure that the external  
receiver is switched on.  
See also Component Video Out on page 131  
for how to set up the component video  
output for use with a progressive scan-  
compatible TV.  
Note  
1 The diagram shows SCART video connections, but you can alternatively use any of the other audio/video  
connections.  
17  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connections  
02  
Position the IR transmitter end of the  
G-LINK™ cable so that the IR receiver on  
your cable/satellite receiver will pick up the  
control signals (see diagram).  
1
Satellite dish/  
antenna/cable TV  
wall outlet  
To antenna input  
From antenna output  
O
Cable/Satellite  
receiver  
From SCART AV  
connector  
S-VIDEO  
INPUT  
3
AV 2 (INPUT 1/DECODER)  
G-LINK  
IN  
OUTPUT  
CONTROL  
AV  
1
(RGB) – TV  
3
To recorder's  
antenna input  
AV2 (INPUT 1/  
DECODER)  
4
G-LINK cable  
AUDIO  
VIDEO  
R
L
ANTENNA  
IN  
DIGITAL  
AUDIO OUT  
S-VIDEO  
AC IN  
INPUT  
3
AV (INPUT 1/DECODER)  
2
HDMI OUT  
COAXIAL  
ANTENNA(DIGITAL)  
IN  
See the manual that came with your cable/  
satellite receiver if you’re not sure where the  
IR receiver is on the front panel.  
G-LINK  
IN  
5
OUTPUT  
OUT  
V
30 mA  
CONTROL  
Y
P
B
PR  
AV  
1
(RGB) – TV  
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT  
AV1 (RGB) - TV  
Alternatively, experiment with the remote  
control, operating it from very close range  
until you find the place where the receiver  
responds.  
2
To SCART AV  
connector  
Tip  
• This recorder has a ‘through’ function  
which allows you to record a TV  
TV  
1
Connect RF antenna cables as shown.  
programme from the built-in TV tuner in  
this recorder while watching a video  
playing on your VCR (To use this feature  
when the recorder is in standby, Power  
Save must be set to Off — see Power  
Save on page 127).  
See Connecting a TV antenna on page 15 for  
more on RF antenna connections, including  
from this recorder to your TV.  
2
Use a SCART cable (not supplied) to  
connect the AV1 (RGB)-TV AV connector  
to a SCART AV connector on your TV.  
This enables you to watch discs.  
Connecting an external  
decoder box (1)  
3
Use another SCART cable to connect  
the AV2 (INPUT 1/DECODER) AV  
connector to a SCART AV connector on  
your cable box/satellite receiver.  
This enables you to record scrambled TV  
channels.  
If you have an external, dedicated decoder  
box for your satellite or cable TV system, use  
the setup described on this page. See above  
for how to connect the G-LINK™ cable.  
4
Plug the supplied G-LINK™ cable to  
the G-LINK™ jack.  
Important  
This enables you to control the tuner in the  
external receiver using the GUIDE Plus+®  
system.  
• Do not connect your decoder box directly  
to this recorder.  
• Information from the decoder (for  
example, relating to pay TV services), is  
only viewable when this recorder is off  
(in standby).  
• For timer recording to work properly on  
this recorder, the VCR/satellite receiver/  
cable box must also be switched on  
during recording.  
18  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connections  
02  
• It is not possible to watch one TV  
programme and record another using  
this setup.  
Connecting an external  
decoder box (2)  
If you only have a decoder, connect it to this  
recorder and your TV as shown on this  
page.  
SCART AV  
connection  
1
Antenna/cable TV  
wall outlet  
1
2
To antenna input  
Using the setup on this page you can:  
• Record scrambled channels received  
using the recorder’s built-in analog TV  
tuner.  
VCR/Satellite receiver  
/Cable box  
Decoder  
From SCART AV  
connector  
3
AV2 (INPUT 1/  
DECODER)  
Important  
AUDIO  
VIDEO  
R
L
ANTENNA  
DIGITAL  
AUDIO OUT  
IN  
• Do not connect this recorder ‘through’  
your VCR, satellite receiver or cable box.  
Always connect each component  
directly to your TV or AV amplifier/  
receiver.  
S-VIDEO  
AC IN  
INPUT  
3
AV (INPUT 1/DECODER)  
2
HDMI OUT  
COAXIAL  
ANTENNA(DIGITAL)  
IN  
G-LINK  
IN  
OUT  
5
OUTPUT  
OUT  
V
30 mA  
CONTROL  
Y
P
B
PR  
AV  
1
(RGB) – TV  
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT  
AV1 (RGB) - TV  
4
Decoder  
From SCART AV  
connector  
To SCART AV  
connector  
3
TV  
AV2 (INPUT 1/  
DECODER)  
1
Connect the cable from the antenna/  
AUDIO  
VIDEO  
R
L
ANTENNA  
IN  
DIGITAL  
AUDIO OUT  
S-VIDEO  
AC IN  
INPUT  
3
AV (INPUT 1/DECODER)  
2
COAXIAL  
HDMI OUT  
cable TV outlet to the antenna input on  
your VCR/satellite receiver/cable box.  
ANTENNA(DIGITAL)  
IN  
G-LINK  
IN  
OUT  
5
OUTPUT  
OUT  
V
30 mA  
CONTROL  
Y
PB  
PR  
AV  
1
(RGB) – TV  
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT  
AV1 (RGB) - TV  
2
Use a SCART cable (not supplied) to  
connect your decoder to your VCR/  
satellite receiver/cable box.  
2
See the manual for your decoder box for  
more detailed instructions.  
3
Use a SCART cable to connect your  
To SCART AV  
connector  
VCR/satellite receiver/cable box to the  
AV2 (INPUT 1/DECODER) AV connector  
on this recorder.  
TV  
4
Use a SCART cable to connect the AV1  
1
Connect your TV antenna to the  
(RGB)-TV AV connector to your TV.  
recorder and TV.  
See Connecting a TV antenna on page 15 for  
details.  
Note  
1 In order to use this setup, you will need to make the following settings from the Initial Setup menu:  
• Set the AV2/L1 In setting to Decoder from the Initial Setup menu (see AV2/L1 In on page 132).  
• From the Manual CH Setting screen, set the Decoder setting for the scrambled channels to On (see Manual  
CH Setting on page 130).  
19  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connections  
02  
2
Use a SCART cable (not supplied) to  
AUDIO  
VIDEO  
R
L
ANTENNA  
IN  
DIGITAL  
AUDIO OUT  
S-VIDEO  
AC IN  
INPUT  
3
connect the AV1 (RGB)-TV AV connector  
to a SCART AV connector on your TV.  
This enables you to watch discs.  
AV (INPUT 1/DECODER)  
2
COAXIAL  
HDMI OUT  
ANTENNA(DIGITAL)  
IN  
G-LINK  
IN  
OUT  
5
OUTPUT  
OUT  
V
30 mA  
CONTROL  
AV  
1
(RGB) – TV  
EO
AUDIO/VIDEO  
OUTPUT  
DIGITAL  
AUDIO OUT  
3
Use another SCART cable to connect  
the AV2 (INPUT 1/DECODER) AV  
connector to a SCART AV connector on  
your decoder box.  
3
2
To audio/video input  
To digital input  
This enables you to record scrambled TV  
channels.  
From video  
output  
AV amp/  
receiver  
4
Connecting to an AV  
amplifier/receiver  
To video input  
To enjoy multichannel surround sound you  
need to connect this recorder to an AV  
amplifier/receiver using the digital coaxial  
output.  
TV  
1
Connect your TV antenna to the  
recorder and TV.  
See Connecting a TV antenna on page 15 for  
In addition to a digital connection, we  
recommend also connecting using the  
stereo analog connection for compatibility  
with all discs and sources.  
details.  
This enables you to watch and record TV  
channels.  
You’ll probably also want to connect a video  
output to your AV amplifier/receiver. Use the  
ordinary video output (as shown here), or the  
S-video output.  
2
Connect the DIGITAL AUDIO OUT  
(COAXIAL) jack on this recorder to a  
coaxial digital input on your AV  
amplifier/receiver.  
Important  
This enables you to listen to multichannel  
• Noise may be output from your speakers  
if the recorder is not set up to work with  
your AV amplifier/receiver properly (see  
Audio Out on page 133).  
surround sound.  
3
Connect the analog AUDIO OUTPUT  
and VIDEO OUTPUT jacks on this recorder  
to an analog audio and video input on  
your AV amplifier/receiver.  
• When watching D.TV only linear PCM  
audio is output from the coaxial digital  
out jack.  
4
Connect the AV amplifier/receiver’s  
video output to a video input on your TV.  
• Do not connect this recorder to your TV  
‘through’ your VCR using A/V cables.  
Always connect it directly to your TV.  
Connecting using HDMI  
1
If you have an HDMI or DVI-equipped  
2
monitor or display , you can connect it to  
this recorder using an HDMI cable (not  
supplied).  
Note  
1 Depending on the component you have connected, using a DVI connection may result in unreliable signal  
transfers.  
2 The pixel resolution of this recorder’s HDMI video output is (according to TV format): NTSC (720 x 480i/p, 1280  
x 720p, 1920 x 1080i/p) and PAL (720 x 576i/p, 1280 x 720p, 1920 x 1080i/p). If your display is not compatible with  
these resolutions the picture may not be correctly reproduced.  
20  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connections  
02  
The HDMI connector outputs  
uncompressed digital video, as well as  
almost every kind of digital audio.  
HDMI adaptor cable. A DVI to HDCP  
connection, however, does not support  
audio. Consult your local audio dealer for  
more information.  
1
Use an HDMI cable to connect the  
• The HDMI connection is compatible with  
32 kHz, 44.1 kHz, 48 kHz, 96 kHz, 16 bit/  
20 bit/24 bit 2-channel linear PCM  
signals, as well as Dolby Digital, DTS and  
MPEG audio bitstream.  
HDMI OUT connector on this recorder to  
an HDMI connector on an HDMI-  
compatible display.  
• If your connected component is only  
compatible with Linear PCM, the signal  
is output as Linear PCM (DTS audio is  
not output).  
H
T
I
D
o
N
M
HD  
I
MI  
i
nput  
HDMI-compatible display  
• If you have connected to a Pioneer  
plasma display, please select the HDMI  
setup on the display (refer to the  
HDMI  
OUT  
supplied manual for more on this).  
AUDIO  
VIDEO  
R
L
ANTENNA  
IN  
ITAL  
O OUT  
S-VIDEO  
AC IN  
INPUT  
3
AV (INPUT 1/DECODER)  
2
I
HDMI OUT  
ANTENNA(DIGITAL)  
IN  
G-LINK  
IN  
OUT  
5
OUTPUT  
OUT  
V
30 mA  
CONTROL  
Y
PB  
PR  
AV  
1
(RGB)  
TV  
About HDMI  
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT  
HDMI (High-Definition Multimedia  
Interface) supports both video and audio on  
a single digital connection for use with DVD  
players and recorders, DTV, set-top boxes,  
and other AV devices. HDMI was developed  
to provide the technologies of High-  
bandwidth Digital Content Protection  
(HDCP) as well as Digital Visual Interface  
(DVI) in one specification. HDCP is used to  
protect digital content transmitted and  
received by DVI-compliant displays.  
• The arrow on the cable connector body  
should be face down for correct  
alignment with the connector on the  
recorder.  
When connected to an HDMI component or  
HDCP-compatible DVI component, the  
HDMI indicator lights.  
HDMI has the capability to support  
HDMI setup is generally automatic. There  
are however settings you can change if you  
need to. See HDMI Output (only available  
when an HDMI device is connected) on  
page 138 for more information. Note that the  
HDMI settings remain in effect until you  
change them, or connect a new HDMI  
component.  
standard, enhanced, or high-definition video  
plus standard to multi-channel surround-  
sound audio. HDMI features include  
uncompressed digital video, a bandwidth of  
up to five gigabits per second (Dual Link),  
one connector (instead of several cables and  
connectors), and communication between  
the AV source and AV devices such as DTVs.  
HDMI, the HDMI logo and High-Definition  
Multimedia Interface are trademarks or  
registered trademarks of HDMI licensing LLC.  
Important  
• An HDMI connection can only be made  
with DVI-equipped components  
compatible with both DVI and High-  
bandwidth Digital Content Protection  
(HDCP). If you choose to connect to a  
DVI connector, you will need a DVI to  
21  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connections  
02  
Connecting a DV camcorder  
Connecting other AV sources  
You can connect a DV camcorder or DVD  
recorder with DV output to the front panel  
DV IN jack.  
Connecting a VCR or analog  
camcorder  
HDD/DVD  
OPEN/CLOSE  
Important  
A.TV  
D.TV  
PLTV  
DivX  
COPY  
HDMI  
COMMON INTERFACE  
STANDBY/ON  
DV IN  
USB  
INPUT  
2
S-VIDEO  
VIDEO  
L(MONO)  
R
AUDIO  
REC  
ONE TOUCH  
COPY  
STOP REC  
• This jack is for connection to DV  
equipment only. It is not compatible with  
digital satellite receivers or D-VHS video  
decks.  
INPUT  
CH  
A.TV/D.TV  
SELECT  
AUDIO/VIDEO  
OUTPUT  
AUDIO/VIDEO  
INPUT  
(Rear panel)  
(Front panel)  
HDD/DVD  
OPEN/CLOSE  
A.TV  
D.TV  
PLTV  
DivX  
COPY  
HDMI  
COMMON INTERFACE  
STANDBY/ON  
DV IN  
USB  
INPUT  
2
S-VIDEO  
VIDEO  
L(MONO)  
R
AUDIO  
REC  
ONE TOUCH  
COPY  
STOP REC  
INPUT  
SELECT  
CH  
A.TV/D.TV  
1
2
DV  
IN  
Analog camcorder  
To audio/video input  
From audio/video output  
From DV output  
VCR  
DV camcorder  
1
Connect a set of audio and video  
Use a DV cable (not supplied) to  
connect the DV jack of your DV  
camcorder to the front panel DV IN  
jack of this recorder.  
inputs of your VCR or camcorder to a set  
of outputs on this recorder.  
This enables you to record from this recorder  
to your VCR or camcorder.  
• You can use standard video or S-video  
cables for the video connection.  
Connecting a USB device  
Using the USB ports on the front of the  
recorder you can connect USB devices such  
as digital cameras, printers, keyboards and  
PCs. Please also see the instructions that  
came with the device you want to connect  
before using.  
• Alternatively, you can use the AV2  
(INPUT 1/DECODER) SCART connector  
for audio/video input and output with  
just one SCART cable.  
2
Connect a set of audio and video  
outputs of your VCR or camcorder to a  
set of inputs on this recorder.  
This enables you to record tapes from your  
VCR or camcorder.  
H
D
D
/
D
V
D
OPEN/CLOSE  
A.TV  
D.TV  
PLTV  
DivX  
COPY  
HDMI  
COMMON INTERFACE  
STANDBY/ON  
D
V
I
N
USB  
INPUT  
2
S-VIDEO  
VIDEO  
L(MONO)  
R
AUDIO  
REC  
ONE TOUCH  
COPY  
STOP REC  
INPUT  
SELECT  
CH  
A.TV/D.TV  
USB  
(Type B)  
USB  
(Type A)  
• You can use standard video or S-video  
cables for the video connection.  
USB  
USB  
• The front panel connections make  
convenient connections for a camcorder  
input.  
Digital Camera  
PictBridge-compatible  
Printer  
• When connecting an external AV source  
that only supports monaural sound, only  
insert the left (white) audio jack to this  
device. Doing so will allow the same  
sound track to be recorded to both  
channels. You must connect to the  
INPUT 2 jack on the front panel.  
Keyboard  
PC  
22  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connections  
02  
• In the event of unreliable operation with  
the hub, we recommend plugging the  
device directly into the recorder’s USB  
port.  
Important  
• Some USB devices may not work with  
this recorder.  
• Operation may become unreliable if too  
many devices are connected to the hub.  
In this case, try unplugging some  
devices.  
• When connecting a PC to this unit, make  
sure the power is turned off on both the  
PC and this unit when you connect them  
via USB.  
• If the power delivered through a hub is  
insufficient for the devices connected,  
communication can become unreliable.  
In this case, disconnect one or more  
devices then perform a USB restart. (See  
Restart USB Device on page 140.)  
• We recommend connecting USB  
devices when this recorder is switched  
off (in standby).  
JPEG file storage devices  
• Digital still camera  
• Memory card reader (any type of  
memory card)  
Using a USB printer  
• Use a PictBridge-compatible printer.  
• USB memory  
The Mass Storage Class (MSC) device  
should be FAT-compatible. Note that if the  
device is partitioned, this recorder may not  
recognize it.  
Using a USB keyboard  
• Do not use a PS/2 keyboard connected  
using a PS/2-USB adapter.  
Using a PC  
The Picture Transfer Protocol (PTP) can be  
used to transfer up to a maximum of 4000  
files.  
• Note that you can connect a PC to this  
device via USB to copy WMA and MP3  
files. For more information, see Connect  
PC on page 109. To use Connect PC with  
this device, your PC must run either the  
Windows XP Home Edition (SP2) or  
Windows XP Professional (SP2)  
operating system and be able to run  
Windows Media Player 10. Even if your  
PC can run Windows Media Player 10,  
we cannot guarantee that it will function  
properly with this device. For more  
details see the ‘Help’ section of Windows  
Media Player 10.  
WMA/MP3 file storage devices  
• Memory card reader (any type of  
memory card)  
• USB memory  
• PC (Use Connect PC function)  
The Mass Storage Class (MSC) device  
should be FAT-compatible. Note that if the  
device is partitioned, this recorder may not  
recognize it.  
Note that although multi-slot card readers  
can be used, the recorder will only recognize  
the first card inserted. To read another card,  
remove all the cards and insert the card to be  
read again.  
Plugging in  
After checking all the connections, plug in  
the recorder.  
Using a USB hub  
• Use a hub compatible with USB 1.1 and/  
Use the supplied power cable to  
connect this recorder to a power outlet.  
or 2.0.  
• Use an independently powered hub (bus  
powered hubs may not work reliably).  
23  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Controls and displays  
03  
CChaoptnert3rols and displays  
Front panel  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
HDD/DVD  
COPY  
OPEN/CLOSE  
A.TV  
D.TV  
PLTV  
DivX  
HDMI  
COMMON INTERFACE  
STANDBY/ON  
DV IN  
USB  
INPUT  
2
S-VIDEO  
VIDEO  
L(MONO)  
R
AUDIO  
REC  
ONE TOUCH  
COPY  
STOP REC  
INPUT  
SELECT  
CH  
A.TV/D.TV  
8
9
10  
11  
9
12  
1
A.TV indicator  
Lights when analog TV is selected.  
4
HDD/DVD indicator  
Indicator lights blue when the hard disk  
(HDD) is selected; orange when the DVD  
drive is selected.  
D.TV indicator  
Lights when digital TV is selected.  
5
OPEN/CLOSE  
Press to open/close the disc tray.  
HDMI indicator  
PLTV indicator  
Lights during recording started using  
the Pause Live TV feature.  
6
Lights when this recorder is connected to  
HDMI (HDCP) compatible component.  
DivX indicator  
Lights during DivX playback.  
7
Front panel display and IR remote  
sensor  
COPY indicator  
Lights when copying is underway.  
See Display on page 26 for details.  
8
STANDBY/ON  
Press to switch the recorder on/into standby.  
Front panel inputs  
2
HDD/DVD  
Press to switch between HDD and DVD for  
recording and playback.  
9
See Front panel connections on page 15 for  
more information on these.  
3
Disc tray  
10 COMMON INTERFACE slot  
Slot for CA module and smart card used to  
decode scrambled D.TV channels. See  
Common Interface on page 25.  
24  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Controls and displays  
03  
11 ꢃ  
Common Interface  
Press to start or restart playback.  
To receive scrambled D.TV channels you will  
need a CA module and smart card provided  
by your service provider.  
Press to stop playback.  
STOP REC  
Press to stop recording.  
Different CA modules support different  
encryption systems. This recorder is  
designed to work with modules that support  
the DVB standard. Contact your service  
provider to obtain the right kind of CA  
module.  
ONE TOUCH COPY  
Press to start One Touch Copy of the  
currently playing title to DVD or the  
HDD.  
Note that neither CA modules nor smart  
cards are supplied or sold by Pioneer.  
CH +/–  
Use to change channels, skip chapters/  
tracks, etc.  
Inserting a CA module  
The Common Interface card slot is located  
on the front panel of the recorder.  
INPUT SELECT  
Press to change the input used for  
recording.  
Insert the CA module into the card  
A.TV/D.TV  
slot as far as it will go.  
Switches between analog TV antenna  
input and digital TV antenna input. The  
A.TV and D.TV indicators show which is  
selected.  
12 REC  
Press to start recording. Press repeatedly to  
set the recording time in 30 minute blocks.  
The Common Interface card slot accepts  
Type I and Type II PC Cards (PCMCIA cards).  
25  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Controls and displays  
Display  
03  
1
2
3
4
5
L
R
P
8
7
6
1
LP/SLP  
Lights during playback; blinks when  
Lights when the recording mode is set to  
playback is paused.  
LP (long play) or SLP (super-long play).  
2
EP/SEP  
Lights when copying.  
Lights when the recording mode is set to  
EP (extended play) or SEP (super-  
extended play).  
3
Lights during recording; blinks when  
recording is paused.  
MN  
Lights when the recording mode is set to  
MN (manual recording level) mode.  
4
(page 68)  
Lights when a timer recording has been  
set. (Indicator blinks if the timer has  
been set to DVD but there isn’t a  
recordable disc loaded, or the timer has  
been set to record to the HDD but the  
HDD is not recordable.)  
6
7
Character display  
R/RW  
Lights when a recordable DVD-R or DVD-RW  
disc is loaded.  
8
PL (page 89)  
Lights when a VR mode disc is loaded  
and the recorder is in Play List mode.  
NTSC  
Lights when the video output signal  
format is NTSC.  
2 3 (page 139)  
(page 132)  
Indicates which channels of a bilingual  
broadcast are recorded.  
Shows the remote control mode (if  
nothing is displayed, the remote control  
mode is 1).  
V
(page 131)  
Lights when the component video output  
is set to progressive scan.  
Lights when an unfinalized Video mode  
disc is loaded.  
VPS/PDC (page 68)  
Lights when receiving a VPS/PDC  
broadcast during a VPS/PDC-enabled  
timer recording.  
5
Recording quality indicators (page 64)  
XP  
Lights when the recording mode is set to  
XP (high quality).  
SP  
Lights when the recording mode is set to  
SP (standard play).  
26  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Controls and displays  
Remote control  
03  
ꢈ ꢉ (page 79)  
Press to start reverse or forward  
scanning. Press again to change the  
speed.  
STANDBY/ON  
HDD/DVD  
1
2
12  
ꢊ/ꢋ ꢌ/ꢍ (page 79)  
PREV  
PAUSE  
STOP  
NEXT  
While paused, press and hold to start  
slow-motion playback. Press repeatedly  
to change the playback speed.  
PLAY  
13  
14  
HELP  
REC  
INFO  
3
While paused, press to advance a single  
frame in either direction.  
TOP MENU  
HOME MENU  
DISC  
NAVIGATOR  
GUIDE  
4
5
15  
16  
CHANNEL  
+
CM BACK  
When GUIDE Plus+® is displayed, use  
to display the previous/next day.  
ENTER  
CHANNEL  
CM SKIP  
3
HELP  
A.TV/D.TV  
RETURN/EXIT  
Press for help on how to use the current GUI  
screen.  
6
7
17  
18  
4
DISC NAVIGATOR (page 78, 89)/  
PAUSE  
LIVE TV  
TIMER  
REC  
ONE TOUCH  
REC MODE  
COPY  
TOP MENU (page 75)  
8
9
19  
20  
21  
22  
AUDIO  
SUBTITLE  
ABC  
ANGLE INPUT SELECT  
Press to display the Disc Navigator screen,  
or the top menu if a DVD-Video or finalized  
DVD-R/-RW (Video) disc is loaded.  
DEF  
MNO  
WXYZ  
MENU  
GHI  
JKL  
DISPLAY  
10  
11  
5
ꢁ/ꢂ/ꢃ/ꢀ and ENTER (Smart Jog)  
Used to navigate all on-screen displays.  
Rotate the Smart Jog to move the cursor  
up or down. Press ENTER to select the  
currently highlighted option.  
PQRS  
TUV  
+
CLEAR CLEAR  
TV CONTROL  
TEXT  
23  
24  
INPUT SELECT CHANNEL VOLUME  
TV/DVD  
When using the Smart Jog, turn it lighty  
to avoid pressing down on the cursor  
keys.  
OPEN  
While watching D.TV press ENTER to  
display the Channel List screen.  
1
STANDBY/ON  
Press to switch the recorder on/into standby.  
Rotate the Smart Jog when playback is  
paused to do a frame-by-frame search  
back/forward.  
2
PLAY (page 74)  
Press to start playback.  
PAUSE  
Press to pause playback or recording.  
CM BACK (commercial back)  
Turn the Smart Jog counter-clockwise  
during playback to skip progressively  
backward through the video playing.  
STOP (page 74)  
Press to stop playback.  
PREV NEXT  
CM SKIP (commercial skip)  
Press to skip to the previous or next title/  
chapter/track/folder; or to display the  
previous or next menu page.  
Turn the Smart Jog clockwise during  
playback to skip progressively forward  
through the video playing.  
When GUIDE Plus+® is displayed, use  
to display the previous/next page.  
CHANNEL +/– (page 61)  
While stopped, turn the Smart Jog to  
change the channel of the built-in TV  
tuner.  
27  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Controls and displays  
03  
6
A.TV/D.TV  
13 Recording controls (page 64)  
Press to switch between analog TV antenna  
input and digital TV antenna input. The A.TV  
and D.TV indicators on the front panel show  
which is selected.  
REC  
Press to start recording. Press  
repeatedly to set the recording time in  
blocks of 30 mins.  
7
Colour buttons  
(RED, GREEN, YELLOW, BLUE)  
When the red action button is visible in a  
GUIDE Plus+® screen, use for One-  
Button-Record.  
Use when an EPG screen is displayed or  
when tuned to a data channel of a digital  
broadcast. The function of each button will  
be described on-screen, and changes  
depending on the screen being displayed.  
STOP REC  
Press to stop recording.  
14 INFO  
8
PAUSE LIVE TV (page 66)  
While watching D.TV, press to display the  
information banner.  
Press to start recording the current TV  
channel, but with playback paused,  
effectively pausing the broadcast.  
Press to see additional information for the  
highlighted item in the EPG.  
9
AUDIO (page 62, 63, 82, 83)  
15 GUIDE  
Press to change the audio language or  
channel. (When the recorder is stopped,  
press to change the tuner audio.)  
Press to display the EPG screen; press again  
to exit.  
16 HOME MENU  
Press to display the Home Menu, from  
which you can navigate all the functions of  
the recorder.  
SUBTITLE (page 82)  
Press to display/change the subtitles  
included in multilingual DVD-Video  
discs.  
17 RETURN/EXIT  
Press to go back one level in the on-screen  
menu or display.  
While watching D.TV, press to change  
the D.TV subtitles.  
Also press to exit the MHEG application.  
ANGLE (page 83)  
Press to switch camera angles on discs  
with multi-angle scenes.  
18 TIMER REC (page 38, 68)  
Press to set a timer recording.  
REC MODE (page 64)  
10 Number buttons, CLEAR, +  
Press repeatedly to change the  
recording mode (picture quality).  
Use the number buttons for track/chapter/  
title selection; channel selection, and so on.  
The same buttons can also be used to enter  
names for titles, discs and so on.  
19 ONE TOUCH COPY (page 100)  
Press to start One Touch Copy of the  
currently playing title to DVD or the HDD.  
Use CLEAR to clear an entry and start again.  
20 INPUT SELECT (page 70)  
Press to change the input to use for  
recording.  
11 TV CONTROL buttons (page 143)  
After setting up, use these controls to  
control your TV.  
21 MENU (page 75)  
12 HDD/DVD (page 64)  
Press to display the disc menu if a DVD-  
Video, finalized DVD-R/-RW (Video mode) or  
finalized DVD+R/+RW disc is loaded.  
Press to select the hard disk (HDD) or DVD  
for recording and playback.  
When in the GUIDE Plus+® system, use to  
jump directly to the Menu bar.  
28  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Controls and displays  
03  
22 DISPLAY (page 84)  
Displays/changes the on-screen information  
displays.  
23 TEXT (page 62, 63)  
Press to display Teletext information (in  
European countries except the UK) or to  
start the MHEG application display (UK only)  
if available during digital broadcasts.  
24 TV/DVD  
Press to switch between ‘TV mode’, in which  
you get the picture and sound from the TV’s  
tuner, and ‘DVD mode’, in which you get  
picture and sound from the recorder’s tuner  
(or an external input).  
29  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Getting started  
04  
Chapter 4  
Getting started  
Switching on and setting up  
ENTER  
4
Start the Setup Navigator.  
When you switch the recorder on for the first  
time, you can make several basic settings  
using the Setup Navigator feature. This takes  
you through setting the clock, the internal TV  
tuner and the video output.  
k
Complete this setup before you  
t
start using your recorder.  
e
P
Start  
Cancel  
p
Please use the Initial Setup if you  
want to make more detailed settings.  
If you’re using the recorder for the first time,  
we strongly recommend you use the Setup  
Navigator before starting to use the  
recorder.  
• If you don’t want to use the Setup  
Navigator, press to select Cancel,  
then press ENTER to exit the Setup  
Navigator.  
1
Switch on your TV and set the video  
input to this recorder.  
ENTER  
STANDBY/ON  
5
Select an Aerial Power  
2
Switch on the recorder.  
1
setting for the built-in digital tuner.  
On: power is always supplied to the  
connected aerial, whether the recorder  
is on or in standby.  
When you switch on for the first time, your  
TV should display the Setup Navigator  
screen (If the Setup Navigator doesn’t  
appear, you can also access it from the  
Initial Setup menu; see page 127).  
Auto: power is only supplied when this  
recorder is on.  
• If this recorder is connected to a  
compatible TV using a fully-wired 21-pin  
SCART cable, the recorder will take a few  
seconds to download country, TV screen  
size and language information. (Check  
the manual that came with your TV for  
compatibility information.)  
Off: power is never supplied to the  
aerial.  
ENTER  
6
Select ‘Auto Scan’ to start  
scanning for D.TV channels.  
• Select Do not set if you want to skip  
D.TV channel setup (because they have  
already been set up, for example), then  
skip to step 8 below.  
ENTER  
3
Choose a language (then  
press ENTER).  
Initial Setup  
ENTER  
Basic  
Clock Language  
Input
Powe
Tuner  
7
Select your country.  
Video In/ Out  
Audio In  
Audio Out  
Language  
Recording  
Playback  
HELP
The recorder starts scanning for new  
channels. After the scan is complete the  
recorder will let you know how many new  
channels were found.  
Setup
• The country setting will apply to both the  
digital and analog TV tuners.  
Note  
1 If the recorder does not accept the On or Auto setting (the highlight jumps back to Off), check that the antenna  
is properly connected and that it is not shorted, then try making the setting again.  
30  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Getting started  
04  
• The clock will also be set automatically  
here if D.TV channels are found.  
Downloading channels from your TV  
Use the Download from TV option to  
download all the channels that your TV is  
tuned to.  
• If no new channels were found a  
message appears asking if you want to  
scan again. Check the aerial connection  
before selecting Yes. (If you select No,  
skip to step 8 below.)  
Downloading  
Pr 5  
32/99  
Cancel  
ENTER  
ENTER  
8
Select the analog TV (A.TV)  
9
Select ‘Auto’ for automatic  
Auto Channel Setting (‘Auto Scan’ or  
‘Download from TV’), or ‘Do not set’.  
time setting, or ‘Manual’ to set the clock  
manually.  
If the clock was already set from a D.TV  
k
AutoChannel Setting  
channel in step 6, this step is skipped.  
e
P
AutoScan  
Download from TV  
k
ClockSetting  
p Do not Set  
er
P
Auto  
• Select Do not set if you want to skip  
channel setup (because they have  
already been set up, for example).  
Manual  
Auto clock setting  
Some TV channels broadcast time  
signals together with the programme.  
This recorder can use these signals to  
set the clock automatically.  
• You can only use the Download from  
TV feature if this recorder is connected  
to your TV using a fully-wired 21-pin  
SCART cable via the AV1 (RGB)-TV  
connector, and if your TV supports this  
function (check your TV’s instruction  
manual for more details).  
Set ‘Clock Set CH‘ to the channel  
preset number that broadcasts a time  
signal, then move the cursor down to  
‘Start’ and press ENTER.  
ENTER  
k
AutoClock Setting  
Select your country.  
Date  
––  
––  
/
:
––  
––  
/
––––  
e
Time  
P
k
Country Selection  
p
Clock Set CH  
Pr  
1
t
eCountry  
P
Start  
UK  
The recorder takes a short while to set  
the time. After you see that it’s set, select  
Next to proceed.  
Auto-tuning channels  
The Auto Scan option automatically scans  
and sets the channel presets.  
k
AutoClock Setting  
Date  
MON 01  
11  
/
01  
20  
/
2007  
e
Time  
Tuning  
:
P
p
Clock Set CH  
Pr  
1
32/99  
Start  
Next  
Cancel  
If the time could not be set  
automatically, press RETURN/EXIT to go  
back to the previous screen and select  
Manual.  
31  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Getting started  
04  
Manual clock setting  
ENTER  
If no stations in your area are  
broadcasting time signals, you can set  
the clock manually.  
10  
Select the EPG (Electronic  
Programme Guide) type to use.  
GUIDE Plus+: Use the Gemstar GUIDE  
Plus+ EPG (see also Setting up the  
GUIDE Plus+® system on page 33 and  
Using the GUIDE Plus+® electronic  
programme guide on page 37).  
Use the ꢃ/ꢀ buttons to set your  
time zone.  
You can set this by selecting a city or a  
time relative to GMT.  
1/2  
k
Manual Clock Setting  
Digital EPG: Use the SI EPG  
(programme information broadcast  
together with digital channels).  
Time Zone  
England  
London  
e
P
p Summer Time  
Off  
• If no channels were found when  
scanning for digital TV channels then  
this screen does not appear and the EPG  
is set according to the country set in step  
7 above.  
Press then use the ꢃ/buttons to  
select ‘On’ or ‘Off’ for summer time,  
then press ENTER.  
Select On if you are currently using  
summer time.  
ENTER  
11  
Select the TV screen type,  
1/2  
k
Manual Clock Setting  
‘Wide (16:9)’ or ‘Standard (4:3)’.  
Time Zone  
England  
London  
e
k
TVScreen Size  
P
p Summer Time  
On  
er
P
Wide (16:9)  
Standard (4:3)  
p Navigator  
Set the date (day/month/year) and  
time, then press ENTER to make all  
the settings.  
ENTER  
12  
Select whether or not your TV  
is compatible with progressive scan  
video.  
2/2  
k
Manual Clock Setting  
Date  
e
MON 01  
00  
/
:
01  
00  
/
2007  
k
Progressive  
P
Time  
p
Time Zone  
er
P
Compatible  
England  
London  
Not Compatible  
p Don't Know  
Summer Time  
On  
• Note that progressive scan video is only  
output through the AV1 (RGB)-TV  
connector and the component video  
outputs.  
• Use the ꢁ/ꢂ buttons to change the  
value in the highlighted field.  
• Use the ꢃ/ꢀ buttons to move from one  
field to another.  
ENTER  
13  
Press to continue after reading  
• You can go back to the previous screen  
in the Setup Navigator by pressing  
RETURN/EXIT.  
the HDD caution.  
k Inthe event of HDD failure, recordings may  
be lost or normal playback/recording may  
not be possible.  
e
As recordings might be lost in case of a HDD  
failure, we recommend to use the HDD only  
P
as temporary storage media.  
p
Please copy recordings you want to keep  
to recordable DVD.  
Press ENTER to continue.  
32  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Getting started  
04  
Setting up the GUIDE Plus+®  
system  
ENTER  
14  
Select ‘Finish Setup’ to exit  
the Setup Navigator, or ‘Go Back’ if you  
want to start again.  
This section is only applicable if you chose to  
use the GUIDE Plus+ system as the EPG type  
in step 10 of the Setup Navigator above.  
k
Setting  
Setupis complete!  
e
The GUIDE Plus+® system is a free,  
interactive on-screen television  
Finish Setup  
Go Back  
p
programming guide. The system offers  
programme listings for all major channels,  
one-touch recording, search by genre,  
recommendations according to your profile  
and more.  
That completes basic setup using the Setup  
Navigator.  
• If there are blank channels with no  
station, you can set these to skip using  
the manual channel setting. See Manual  
CH Setting on page 130.  
For the GUIDE Plus+ system to function  
correctly, it is important that you set the  
language and country correctly in the Setup  
Navigator, and that you have performed a  
scan for available channels, as these are all  
used by the GUIDE Plus+ system. If any of  
these things are not yet set, please run the  
Setup Navigator first (see Switching on and  
setting up on page 30).  
For users receiving digital  
broadcast services  
This unit can set its internal clock  
automatically from digital broadcasts.  
However, depending on the broadcaster, the  
clock information received may not be  
accurate.  
TV listings information is received via ‘host  
channels’. In order to receive the correct TV  
listings information for your country or  
region you need to set up the GUIDE Plus+  
system and ‘download’ the TV listings  
information. The initial download can take  
up to 24 hours, but once this is done, all  
future updates are automatic.  
Use the following procedure (while the  
recorder is not recording) to set the clock  
manually.  
HOME MENU  
1
Press HOME MENU.  
ENTER  
2
Select ’Initial Setup’ > ‘Basic’ >  
GUIDE  
1
Display the GUIDE Plus+ setup  
‘Clock Setting’.  
3
menu.  
Highlight the time setting.  
ENTER  
4
Press to display the manual clock  
setting screen.  
Set the correct time.  
5
Return to automatic clock setting  
• To return to the automatic clock setting,  
follow the instructions for ‘Replace  
Channels’ (page 128).  
The language and country settings are  
already set to whatever you selected in the  
Setup Navigator.  
33  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Getting started  
04  
4
If you are using an external receiver  
ENTER  
(such as a satellite receiver) with the  
supplied G-LINK cable, complete this  
step, otherwise jump to step 5 below.  
2
Highlight ‘Postal Code’.  
• See Connecting to a cable box or satellite  
receiver on page 17 for more on using the  
supplied G-LINK cable.  
ENTER  
3
Enter your postal  
code.  
• Select External Receiver 1, 2 or 3, then  
press ENTER. (If you have just one  
external receiver, use External Receiver  
1. You can add further receivers in 2 and  
3 if you need to.)  
After pressing ENTER:  
• Select your reception method  
(Terrestrial, Cable or Satellite).  
• Select your provider (if applicable).  
• Select the brand of your external  
receiver.  
• Identify which input your external  
receiver is connected to.  
The system uses your postal code to identify  
which TV listings data is correct for the area  
in which you live, so it is important that you  
enter it correctly.  
After completing these steps the recorder  
will try and communicate with your external  
receiver and change the channel via the G-  
LINK cable. If the channel was successfully  
changed, select Yes to confirm.  
If the channel did not change, select No. The  
GUIDE Plus+ system will try other codes  
assigned to your external receiver. If none of  
the codes changes the channel  
successfully, tune your external receiver to  
the host channel for your country (refer to  
step 5 below) and leave it on overnight. The  
34  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Getting started  
04  
recorder needs to be in standby; it will wake  
up automatically and download new codes  
from the host channel. The next day, try this  
setup process again:  
Country/ Host  
Comments  
Region  
Austria  
Belgium  
France  
Germany  
Italy  
channels  
Eurosport  
RTL-TVI  
Canal+  
Eurosport  
MTV  
• Press GUIDE to display the GUIDE  
Plus+ screen.  
Analog only  
Analog only  
Analog only  
• Press to highlight the Menu bar, then  
use to reach the Setup area and  
select Setup.  
• Continue setting up from the start of this  
step again.  
Netherlands Eurosport  
Spain Tele 5  
Switzerland Eurosport  
If your external receiver still doesn’t respond  
to the G-LINK controller, please call  
customer support and report the brand and  
model of your external receiver.  
UK  
ITV, Eurosport ITV is analog only. Use  
Eurosport if you are a  
SKY subscriber and  
you no longer have an  
analog terrestrial  
See also GUIDE Plus+ FAQ and  
troubleshooting on page 48.  
5
Identify the host channel for your  
antenna.  
country.  
The TV listings information available in the  
GUIDE Plus+ system is distributed  
throughout Europe by selected broadcasters  
called host channels. It is important that the  
host (analog) channel for your country is  
correctly identified in order to receive  
listings information (EPG download).  
• Tune your external receiver to the  
appropriate host channel and leave the  
receiver on and the recorder in standby  
overnight.  
C If you use both an external receiver  
and this recorder as sources, follow the  
instructions above for setting up without  
an external receiver. Only if this is  
unsuccessful try the external receiver  
method.  
Follow A, B or C below depending on your  
setup:  
A If you are not using an external  
receiver, this recorder will automatically  
scan all channels for the host channel:  
About EPG download  
• EPG data can only be received when the  
recorder is in standby. (When not using the  
recorder, therefore, please switch it into  
standby.) If you’re using an external receiver,  
leave this on when EPG data is downloading.  
• Leave the recorder in standby overnight  
(do not leave it switched on).  
B If you are using an external receiver,  
you need to identify the host channel  
from the table below:  
• If you cannot receive any of the host  
channels (see the above table) then you  
won’t be able to use the GUIDE Plus+  
system. In this case do not set the postal  
code (or set Country to Other) in the  
GUIDE Plus+ setup screen. (When  
GUIDE Plus+ service starts in your area,  
set the postal code again.)  
If digital broadcasts start in your area,  
please set the EPG Type Select setting in  
the Initial Setup menu to Digital EPG.  
35  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Getting started  
04  
• Even if you can’t use the EPG functions  
where you live, you can still set VIDEO  
Plus+ recordings and manual  
recordings — see Setting a manual  
recording on page 45.  
• For any channel that you turn ON, the  
GUIDE Plus+ system will need to know  
how it is received (the source) and on  
which programme number. The source  
may be the built-in tuner of this recorder,  
or an external receiver. The programme  
number is the number on which the  
channel can be found on its receiving  
device/source. The entry in the Editor  
screen must match this number for  
correct recording of that channel.  
• The front panel display shows EPG when  
receiving data. If you power on the  
recorder during an EPG download, the  
download is cancelled.  
• EPG data may be received several times  
a day. All updates are automatic.  
• The above is especially important for the  
‘host channel’. Please make sure that  
the host channel is always switched ON.  
• When downloading EPG data, the  
recorder may sound as though it is on.  
This is normal.  
Checking the downloaded data the  
following day  
2
Change the programme  
numbers as you like.  
GUIDE  
1
Display the GUIDE Plus+ screen.  
Changing the programme numbers allows  
you to decide the order in which the  
channels change when stepping through  
them sequentially. You can do this to group  
certain channels together, for example.  
Name  
BBC1  
BBC2  
ITV  
CH4  
CH5  
BBC3  
ITV2  
E4  
On/Off Source  
Prog. No.  
001  
On  
On  
On  
On  
On  
On  
On  
Off  
On  
D. TV  
D. TV  
002  
003  
004  
005  
007  
006  
014  
017  
D. TV  
D. TV  
D. TV  
Ext. Rec. 1  
D. TV  
You should see a grid filled with channel  
logos and TV listings information. Use the  
ꢁ/ꢂ buttons to review the list. If you notice  
that there are channels missing, or that  
there are channels in the list that you don’t  
get, go to the Editor screen:  
D. TV  
D. TV  
UKGOL  
3
When you’re done, press the BLUE  
Action button (Home) to get back to the  
GUIDE Plus+ home screen.  
• Press repeatedly until the Menu bar is  
highlighted.  
• You can find detailed information on  
using the GUIDE Plus+ system in the  
following chapter.  
• Press until Editor is highlighted. The  
main area of the screen now shows a list  
of channels. Those that are turned ON  
are displayed in the grid; those that are  
OFF are hidden. Use the ꢁ/ꢂ/ꢃ/ꢀ  
buttons to move down the list and turn  
channels ON or OFF as necessary.  
36  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the GUIDE Plus+® electronic programme guide  
05  
Chapter 5  
Using the GUIDE Plus+®  
electronic programme guide  
GEMSTAR-TV GUIDE INTERNATIONAL, INC. AND/  
OR ITS RELATED AFFILIATES BE LIABLE FOR ANY  
AMOUNTS REPRESENTING LOSS OF PROFITS, LOSS  
OF BUSINESS, OR INDIRECT, SPECIAL, OR  
This chapter is only applicable if the EPG Type  
Select setting made in the Setup Navigator (or  
the Initial Setup menu) is set to GUIDE Plus+.  
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES IN CONNECTION  
WITH THE PROVISION OR USE OF ANY  
INFORMATION, EQUIPMENT, OR SERVICES  
The GUIDE Plus+ system  
RELATING TO THE GUIDE PLUS+ SYSTEM.  
The GUIDE Plus+® system* is a free,  
interactive on-screen television  
programming guide. The system provides  
programme listings for all major channels,  
Using the GUIDE Plus+  
system  
1
one-touch recording, searching by genre,  
All the various features and areas are colour-  
recommendations according to your profile  
coded for ease of navigation. All screens  
and more. The GUIDE Plus+ system is a  
(with the exception of some setup screens)  
convenient way to find out what’s on right  
have the following common elements:  
now or during the coming week, by channel  
or by genre. The GUIDE Plus+ system also  
allows you to automatically set your viewing  
and recording selections quickly and easily.  
3
4
1
In order to receive the correct TV listings  
5
information for your country or region you  
need to set up the GUIDE Plus+ system and  
‘download’ the TV listings information. If you  
6
haven’t already done this, please turn to  
Setting up the GUIDE Plus+® system on  
page 33 before proceeding.  
2
* GUIDE Plus+, SHOWVIEW, VIDEO Plus+,  
G-LINK are (1) registered trademarks or  
trademarks of, (2) manufactured under  
license from and (3) subject of various  
international patents and patent applications  
owned by, or licensed to, Gemstar-TV Guide  
International, Inc. and/or its related affiliates.  
1 Video window – Allows you to continue  
watching the current programme while  
using the GUIDE Plus+ system.  
2 Information panels – Display  
programme promotions or instructions  
on the GUIDE Plus+ system.  
3 Action bar – Colour-coded Action  
buttons change function depending on  
the area.  
Legal Notice  
GEMSTAR-TV GUIDE INTERNATIONAL, INC. AND/  
OR ITS RELATED AFFILIATES ARE NOT IN ANY WAY  
LIABLE FOR THE ACCURACY OF THE PROGRAMME  
SCHEDULE INFORMATION PROVIDED BY THE  
GUIDE PLUS+ SYSTEM. IN NO EVENT SHALL  
4 Information box – Shows short  
programme descriptions or help menus.  
Note  
1 The GUIDE Plus+ system can’t be used when the Input Line System is set to 525 System (see also Input Line  
System on page 127).  
37  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the GUIDE Plus+® electronic programme guide  
05  
5 Menu bar – Gives access to the various  
areas of the GUIDE Plus+ system.  
One-Button-Record  
The RED Action button (Record) is visible  
anytime you can highlight a programme  
title, including from the Grid, after a search,  
or in your recommendations in the My TV  
area.  
6 Grid – Shows TV listings information for  
the next seven days by channel and time.  
GUIDE Plus+ navigation  
The table below shows a summary of the  
remote buttons you’ll use to navigate the  
GUIDE Plus+ system.  
The programme name, date, channel,  
recording start and end times are all set  
automatically when you set a timer  
recording using One-Button-Record.  
Key  
What it does  
If you need to, you can edit the settings at  
any time before the recording is due to start  
(see Editing a scheduled recording on  
page 43).  
Press to set or cancel One  
Button Recording.  
REC  
Press to display the GUIDE  
Plus+ screen (also use to  
exit).  
GUIDE  
1
Highlight a programme title.  
ꢁ/ꢂ/ꢃ/ꢀ  
Use to navigate screens  
(highlight an item).  
RED, GREEN,  
Action buttons that change  
YELLOW, BLUE functionality depending on  
the Area.  
MENU  
Press to jump directly to the  
Menu bar.  
TIMER REC  
INFO  
Press to go directly to the  
Schedule area.  
Press to display extended  
information for the current  
programme.  
2
Press the RED Action button (Record).  
The programme is now set for recording.  
When the programme is due to start, the  
recorder will switch to the correct channel  
ENTER  
Press to confirm a selection  
or to leave the GUIDE  
Plus+ screen.  
1
and start recording .  
Number  
buttons  
Use for numeric entry.  
• You can also use the REC button to set  
the recording.  
• You can review the shows you have set to  
record in the Schedule Area (see also  
The Schedule Area on page 42).  
PREV/  
NEXT  
Press to select the previous/  
next page of information (in  
the grid, for example).  
ꢈ/ꢉ  
Press to select the previous/  
next day.  
Note  
1 Recording times set using the GUIDE Plus+ system do not automatically change to reflect any changes that  
may occur in the programme broadcast schedules.  
38  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the GUIDE Plus+® electronic programme guide  
05  
Lock/Unlock video window  
When you enter the GUIDE Plus+ system,  
Areas  
The GUIDE Plus+® system consists of  
seven Areas. All Areas can be accessed from  
the Menu bar.  
the channel you were watching remains  
visible in the video window. The date stamp  
above the window lets you know the  
channel, date and time.  
Grid – The GUIDE Plus+ system Home  
Area. Displays TV listings information for  
the next seven days by time and channel.  
The default setting for this window is  
‘locked’, as indicated by a closed padlock  
icon above the video window. When locked,  
the video window always shows the channel  
you were previously watching as you move  
up and down through the listings grid.  
Search – Search for TV programmes by  
category (e.g., Sport), subcategory (e.g.,  
Football) or keyword.  
My TV – Set up a profile and receive  
recommendations according to your  
preferences.  
If you prefer, you can unlock the video  
window so that as you highlight different  
channels in the listings grid, that channel is  
shown in the video window.  
Schedule – Show all scheduled  
recordings.  
Info – Area for additional information,  
such as weather (not available in all  
regions).  
1
Highlight a channel logo.  
Editor – Change channel settings.  
Setup – Setup the GUIDE Plus+®  
system.  
The Grid Area  
The Grid is the main TV listings screen of the  
GUIDE Plus+ system and is the first screen  
that you see when you press GUIDE. You can  
see TV listings for the next seven days,  
starting with the current day.  
Channel logos are displayed to the left of  
programme titles.  
2
Press the RED Action button (Unlock).  
When you highlight a programme in the  
Grid, you can see information about it in the  
Information Box, including title, synopsis,  
channel, source, time and length. If there is  
an i symbol in the Information Box, it means  
that there is an extended synopsis available.  
Press the INFO button to see it.  
The padlock icon above the video window  
becomes unlocked. It remains unlocked for  
the remainder of your current TV viewing  
session.  
If you want to lock the video window again,  
follow the same procedure. The RED Action  
button will now act as Lock.  
In some countries, you can also see a rating  
for a particular programme (mostly movies).  
These ratings are provided by local partners,  
such as TV magazines.  
Channel mosaic screen  
You can switch the display style of channels  
in the Grid Area, Schedule Area or My TV  
Area from a list to a mosaic of channel icons  
by pressing the YELLOW Action button.  
Select the channel icon you want using the  
cursor buttons, then press ENTER to return  
to the previous screen on that channel.  
From the Grid Area you can:  
• View and scroll through programme  
listings  
• Read programme synopses  
39  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the GUIDE Plus+® electronic programme guide  
05  
• Tune to a programme that’s currently  
1
showing  
1
bar.  
Select ‘Search’ from the Menu  
• Set a programme to record  
• Lock or unlock the video window  
• Access Information panels  
2
Select a category and a  
Browsing the Grid  
subcategory.  
Use the following remote buttons to browse  
the grid:  
ꢁ/ꢂ/ꢃ/ꢀ (cursor buttons) – Navigate the  
Grid  
PREV/ꢇ NEXT – Previous / next page  
ꢈ/ꢉ – Previous / next day  
BLUE Action button – Return to the current  
time/date in the Grid  
ENTER – Press on the current selection to  
exit the GUIDE Plus+ system and start  
watching the programme  
• If you choose All as the subcategory, all  
programmes in the category you  
selected will show up in the search  
results.  
The Search Area  
From the Search Area you can:  
• Search by category  
• Search by subcategory  
• Search by keyword  
ENTER  
3
Start the search.  
The search results are shown sorted by time  
and date.  
• Read programme synopses  
• Tune to a programme that’s currently  
showing  
• If no search results are displayed, it  
means there are no programmes for the  
current day that match your search  
criteria.  
• Set a programme to record  
• Access Information panels  
Searching  
You can search for programmes by category,  
subcategory or by keyword (My Choice).  
Categories for searching include Movies  
(purple), Sport (green), Children (blue) and  
Others (teal). In some countries there is a  
further subcategory available called ‘Tip of  
the Day’. These are programmes  
recommended by a local partner, such as a  
TV magazine.  
Note  
1 If you’re using an external tuner (satellite tuner, for example), there will be a short delay of a couple of seconds  
while it tunes to the channel. This is normal.  
40  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the GUIDE Plus+® electronic programme guide  
05  
Using My Choice keywords for a search  
In addition to the standard categories, you  
can also set your own keywords.  
My TV Area  
The My TV Area allows you to set up a  
personal profile. You can define a profile by  
channels, themes and/or keywords. As soon  
as a personal profile has been set, the  
GUIDE Plus+ system continuously scans  
the TV listings for the next seven days.  
Whenever you access the My TV Area, a list  
of programmes matching your profile  
appears.  
1
Access My Choice.  
From the My TV Area you can:  
• Set up a profile by channel, theme and/  
or keyword  
• Edit and delete profiles  
• Read programme synopses  
• Tune to a programme that’s currently  
showing  
• Set a programme to record  
• Access Information panels  
2
Press the YELLOW Action button to  
add a keyword.  
Setting up a profile  
ENTER  
You can set up a profile with any  
combination of up to 16 channels, four  
categories and 16 keywords.  
3
Enter a keyword to appear in  
the menu.  
1
2
Select ‘My TV’ from the Menu bar.  
Press the YELLOW Action button to  
set a profile.  
When you’re finished, press the GREEN  
Action button to exit and continue.  
ENTER  
4
Start the keyword search.  
• You can delete or edit keywords using  
the RED and GREEN Action buttons.  
Channels is now highlighted.  
• When you have set more than two  
keywords, an All subcategory  
automatically appears which allows you  
to search for all your keywords.  
41  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the GUIDE Plus+® electronic programme guide  
05  
3
To add a channel to your profile,  
5
To add a keyword to your profile,  
press the YELLOW Action button.  
highlight ‘Keywords’ and press the  
YELLOW Action button.  
Select a channel from the mosaic of channel  
icons and press ENTER. Repeat this step to  
add up to 16 channels.  
Use the ꢁ/ꢂ/ꢃ/ꢀ buttons followed by  
ENTER to select characters from the on-  
screen keyboard. When you’re finished,  
press the GREEN Action button to exit and  
continue.  
4
To add a category to your profile,  
highlight ‘Categories’ and press the  
YELLOW Action button.  
6
Press ENTER to activate your profile.  
• You can add up to 16 keywords by  
repeating step 5.  
• You can edit or delete your profile using  
the RED and GREEN Action buttons.  
The Schedule Area  
The Schedule Area is where you can set, see,  
edit and delete scheduled (timer)  
recordings.  
From the Schedule Area you can:  
• Edit or delete a One-Button-Recording  
Select a category from the Search Area  
categories and press ENTER. Repeat this  
step to add up to four categories.  
• Set, edit or delete a VIDEO Plus+  
recording  
• Set, edit or delete a manual recording  
42  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the GUIDE Plus+® electronic programme guide  
05  
4
Enter a name for the scheduled  
Editing a scheduled recording  
You can edit any parameter in a scheduled  
recording.  
recording, or delete it if you no longer require  
1
it .  
1
Highlight the left tile of a scheduled  
recording.  
Use the ꢁ/ꢂ/ꢃ/ꢀ buttons followed by  
ENTER to select characters from the on-  
screen keyboard.  
After entering the whole name, press the  
GREEN Action button to continue.  
• If you only want to edit the recording  
quality, frequency, destination, timing or  
genre settings, skip to step 5 below.  
5
6
Highlight the right recording tile.  
Press the RED Action button (Quality)  
to change the recording quality.  
2
3
Press the GREEN Action button (Edit).  
Use the cursor and number buttons  
to edit the recording date, start time, end  
time and channel.  
2
Select from AUTO , XP, SP, LP, EP, SLP, SEP  
or a manual recording mode (see Manual  
Recording on page 135 and Manual recording  
modes on page 145).  
Use the ꢁ/buttons or the number buttons  
to edit.  
Press the GREEN Action button to go to  
continue, or the RED Action button to go  
back.  
Note  
1 See About timer recordings on page 68 for more information about scheduled recordings.  
2 This mode maximizes the recording quality to fit on to a single DVD disc. Can also be used when recording to  
HDD.  
43  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the GUIDE Plus+® electronic programme guide  
05  
7
Press the GREEN Action button  
• Auto Replace Recording is only available  
as an option with regular daily or weekly  
recordings.  
(Frequency) to change the recording  
frequency.  
9
Press to access the extended  
recording options.  
Select from the various options for one-time,  
daily and weekly recordings.  
• If you want to record to a particular HDD  
genre, use the YELLOW Action button  
(Genre) to select one.  
8
Press YELLOW Action button  
(Destination) to select the recording  
destination.  
• Use the GREEN Action button (Timing)  
to add extra time to the end of the  
recording (+0, +10, +20, +30 or VPS/  
2
PDC (V–P)).  
• Press to display the standard  
recording options again.  
Select from DVD, HDD or HDDr (Auto  
1
Replace Recording) .  
Note  
1 • For a DVD timer recording, if Optimized Rec (see Optimized Rec on page 135) is set to On (and VPS/PDC is  
off), the recorder will adjust the recording quality to try and fit the recording on the disc. If the recording will not  
fit onto the disc even on MN1 recording quality (MN4 for DVD+R/+RW) then the Recovery Recording feature  
will automatically make the recording to the HDD instead.  
• If there is very little free space left on the HDD, an Auto Replace Recording may not complete successfully.  
• If the HDD is being used for playback or high-speed copying when an Auto Replace Recording is due to start,  
the new timer recording will not replace the old one. However, the next time the timer recording starts, both of  
the older two programmes will be erased.  
2 • If you set the timer recording to use VPS/PDC, you must switch the recorder into standby before the timer  
recording is due to start for it to work correctly. For non-VPS/PDC timer recordings there is no need to switch  
the recorder into standby.  
• Optimized Recording will not work if VPS/PDC is on.  
• Up to eight timer recordings can be set with VPS/PDC.  
• VPS/PDC cannot be set for recordings made from digital broadcasts or an external input, or when the  
recording mode is set to AUTO.  
44  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the GUIDE Plus+® electronic programme guide  
05  
3
Use the number buttons to enter a  
Deleting a scheduled recording  
Highlight the left tile of a scheduled  
PlusCode programming number.  
1
recording.  
Please enter the PlusCode programming number and press  
ENTER to confirm.  
• If you live in an area not yet covered by  
the GUIDE Plus+ system you may also  
have to input a channel number. Follow  
the on-screen display to do this.  
2
Press the RED Action button (Delete).  
The scheduled event is deleted.  
Setting a VIDEO Plus+® recording  
4
Press ENTER to confirm.  
1
Select ‘Schedule’ from the Menu  
bar.  
Setting a manual recording  
1 Select ‘Schedule’ from the Menu bar.  
2
Press the RED Action button (VIDEO  
Plus+).  
2
Press the GREEN Action button  
(Manual).  
45  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the GUIDE Plus+® electronic programme guide  
05  
3
Use the number and ꢁ/ꢂ/ꢃ/ꢀ  
The Info Area  
buttons to enter the recording date, then  
press the GREEN Action button (Next).  
This area is reserved for additional  
information such as news, weather reports,  
stock quotes, and so on, and varies by  
region. (Note that this feature is not available  
in all countries/regions.)  
The Editor Area  
The Editor Area is the central location for you  
to manage your channels. Any changes you  
make here will affect what is displayed in the  
Grid Area. The Editor Area is mainly used  
when setting up the GUIDE Plus+ system to  
make any manual changes as necessary.  
You can also use the Editor Area if new  
channels become available in your area, or if  
you change from cable to satellite, say, or  
move house.  
4
In the same way, enter the recording  
start time, followed by the GREEN Action  
button (Next) to confirm.  
From the Editor Area you can:  
5
Enter the recording end time in the  
same way, followed by the GREEN Action  
button (Next) to confirm.  
• Display/hide channels in the grid (switch  
the channel on/off)  
6
Use the number buttons to enter a  
• Select a channel source (A.TV, D.TV,  
Ext. Rec. 1, Ext. Rec. 2, etc.)  
channel number, then press the GREEN  
Action button (Next) to confirm.  
• Enter a channel programme number  
Switching a channel on/off  
You can choose whether or not to display a  
channel in the Grid Area by switching the  
channel on or off in the Editor Area.  
D.TV 001  
1
Select ‘Editor’ from the Menu bar.  
Name  
BBC1  
BBC2  
ITV  
CH4  
CH5  
BBC3  
ITV2  
E4  
On/Off Source  
Prog. No.  
001  
On  
On  
On  
On  
On  
On  
On  
Off  
On  
D. TV  
D. TV  
D. TV  
D. TV  
D. TV  
Ext. Rec. 1  
D. TV  
D. TV  
D. TV  
Alternatively, you can press the YELLOW  
Action button (Mosaic) and use the ꢁ/ꢂ/  
ꢃ/ꢀ buttons to select a channel from the  
mosaic, followed by ENTER.  
002  
003  
004  
005  
007  
006  
014  
017  
UKGOL  
2
channel you want to switch on or off.  
Press the RED Action button to switch  
the channel on or off.  
Highlight the left channel tile of the  
3
46  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the GUIDE Plus+® electronic programme guide  
05  
Changing the source and programme  
number  
The Setup Area  
The Setup Area is where you can set up the  
GUIDE Plus+ system for your particular  
region, TV reception conditions, and so on.  
1
Select ‘Editor’ from the Menu bar.  
Making changes to your GUIDE Plus+  
setup  
1
Select ‘Setup’ from the Menu bar.  
Prog. No.  
001  
002  
003  
004  
005  
007  
006  
014  
017  
Name  
BBC1  
BBC2  
ITV  
CH4  
CH5  
BBC3  
ITV2  
E4  
On/Off Source  
On  
On  
On  
On  
On  
On  
On  
Off  
On  
D. TV  
D. TV  
D. TV  
D. TV  
D. TV  
Ext. Rec. 1  
D. TV  
D. TV  
D. TV  
Press ENTER to access the Basic Setup screen.  
UKGOL  
Basic Setup  
Host Channel Setup  
GUIDE Plus+ System Information  
2
channel you want to make a change to.  
Press the RED Action button to  
Highlight the right channel tile of the  
3
change the channel source, or the GREEN  
Action button to enter a programme  
number.  
2
Highlight the part you want to  
Each press of the RED Action button  
changes the channel source (A.TV, D.TV,  
Ext. Rec. 1, etc.). To set a programme  
number, use the number buttons to enter a  
programme number then press ENTER  
(When set to A.TV or D.TV, make sure that  
the programme number matches the preset  
number of this recorder for what you want to  
record).  
change.  
You can change the Language, Country,  
1
Postal Code and the External Receiver  
settings.  
3
Press ENTER to confirm.  
Note  
1 Making changes to the Country or Postal Code settings may require a new download of TV listings information.  
This can take up to 24 hours.  
47  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the GUIDE Plus+® electronic programme guide  
05  
Manual Host Channel setup  
GUIDE Plus+ FAQ and  
The GUIDE Plus+ system will automatically  
troubleshooting  
identify your Host Channel as soon as the  
recorder is put into standby for the first time.  
See the table on page 35 for a list of all the  
European Host Channels.  
This FAQ covers only a few questions. For a  
complete list please consult the GUIDE  
Plus+ website at:  
www.europe.guideplus.com  
If you know your Host Channel details  
(source and programme number) or if the  
automatic identification did not provide the  
expected result, you can identify your Host  
Channel manually. Select Host Channel  
Setup in the Setup area and follow the  
instructions on the TV. Select the correct  
source (e.g., internal tuner or external  
receiver) and enter the respective  
FAQ  
• When I tried setting up my external  
receiver I could not get any of the  
attempts to work, what should I do?  
There could be several reasons why your  
external receiver could not be controlled.  
programme number (e.g., if you have to  
press 9 on the remote to watch your Host  
Channel, enter 9 as the programme  
number). When you next switch the recorder  
into standby the GUIDE Plus+ system will  
complete the Host Channel setup.  
– The connections could be wrong. Make  
sure that the G-LINK cable is connected  
to the G-LINK connector on the recorder  
and the IR blaster is in front of the  
external receiver, pointing towards the  
IR receiver of your external receiver. See  
Connecting to a cable box or satellite  
receiver on page 17.  
You can reset the Host Channel settings at  
any time back to the default setting of  
automatic. Please be aware that resetting  
the Host Channel will erase all TV listings  
data.  
– The code that is listed under your  
brand could be wrong. Please try other  
codes for your brand under satellite,  
cable or terrestrial. Go to the Setup Area  
and choose one of the three options  
(cable, satellite or terrestrial) that you  
have not already tried. Follow the on-  
screen prompts to make sure that the  
GUIDE Plus+ system can change  
channels on your external receiver. If it  
does not work, repeat the process,  
choosing different reception and  
external receiver combinations until you  
have tried all the codes for your brand of  
receiver that are already in the GUIDE  
Plus+ system. If it still does not work,  
see below on how to receive new codes  
overnight.  
– The unit has not yet received new  
codes. The nightly data downloads  
frequently include new codes for  
controlling external receivers. Please  
tune your external receiver to your local  
host channel and leave it on overnight.  
48  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the GUIDE Plus+® electronic programme guide  
05  
Switch this recorder into standby. The  
next morning, please perform the GUIDE  
Plus+ setup again to see if your external  
receiver can now be controlled.  
terrestrial or cable connection only to  
receive data this way. It is important that  
you identify your host channel correctly  
in the Editor Area.  
– The external receiver that you use is  
currently not supported. If, after leaving  
your external receiver on overnight, and  
doing the Reception and External  
• After I performed the initial set-up I found  
that the line-up for all the channels  
received via the external set top box is  
incorrect. How do I correct this?  
Receiver Setup again, it still does not  
respond, please call Customer Support  
to report your brand and model.  
You can change the line-up in the editor  
according to your preferences. Access  
the Editor Area. Select the channels that  
you would like to change. Change the  
source and preset number according to  
your preferences.  
• My external receiver was successfully  
setup. However I have found that when  
the GUIDE Plus+ system has to change  
to a channel with a three-digit programme  
number in the external receiver’s preset, it  
does not work. It looks like the GUIDE  
Plus+ system can only send two digits.  
• I performed the set-up but after many  
hours I still have a blank EPG what is  
going wrong?  
There are several possibilities:  
With the number of channels  
– Connections are wrong. See  
Connections on page 14 to double check  
everything.  
increasing, the number of digits has  
increased as well. While older boxes use  
only two digits, newer boxes require up  
to four. It is possible that you selected an  
older code for your brand during set-up.  
Please access the Setup Area, select  
External Receiver and repeat the setup  
for your brand (Note: Every time you see  
the on-screen question about whether  
the receiver has changed to a certain  
channel, the GUIDE Plus+ system has  
sent a different code). Try all the different  
codes until your GUIDE Plus+ system  
can control your external receiver  
– The initial setup of GUIDE Plus+ was  
completed incorrectly. Try setting it up  
again (see Setting up the GUIDE Plus+®  
system on page 33).  
– Your cabling and setup is OK, but the  
recorder has not been connected for  
enough time to receive the TV listings  
data. Leave the recorder in standby  
overnight.  
– For external receiver users only: The  
connections and setup are OK, but the  
external receiver was not tuned to the  
correct host channel. Check the list of  
host channels (see step 5 of Setting up  
the GUIDE Plus+® system on page 33)  
and leave the recorder in standby and  
the external receiver on overnight tuned  
to the correct host channel.  
correctly. If you have no success, try to  
receive new codes overnight.  
• I used to receive data through my  
terrestrial antenna or analog cable  
without a set-top box. Now, I have  
“upgraded” to a satellite system or to  
digital cable with external receiver. What  
should I do to receive data for the GUIDE  
Plus+ system?  
– You live in a country/region where the  
GUIDE Plus+ system is not yet available.  
Check the list of countries to see if you  
are in a region that is supported.  
You can try to receive your host channel  
through your new reception method. If  
you have problems to receive data we  
recommend that you keep your analog  
49  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the GUIDE Plus+® electronic programme guide  
05  
• I used the One-Button-Record feature (red  
Action button) to set a recording, but I  
recorded the wrong channel.  
• The automatic Host Channel search  
failed or the GUIDE Plus+ system  
identified the wrong Host Channel for my  
region.  
If the channel to be recorded is received  
via the external receiver first make sure  
that the external receiver was left  
switched on. Next, in the Editor Area,  
make sure that the channel to be  
You can identify your Host Channel  
manually. See Manual Host Channel  
setup on page 48 for how to do this.  
recorded is correctly set: Access the  
Editor Area. Check the source and  
programme number of the channel that  
you wanted to record. Change the  
source and preset numbers if incorrect.  
If you are recording from the recorder’s  
internal tuner (the A.TV or D.TV  
setting), make sure that the programme  
number is the same as the preset  
number set on this recorder. If they are  
different, go to the Editor Area and  
change the programme number to  
match the recorder’s preset number.  
• The TV listings information doesn’t  
update.  
The latest TV listings information is  
automatically downloaded by the  
recorder overnight. This only happens if  
the recorder is in standby; if the recorder  
is left on, it will not download. When not  
using the recorder, please switch it into  
standby.  
Data downloads can take several hours.  
The front panel display shows EPG when  
downloading. If you switch the recorder  
on while EPG is displayed, the download  
will be cancelled.  
• The GUIDE Plus+ system is not  
supported in my area, but when I switch  
the recorder into standby, after a while the  
front panel display shows EPG. Can I stop  
this from happening?  
If the GUIDE Plus+ system is not  
supported in your area, please do not set  
the postal code in the GUIDE Plus+  
setup (see Setting up the GUIDE Plus+®  
system on page 33). When the GUIDE  
Plus+ service starts in your area, please  
set the postal code again.  
50  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the digital electronic programme guide  
06  
Chapter 6  
Using the digital electronic  
programme guide  
5
Indicates the programme set for  
This chapter is only applicable if the EPG Type  
Select setting made in the Setup Navigator (or  
the Initial Setup menu) is set to Digital EPG.  
recording  
6
Appears when other programmes (often  
short ones) have been scheduled for the  
same period  
7
8
The Digital EPG system  
Programme title  
Time dividers  
The Digital EPG shows a table of scheduled  
digital TV programmes and detailed  
information about individual programmes. It  
also allows you easily to select and tune to a  
particular programme.  
• The general programme list may show  
sections whose bottom right corners  
have been folded. This indicates that  
other programmes have been scheduled  
for that period. To view the title of such a  
programme and related information,  
highlight a folded section, and then  
press ꢃ/ꢀ.  
1
The Digital EPG screen consists of  
programme Information, Channel List and  
General Programme List. This section  
describes information displayed in the  
schedule and information windows.  
Note that the recorder’s clock must be set to  
the correct time and date to ensure all  
relevant EPG information is displayed.  
Programme information  
D007  
General Programme List  
D007  
1
2
3
4
Channel number  
Station name  
Programme title  
Appear when other programmes have  
been scheduled for the same period  
5
6
Programme schedule  
Programme genre  
1
Appears when the schedule table can be  
scrolled forward or backward  
2
3
4
Time schedule  
Channel list  
Highlights the currently selected  
channel  
Note  
51  
En  
1 EPG information is only viewable for D.TV programmes that provide EPG information.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the digital electronic programme guide  
06  
• To quit the display of detailed  
information, press INFO again (or  
Using the Digital EPG  
Using the Digital EPG you can check the  
schedule of digital TV programmes, view  
information about desired programmes,  
and/or select programmes.  
RETURN/EXIT).  
D007  
13:40 -14:05  
************  
*************  
**************************  
GUIDE  
1
Press to display the Digital EPG  
screen.  
The EPG screen updates automatically if the  
EPG data is acquired successfully. If not, the  
Digital EPG screen shows a blank image.  
More...  
GUIDE  
4
Press to exit the Digital EPG  
screen.  
2
Select a TV programme.  
Setting timer programmes  
D007  
Using the Digital EPG, it’s easy to set digital  
2
TV programmes for recording .  
GUIDE  
1
Press to display the Digital EPG  
Select a programme.  
screen.  
ENTER  
• Press PREV/NEXT to skip to  
the next or previous channel list page.  
2
• Information about the selected  
D007  
programme appears in the information  
1
window.  
• To watch a programme currently on air,  
select the programme (then press  
ENTER).  
• You can check information about  
programmes scheduled up to one week  
ahead, depending on conditions.  
• Select a programme currently on-air:  
press ENTER to close the Digital EPG  
screen and watch the channel  
immediately, or press RED to set the  
programme for recording immediately.  
• Depending on conditions, it may take  
some time to acquire EPG data.  
INFO  
3
Press to view more information  
• Select a programme not yet started then  
press ENTER or RED to set the  
programme for recording.  
about the selected programme.  
Detailed information appears in the  
schedule window.  
If the screen contains further information,  
More ... is displayed.  
Note  
1 The general programme list does not show programmes that have already finished.  
2 For more information on timer programmes, see About timer recordings on page 68.  
52  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the digital electronic programme guide  
06  
3
Enter the timer recording settings.  
4
If you want to change the recording  
Use the ꢃ/ꢀ buttons to select a field; use  
the ꢁ/ꢂ buttons to change the value .  
mode, recording destination, etc., select  
‘Set Detailed’.  
In this area you can set:  
1
Record to – Select HDD for hard disk  
recording or DVD for DVD recording .  
Timer Programme Set  
Manhattan Open Tennis  
2
CH  
Date  
SUN 1/4  
Start  
18:00  
Stop  
19:00  
Extend  
Off  
3
D.TV003  
Recording Mode – Select from AUTO , XP,  
Store Programme  
SP, LP, EP, SLP, SEP (See Setting the picture  
quality/recording time on page 64). If Manual  
Recording is on, then you can also select the  
LPCM setting, XP+ or MN (press ENTER  
then use the ꢃ/ꢀ buttons to select the  
level).  
Detailed Settings  
Record To  
Recording Mode  
VPS/PDC  
Auto Replace Rec.  
Genre  
Enter Details  
HDD  
XP  
------  
------  
Set Detailed  
Set Title Name  
Cancel  
No Category  
VPS/PDC 0/8  
4
CH – Choose a channel (Pr 1 to Pr 99 for  
analog channels and available digital  
channels (excluding skip channels)), or  
one of the external inputs from which to  
record.  
VPS/PDC – Choose whether or not to use  
VPS/PDC when making timer recordings of  
analog programmes (see About timer  
recordings on page 68).  
Auto Replace Rec. – Automatically erases  
the previous daily or weekly recording when  
the next one is recorded.  
Date – Choose a date up to one month in  
advance, or select a daily or weekly  
programme.  
Genre – Select a record genre (for HDD  
recording only).  
Start – Set the recording start time.  
Stop – Set the recording end time  
(maximum length of a timer recording is  
24 hours).  
Extend – Extend the end time of the  
timer recording (select Off, 10, 20 or 30  
mins.)  
Note  
1 You cannot change the CH, Date, Start, Stop, Extend and title name when you have EPG Link set to On (see  
page 54).  
2 • For a DVD timer recording, if Optimized Rec (see Optimized Rec on page 135) is set to On (and VPS/PDC is  
off), the recorder will adjust the recording quality to try and fit the recording on the disc. If the recording will not  
fit onto the disc even on MN1 recording quality (MN4 for DVD+R/+RW) then the Recovery Recording feature  
will automatically make the recording to the HDD instead.  
• If there is very little free space left on the HDD, an Auto Replace Recording may not complete successfully.  
• If the HDD is being used for playback or high-speed copying when an Auto Replace Recording is due to start,  
the new timer recording will not replace the old one. However, the next time the timer recording starts, both of  
the older two programmes will be erased.  
3 This mode maximizes the recording quality to fit on to a single DVD disc. Can also be used when recording to  
HDD.  
4 • If you set the timer recording to use VPS/PDC, you must switch the recorder into standby before the timer  
recording is due to start for it to work correctly. For non-VPS/PDC timer recordings there is no need to switch  
the recorder into standby.  
• Optimized Recording will not work if VPS/PDC is on.  
• Up to eight timer recordings can be set with VPS/PDC.  
• VPS/PDC cannot be set for recordings made from digital broadcasts or an external input, or when the  
recording mode is set to AUTO.  
53  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the digital electronic programme guide  
06  
1
This screen shows all the timer programmes  
currently set.  
EPG Link (UK only) – Choose whether or not  
to have this device automatically record  
scheduled programmes from the Digital  
EPG even if the times in which they are  
broadcast change.  
Timer Programme View  
SUN 25/3 15:00  
VPS/PDC 0/8  
Manhattan Open Tennis  
Tmr Pgms 3/32  
OK  
SUN 25/3 18:00  
World Journey  
MON 26/3 19:30  
19:00  
21:00  
14:00  
Pr  
Pr  
Pr  
4
6
8
OK  
2
Series Recording (UK only) – Choose  
Flower  
Until 20/4  
whether or not to record all programmes  
from a series when you make a recording  
from the Digital EPG (for HDD recordings  
only).  
MON  
FRI 13:30  
New Input  
HDD Remain  
DVD Remain  
59h59m(SP)  
1h59m(SP)  
5
After entering all the timer recording  
information, highlight ‘Store  
Programme’ and press ENTER.  
A red clock icon appears for the programme.  
• Each row is for one timer recording  
programme, with the date and time  
information, channel, recording mode,  
DVD or HDD and recording status.  
GUIDE  
6
Press to exit the Digital EPG  
• The amount of free space available on  
the HDD and the currently loaded  
recordable DVD is shown towards the  
bottom of the screen.  
screen.  
Tip  
• In the upper-right corner, the number of  
timer programmes already set is shown  
next to Tmr Pgms.  
• To enter a title name for the timer  
recording in advance, select Set Title  
Name and follow the on-screen display.  
• If there are more than five timer  
programmes already set, press  
NEXT to switch page (go back using  
the PREV button).  
Editing a timer programme  
You can change any of the settings in a timer  
programme before the recording is due to  
start. Even if a programme is currently being  
recorded, you can program a new end time  
or edit its extend time parameter.  
• You can also delete a timer programme  
before it’s started (before the recorder  
enters timer recording standby) by  
highlighting it and pressing CLEAR. See  
also Deleting a timer programme on  
page 56.  
TIMER  
REC  
1
Press to display the Timer  
Programme View screen.  
You can also access the Timer Programme  
View screen from the Home Menu (press  
HOME MENU, select Timer Recording,  
then Timer Recording).  
Note  
1 • You cannot set an EPG Link when recording mode is set to AUTO.  
• You cannot change the CH, Date, Start, Stop, Extend and title name when you have EPG Link set to On.  
• When you have EPG Link set to On and you set a timer recording for a programme that is divided into multiple  
parts, all parts of that programme are recorded automatically. In the programme list, the earliest part of the  
programme to be recorded has a red  
by the broadcaster determines which programmes are classified as divided programmes.  
2 • In the programme list, the earliest programme to be recorded has a red icon, with successive programmes  
indicated by a gray icon.  
icon, with successive parts indicated by a gray  
icon. Data provided  
• There is a limit to the number of programmes you can schedule to record with the Series Recording function.  
• Data provided by the broadcaster determines which programmes are classified as part of a series.  
54  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the digital electronic programme guide  
06  
• Cancel Once – A regular timer  
programme is set to skip.  
2
Highlight the timer  
• Can’t Rec – Not possible to record.  
programme you want to change  
If you want to set a new timer programme,  
select ‘New Input’ and skip to step 4.  
.
Title Over – Can’t record because there  
is already the maximum number of titles  
on the disc (HDD: 999; DVD: 99).  
• Recording – The programme is currently  
ENTER  
recording.  
3
Press then select ‘Modify’  
• Standby – The recorder is in timer  
recording standby.  
from the command menu panel.  
Alternatively, press ENTER.  
• Valid Until ... (eg., Valid Until 13/8) (UK  
only) – When you have set to make a  
series recording of a programme that  
has no new scheduled broadcasts, the  
date displayed indicates the last day  
until which the scheduled programme  
settings remain valid. (If the programme  
is not broadcast for over 13 weeks, its  
settings are automatically deleted.)  
The Timer Programme Set screen appears  
from which you can edit the settings.  
ENTER  
4
Enter the timer recording  
settings.  
Use the ꢃ/ꢀ buttons to select a field; use  
the ꢁ/ꢂ buttons to change the value. For  
more information on the options available at  
the Timer Programme Set screen, See  
Setting timer programmes on page 52.  
• No Broadcast (UK only) – Displays when  
a programme for which you had the EPG  
Link set to On does not record because  
the date of the scheduled recording has  
already passed.  
ENTER  
5
After entering all the timer  
nothing displayed – Another timer  
recording or copying is in progress.  
recording information, highlight ‘Store  
Programme’ and press ENTER.  
The timer recording list screen is displayed  
again. The timer programme you just input  
appears in the list. The rightmost column  
shows various timer recording status  
messages:  
HOME MENU  
6
Press to exit the timer  
recording screen.  
Note  
• If you set a DVD timer recording but  
there is no recordable DVD disc loaded,  
or the disc loaded doesn’t have enough  
free space for the complete recording,  
Recovery is shown. In this case (unless  
you load a suitable disc before the  
recording actually starts), the recorder  
will use the HDD for recording. (The  
message Can’t Rec will appear if there  
are already 999 titles on the HDD or if  
there is not enough free space on the  
HDD for recording.)  
OK – Can be recorded.  
Time Over – Not enough space on the  
HDD (the recording won’t finish).  
Over 12h – Recording time of over 12  
hours set (when recording to the HDD  
the recording will be split into two titles).  
Overlap – Two timer programmes  
partially or completely overlap. The one  
starting earlier will take priority.  
Until ... (eg., Until 13/8) – For a regular  
recording, the last programme that  
could be recorded is shown.  
Data Over – Can’t record because the  
disc management area of the disc is full.  
55  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the digital electronic programme guide  
06  
• When you have EPG Link or Series  
Recording set to On, any changes in  
ENTER  
broadcast time or division of broadcasts  
are automatically accommodated for  
and your scheduled recordings are  
carried out without any additional  
settings. As a result, even when you have  
not scheduled programmes to record at  
the same time, changes in broadcasting  
schedules can cause scheduled  
3
Press then select ‘Cancel  
Once’ from the command menu panel.  
• In the timer programme list, Cancel  
Once appears by the programme.  
• You can also just press PAUSE when  
the timer programme is highlighted.  
Checking for alternative broadcast  
times  
(UK only)  
recordings to overlap.  
Deleting a timer programme  
You can delete timer programmes you no  
longer need.  
You can check to see if a programme you  
have scheduled to record is airing at an  
alternative time slot .  
1
TIMER  
REC  
TIMER  
REC  
1
Press TIMER REC.  
1
Press TIMER REC.  
2
Highlight the timer  
2
Highlight the timer  
programme you want to erase  
.
programme you want to search.  
ENTER  
ENTER  
3
Press then select ‘Erase’  
3
Press then select ‘Alternate  
from the command menu panel.  
Search’ from the command menu panel.  
• The search results are displayed.  
Choose the programme you would like to  
record and press either the RED button  
or ENTER to schedule a recording.  
• Select Yes to confirm or No to cancel.  
• You can also just press CLEAR when the  
timer programme is highlighted.  
Skipping a regular timer  
programme  
If you’ve set a regular daily or weekly timer  
programme, you can set the recorder to skip  
the next scheduled recording.  
Searching for series  
(UK only)  
You can search for broadcasts of  
programmes of the same series as a  
1
programme you have scheduled to record .  
TIMER  
REC  
TIMER  
REC  
1
Press TIMER REC.  
1
Press TIMER REC.  
2
Highlight the timer  
2
Highlight the timer  
programme you want to skip  
.
programme you want to search.  
Note  
1 • Programme search results are based upon data provided by the broadcaster.  
• This function may not be applicable to all programmes.  
56  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the digital electronic programme guide  
Other useful EPG functions  
06  
ENTER  
3
Press then select ‘Series  
Search’ from the command menu panel.  
• The search results are displayed.  
Choose the programme you would like to  
record and press either the RED button  
or ENTER to schedule a recording.  
EPG Jump  
1
Press GREEN when the Digital EPG  
screen (Programme List, Detailed  
information or Search Result) is  
displayed.  
Searching for recommendations  
(UK only)  
2
In the ‘Date’ field select a date  
You can search for recommended  
(within one week) to jump to.  
programmes generated from the content of  
the programmes you have scheduled to  
Date  
Time  
Mon.13.Sep  
14:00  
1
record .  
Jump  
Cancel  
TIMER  
REC  
1
Press TIMER REC.  
3
In the ‘Time’ field select a time  
of the day (0:00 to 23:00) to jump to.  
2
Highlight the timer  
programme you want to search.  
ENTER  
4
Select ‘Jump’.  
ENTER  
The Programme List for the specified day  
and time is displayed.  
3
Press then select  
‘Recommendation Search’ from the  
command menu panel.  
The search results are displayed. Choose the  
programme you would like to record and  
press either the RED button or ENTER to  
schedule a recording.  
EPG Search  
1
Press YELLOW when the EPG screen  
(Programme List, Detailed information or  
Search Result) is displayed.  
2
In the ‘Date’ field select a date  
(within one week) to search in.  
Date  
Sun.12.Sep  
12:00  
Time  
Genre  
Select  
0/16  
Search  
Cancel  
Note  
1 • Programme search results are based upon data provided by the broadcaster.  
• This function may not be applicable to all programmes.  
57  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the digital electronic programme guide  
06  
3
In the ‘Time’ field select the  
time of day (0:00 to 23:00) to search in.  
4
In the ‘Genre’ field, select the  
genre to search for.  
You can search for multiple genres by  
pressing ENTER after each genre.  
ENTER  
5
6
Select ‘OK’.  
ENTER  
Select ‘Search’.  
The results of your search are displayed.  
58  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recording  
07  
Chapter 7  
Recording  
About DVD recording  
Max.  
chapters  
(per title)  
Disc type/rec.  
format  
Max. titles  
(per disc)  
This recorder can record to DVD-R, DVD-  
RW, DVD+R, DVD+RW, DVD-RAM, DVD-R  
DL and DVD+R DL media.  
DVD-R/-RW  
Video mode  
99  
99  
49  
99  
DVD-R and DVD-RW discs can be initialized  
for Video mode or VR mode recording. Each  
has its advantages, and it depends on what  
you want to do with the recording which  
mode you choose.  
*1  
DVD-R/-RW/-RAM  
VR mode  
999  
*2  
DVD+R/+RW  
99  
If you want to edit your recordings in any  
significant way, VR mode offers greater  
possibilities for cutting, copying, and  
changing the way the video is presented.  
*1 A maximum of 999 chapters are recordable per disc.  
*2  
A maximum of 254 chapters are recordable per disc.  
• This recorder cannot play or record  
unfinalized DVD-R/-RW (Video mode)  
and DVD+R discs recorded on another  
recorder. DVD+RW discs recorded on  
another recorder are playable on this  
recorder but are not recordable.  
Video mode is less flexible when it comes to  
editing, but it has the advantage that it is  
compatible with standard DVD players  
1
(many of which won’t play VR mode discs ).  
Once a disc is initialized for a particular  
mode, all recording on that disc will be in  
that mode.  
• The maximum continuous recording  
time for one title is eight hours when  
using a DVD+R/+RW disc.  
DVD+RW discs can be initialized for +VR  
mode recording.  
• If you delete a title from a DVD+R/+RW  
disc, the total number of recordable  
titles remaining may not increase.  
DVD-RAM discs can be initialized for VR  
mode recording.  
• Although this recorder can record PAL,  
SECAM, NTSC and PAL-60, you can’t mix  
multiple TV line systems on one disc. A  
disc can contain PAL and SECAM  
recordings, or NTSC and PAL-60. See  
also Additional information about the TV  
system settings on page 141.  
DVD+R discs do not require initializing.  
Important  
• The table below shows the maximum  
number of titles recordable per disc and  
the maximum number of chapters per  
title:  
• Fingerprints, dirt and small scratches on  
a disc can affect playback and/or  
recording performance. Please take  
proper care of your discs.  
• Pioneer takes no responsibility for  
recording failure due to power cuts,  
defective discs, or damage to the  
recorder.  
Note  
1 Some DVD players, such as some Pioneer models, are compatible with VR mode discs. Check the operating  
instructions for your player for VR mode compatibility information.  
59  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recording  
07  
• See also Disc/content format playback  
compatibility on page 7 for detailed disc  
compatibility information.  
• It is possible to record both PAL and  
NTSC titles on the HDD. Before  
recording, you need to make sure that  
the Input Line System setting (page 141)  
matches the TV line system of the source  
you’re recording.  
Recording to DVD-R DL/DVD+R DL  
discs  
Recording to DVD-R DL/DVD+R DL discs is  
generally the same as recording to regular  
single-layer discs; however, please note the  
following points:  
HDD Video mode compatibility  
When recording to the HDD you can choose  
to record in one of two formats. Set the  
format from the HDD Recording Format  
item in the Initial Setup menu (see  
page 136).  
• When the recorder switches from the  
first layer to the second during recording  
a DVD-R DL (Video mode) disc, a new  
title is automatically started on the new  
layer.  
When set to Video Mode On, high-speed  
copying from HDD to DVD-R/-RW (Video  
mode) or DVD+R/+RW is possible. When  
recording a bilingual broadcast, set which  
channel you want to record from the Initial  
Setup menu (see Bilingual Recording on  
page 132).  
• Up to 99 titles can be recorded on a  
DVD-R DL (Video mode) disc. If the 99th  
title is being recorded when the layer is  
switched, recording will stop.  
• Up to 49 titles can be recorded on a  
DVD+R DL disc.  
When HDD Recording Format is set to Video  
Mode Off, high-speed copying from HDD to  
DVD-R/-RW (Video mode) or DVD+R/+RW  
isn’t possible. However, both channels of  
bilingual broadcasts are recorded and you  
can switch the audio on playback.  
• You cannot play, record additional  
material to, edit or finalize a DVD-R DL or  
DVD+R DL disc that has been recorded  
on but not yet finalized on another DVD  
recorder.  
Recorded audio  
About HDD recording  
In all except the LPCM mode, sound is  
recorded in two channel Dolby Digital format  
(only Dolby Digital 2.0 can be recorded; Dolby  
Digital 5.1 recording is not possible). When  
set to LPCM, sound is recorded in high  
quality, uncompressed Linear PCM format.  
Recording to the hard disk drive (HDD) is  
very flexible; you have the full choice of  
recording quality options, including manual  
mode, and of course you can record, erase  
and re-record as many times as you like.  
The capacity of the hard disk drive means  
that you can store many hours of video on it,  
even using the higher quality recording  
modes.  
If the broadcast audio is bilingual and you  
are recording to DVD-R/-RW (Video mode),  
DVD+R/+RW, or to the HDD with the HDD  
Recording Format set to Video Mode On, or  
on the LPCM setting, use the Bilingual  
Recording setting (page 132) to select the  
A/L or B/R audio channel to record before  
recording starts. In other cases, both  
Important  
• The maximum number of titles/chapters  
per title that can be recorded on the  
HDD is 999 and 99 respectively. No more  
recording is possible on the HDD after  
the maximum number of titles has been  
reached.  
channels of a bilingual broadcast will be  
recorded and you can switch on playback.  
• The maximum continuous recording  
time for one title is 12 hours.  
60  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recording  
07  
Copying of copyrighted material such as  
films or music is unlawful unless permitted  
by a legal exception or consented to by the  
rightowners.  
This product incorporates copyright protection  
technology that is protected by method claims of  
certain U.S. patents and other intellectual property  
rights owned by Macrovision Corporation and other  
rights owners. Use of this copyright protection  
technology must be authorized by Macrovision  
Corporation, and is intended for home and other limited  
viewing uses only unless otherwise authorized by  
Macrovision Corporation. Reverse engineering or  
disassembly is prohibited.  
Restrictions on video  
recording  
You cannot record copy-protected video  
using this recorder. Copy-protected video  
includes DVD-Video discs and some satellite  
broadcasts. If copy-protected material is  
encountered during a recording, recording  
will pause automatically and an error  
message will be displayed on-screen.  
Video that is ‘copy-once only’ can only be  
recorded to DVD-RAM or HDD, CPRM-  
compatible VR mode DVD-R/-RW (see  
below).  
Using the built-in A.TV and  
D.TV tuners  
When recording a TV broadcast or through  
an external input, you can display copy  
control information on screen (see  
Displaying disc information on-screen on  
page 84).  
Switching between A.TV and D.TV  
tuners  
CPRM  
A.TV/D.TV  
Press to switch between D.TV  
CPRM is a copy protection/scrambling  
system developed for the recording of ‘copy  
once’ broadcast programmes. CPRM stands  
for Content Protection for Recordable Media.  
(digital) and A.TV (analog).  
Changing channels  
There are a number of ways to select analog  
and digital TV channels. Note that you can’t  
This recorder is CPRM compatible, which  
means that you can record copy-once  
1
broadcast programmes, but you cannot then  
make a copy of those recordings. CPRM  
recordings can only be made on CPRM-  
compatible DVD-R (ver. 2.0/8x or higher) or  
DVD-RW (ver. 1.1 or higher) discs formatted  
in VR mode, DVD-RAM discs or on the HDD.  
change the TV channel during playback,  
recording or during recording standby.  
CHANNEL  
+
CHANNEL  
Smart Jog  
DVD CPRM recordings can only be played  
on players that are specifically compatible  
with CPRM.  
Number buttons  
For example, to select channel 4 (digital  
channel D004), press 4 then ENTER; for  
channel 34 (digital channel D034), press  
Recording equipment and  
copyright  
Recording equipment should be used only  
for lawful copying. You are advised to check  
carefully what constitutes lawful copying in  
the country in which you are making a copy.  
2
3, 4, ENTER.  
CH +/– buttons on the front panel.  
• For D.TV channels only, you can also use  
the Channel List — see below.  
Note  
1 • If you select a locked channel, you will need to enter your password to access it.  
• While listening to D.TV radio channels, the screen saver automatically starts after no button has been pressed  
for three minutes.  
61  
En  
2 Analog channel presets are numbered 1 to 99; digital channel presets are numbered D001 to D999.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recording  
07  
• The channel banner displays the Subtitles  
) and Teletext/MHEG ( ) icon if they  
Tip  
(
• When changing terrestrial digital  
broadcast channels, channels with a low  
signal strength may result in a black  
screen being displayed.  
apply to the selected channel.2  
• To see more detailed channel  
information, press INFO again.  
3
Now  
11:30-12:00  
************************  
• For other channels, it may take a short  
while for the channel picture to appear,  
and/or for the channel number to appear.  
More...  
Use the ꢁ/ꢂ buttons to display  
• In both of the above cases, some  
improvement may be possible by  
adjusting the antenna.  
information about previous and following  
programmes. Use the ꢃ/ꢀ buttons to  
see information about other channels.  
Using the D.TV Channel List  
• If there is still more information to be  
displayed, More ... is displayed; press  
the BLUE button to see the extra  
information.  
When in D.TV mode, you can call up the on-  
screen Channel List anytime by pressing ENTER  
Use the ꢁ/ꢂ buttons to select a channel, then  
press ENTER to switch to that channel.1  
.
• To hide the channel banner, press  
RETURN/EXIT.  
D001  
D002  
D003  
D004  
D005  
D006  
************  
************  
******  
Changing D.TV audio languages  
************  
****  
AUDIO  
Press to display the current audio  
******  
language. Press repeatedly to change it  
to other available languages.  
Displaying a channel banner  
A channel banner shows programme titles,  
start and end times of the current  
Changing D.TV subtitle languages  
programme and other channel information.  
The information is updated every minute.  
SUBTITLE  
Press to display the current  
subtitle language. Press repeatedly to  
change it to other available languages.  
INFO  
Press to display the channel  
banner for the current channel.  
Using the MHEG application  
(UK only)  
D001  
Wed.30.Apr 12:46  
************  
Now  
Next  
11:30-12:00  
12:00 - 12:30  
********************  
*************  
Some stations bring you programmes with  
the MHEG (Multimedia and Hypermedia  
Expert Group) application encoded, letting  
• Use the ꢃ/ꢀ buttons to display the  
channel banner for other channels. To  
switch to the displayed banner’s  
channel, press ENTER.  
4
you experience D.TV interactively.  
Note  
1 • If you select a locked channel, you will need to enter your password to access it.  
• While listening to D.TV radio channels, the screen saver automatically starts after no button has been pressed  
for three minutes.  
2 Due to inaccurate information provided by the broadcaster, some icons may occasionally be present or absent  
in error.  
3 Not all channels supply more detailed information.  
4 If you start recording while the MHEG application is running, the MHEG application screen will also be  
recorded. To avoid this, quit the application first, then start recording. It is not possible to start the MHEG  
application while recording is in progress.  
62  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recording  
07  
• You can also select the language for a  
non-NICAM bilingual broadcast.  
The channel banner displays an icon ( ) to  
indicate that the MHEG application can be  
run.  
A (L)  
B (R)  
TEXT  
A + B (L+R)  
Press to start the MHEG  
• When watching a recording made from  
an external input with Bilingual  
recording selected (see External Audio  
on page 132), you can switch the audio  
channel between left (L), right (R) or both  
(L+R).  
1
application.  
• You can also use any of the colour  
buttons.  
• Press TEXT to quit the MHEG  
application.  
L
R
Viewing Teletext  
(European countries except the UK.)  
L+R  
You can view the Teletext that comes  
simultaneously with certain programmes.  
Note  
• When recording to the HDD with HDD  
Recording Format set to Video Mode On,  
to DVD-R/-RW (Video mode), to DVD+R/  
+RW, or on the LPCM setting, only one  
channel of a bilingual broadcast is  
recorded. In this case, decide which  
language you want to record before  
recording by setting the Bilingual  
Recording setting (see Bilingual  
TEXT  
Press to display the Teletext.  
• You can also use any of the colour  
buttons.  
• Press the TEXT button again to hide the  
Teletext screen.  
Changing A.TV audio channels  
You can change the audio channel of the  
broadcast or external input signal.  
Recording on page 132).  
Switching between TV and DVD  
When the recorder is stopped or recording  
you can choose whether to have the audio/  
video from the built-in TV tuner (or external  
input) play on your TV (‘DVD mode’), or  
watch the channel that the TV is currently set  
to (‘TV mode’).  
AUDIO  
Press to change the audio type.  
The current audio channel is displayed on-  
screen.  
• If the NICAM audio setting (see NICAM  
Select on page 132) is set to NICAM and  
you are watching a NICAM broadcast,  
you can switch between NICAM and  
Regular (non-NICAM) audio.  
During playback or when a menu is being  
displayed on-screen, the sound and video is  
always routed to your TV and is unaffected by  
the TV/DVD mode setting.  
NICAM  
Regular  
Note that the recorder must be connected to  
your TV using a SCART cable to be able to  
use this feature.  
• If the NICAM broadcast is bilingual, you  
can also select the language.  
NICAM A  
Regular  
NICAM B  
TV/DVD  
NICAM A+B  
Switch between TV mode and  
DVD mode.  
Note  
63  
En  
1 This function is not available when subtitle display is active.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recording  
07  
SLP (Super Long Play) – Lower quality  
than EP, but gives about eight hours of  
recording time on a DVD disc.  
Setting the picture quality/  
recording time  
SEP (Super Extended Play) – Lowest  
video quality but gives about ten hours of  
recording time on a DVD disc.  
DVD (VR) DVD (Video) DVD+R DVD+RW DVD-RAM HDD  
Before starting a recording, you will usually  
want to set the picture quality/recording  
time. There are six standard settings  
available, which allow you to choose a  
balance between picture quality and  
recording time.  
1
2
MN1 to MN32/LPCM /XP+ – Manual/  
Linear PCM/XP+ (available only when  
manual recording is on).  
The setting is indicated in the front panel  
display, and shown on-screen together with  
the recording time for a blank recordable  
disc. If a recordable disc is loaded, the  
approximate remaining recording time for  
that disc is also shown. (Note that if the On  
Screen Display setting (see On Screen  
Display on page 139) is Off then this  
information is not displayed.)  
When Manual Recording is set to On (see  
Manual Recording on page 135), a further  
option will be available (MN1 to MN32,  
LPCM, or XP+ (a super-high quality HDD  
recording mode that features a transfer rate  
of around 15 Mbps) depending on what you  
set).  
When recording to DVD, MN32 is the  
highest recording quality available. If you  
select XP+, the recording mode will  
automatically revert to MN32.  
Basic recording from the TV  
DVD (VR) DVD (Video) DVD+R DVD+RW DVD-RAM HDD  
When recording to DVD+R/+RW, SLP is the  
longest recording time available. If you  
select SEP or MN1 to MN3, the recording  
mode will automatically revert to SLP.  
Basic recording from the TV involves just  
setting the channel to record, choosing  
whether to record to the HDD or a DVD and  
selecting the recording quality.  
REC MODE  
HDD/DVD  
Press repeatedly to select the  
recording quality.  
1
Select the HDD or DVD for  
XP – High quality setting, gives about  
one hour of recording time on a DVD  
disc.  
recording.  
• If you’re recording to DVD, load a  
recordable disc (if you load a new blank  
DVD-RW or DVD+RW disc, the recorder  
takes a short while to initialize the disc).  
SP (Standard Play) – Default quality,  
used for most applications, gives about  
two hours of recording time on a DVD.  
• If you want to record a VR mode DVD-R  
or a Video mode DVD-RW, you must  
initialize it before proceeding (see  
Initializing recordable DVD discs on  
page 72).  
LP (Long Play) – Lower video quality than  
SP, but doubles the recording time on a  
DVD to about four hours.  
EP (Extended Play) – Lower quality than  
LP, but gives about six hours of  
recording time on a DVD disc.  
A.TV/D.TV  
2
Press to switch between D.TV  
(digital) and A.TV (analog).  
Note  
1 Audio is recorded in 16-bit Linear PCM format, video is recorded at XP quality. When recording a bilingual  
broadcast, select which audio channel to record (see Bilingual Recording on page 132).  
2 Applicable only to HDD recording. (If this setting is used when recording to DVD, MN32 is used.) When copied  
to DVD, XP+ recordings are always copied in real time.  
64  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recording  
07  
REC  
CHANNEL  
+
7
Start recording.  
CHANNEL  
3
Select a TV channel to record.  
If you want to set a recording end time, press  
the REC button repeatedly. The recording  
time increases in 30 minute increments, up  
to a maximum of six hours. The time the  
recording will end is shown on-screen and in  
the front panel display. When the recording  
ends, the recorder automatically switches  
into standby if no other operation is being  
performed.  
The front panel display shows the channel  
number, or channel name if it’s available:  
A.TV Channel preset  
• While the recorder is stopped, you can  
also use the number buttons on the  
remote to select the channel (For  
channel 24, press 2, 4 then ENTER).  
• To cancel the set recording time, press  
REC.  
• If the recorder is stopped, you can also  
use the CH +/– buttons on the front  
panel to select the channel number.  
REC MODE  
• If you want to pause recording at any  
1
time , press PAUSE. Press again to  
restart the recording (If recording to the  
HDD, DVD-RAM or in VR mode, a new  
chapter is started after recording  
restarts).  
4
Set the picture quality/recording  
time.  
• See Setting the picture quality/recording  
time on page 64 for detailed instructions.  
STOP REC  
AUDIO  
8
Press to stop recording.  
• If you set the recording time in the  
previous step, you can still stop the  
recording anytime by pressing  
STOP REC.  
5
If you’re recording from the A.TV  
tuner, select the audio channel to record.  
See Changing A.TV audio channels on  
page 63 for more on this.  
• When recording in VR mode, if a  
broadcast is bilingual, both audio  
channels are recorded, allowing you to  
switch the audio channel on playback.  
The only exception to this is when the  
picture quality is set to LPCM, in which  
case you do need to select the audio  
channel before recording.  
• Recording will stop automatically when  
there is no more space on the HDD/  
DVD, or after 12 hours of HDD recording  
(whichever is sooner).  
Tip  
• During recording you can turn on/off the  
SCART loop through function. During  
recording, press the front panel CH +  
button to switch to SCART THRU (loop  
through on), or CH – to switch to SCART  
NORM (loop through off). Loop through  
is automatically reset to off after  
recording has finished. Note that you  
can’t switch loop through on if recording  
from the AV1(RGB)-TV connector.  
AUDIO  
6
If you’re recording from the D.TV  
tuner, select the audio language to  
record.  
• You may also be able to set which  
subtitle language to record; use  
SUBTITLE to select.  
• Note that audio and subtitle languages  
cannot be changed during the recording  
of a digital broadcast.  
Note  
65  
En  
1 Except during Chase Play.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recording  
07  
1
Connect this recorder to your TV with  
Pause Live TV  
a SCART cable.  
2
3
Press HOME MENU.  
Select ‘Initial Setup’ > ‘Options2’ >  
HDD  
The Pause Live TV feature lets you effectively  
pause a TV programme you’re watching.  
When you’re ready to resume watching, just  
press the PLAY button.  
‘Pause Live TV’ > ‘TV’s Tuner’.  
4
Select ‘Initial Setup’ > ‘Analog Tuner’  
> ‘Auto Channel Setting’ > ‘Download  
from TV’.  
• If the Download from TV option appears  
grayed out, check the connections to  
your TV and try again.  
Setting up for Pause Live TV  
You can use the Pause Live TV feature with  
an AV Link-compatible TV connected using a  
SCART cable (see TV tuner setup for Pause  
Live TV below), or using this recorder’s  
internal tuner (see Using the recorder’s  
internal tuner for Pause Live TV below).  
• Depending on your TV, you might have to  
switch off and unplug it for a few  
moments before plugging it back in and  
switching it on again.  
5
Follow the on-screen instructions.  
TV tuner setup for Pause Live TV  
To use this feature with an external TV tuner,  
the recorder must be connected to your TV  
using a SCART cable, and the AV. Link  
setting (page 139) should be set to This  
Using the recorder’s internal tuner for  
Pause Live TV  
If you haven’t connected to your TV using a  
SCART cable (or your TV is not compatible  
with AV Link) you can use the recorder’s  
internal tuner for the Pause Live TV.  
1
Recorder Only. See also Pause Live TV on  
page 140 for more on this.  
1
2
Press HOME MENU.  
Select ‘Initial Setup’ > ‘Options2’ >  
In order to use Pause Live TV, make the  
following connections and settings.  
‘Pause Live TV’ > ‘Recorder’s Tuner’.  
• Pause Live TV will not work as expected  
when watching TV via an external  
component such as a VCR or digital  
tuner. It only works with the channel  
selected on the TV.  
See Pause Live TV on page 140 to do this.  
You can record the channel selected on the  
recorder.  
Important  
• Pause Live TV only works with the built-in  
A.TV (analog) tuner. It does not work with  
the D.TV tuner or the external inputs.  
Make sure the Auto Channel Setting is  
set to Download from TV (see Auto  
Channel Setting on page 130).  
Note  
1 • Not all TVs support this feature. Check the instructions that came with your TV if you are unsure.  
• This feature will not work unless your TV is compatible with AV Link. See the operating instructions that came  
with your TV if you’re unsure about your TV’s compatibility with this feature.  
66  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recording  
07  
Using Pause Live TV  
Tip  
PAUSE  
LIVE TV  
• When the Pause Live TV setting (see  
page 140) is set to TV’s Tuner, you can  
press PAUSE LIVE TV while the recorder  
is in standby to switch on and immediately  
start recording. When set to Recorder’s  
Tuner, it is not possible to use the Pause  
Live TV feature from standby.  
1
Start recording the current TV  
channel.  
Recording continues with playback paused.  
• Note that it may take up to 10 seconds  
for recording to start.  
2
Press to start playback.  
• After pressing PAUSE LIVE TV, it will  
take at least 10 seconds for the picture to  
change (during this time, all controls  
except the power button are inoperative).  
(Note that startup from standby is not  
possible if you have selected Recorder’s  
Tuner in Pause Live TV on page 140.)  
• Please note that you can’t record from  
another component (VCR, etc.) that is  
connected by a SCART cable to the AV2  
(INPUT 1/DECODER) connector using  
the Pause Live TV feature.  
You can also use the scan buttons (ꢈ/  
), pause (PAUSE) and stop (STOP)  
— all without affecting the recording.  
STOP REC  
3
Press to stop the recording.  
The operation is slightly different depending  
on the viewing source. See the Operation  
table below for details.  
Operation table  
TV/DVD  
mode of DVR source  
DVR  
Pause Live TV  
function button  
Viewing source  
Condition  
TV built-in analog  
tuner  
TV  
Pause Live TV  
Preset channel of DVR and TV are  
matched after downloading from TV.  
Direct TV  
recording*1  
Preset channel of DVR and TV are NOT  
matched after downloading from TV.  
Record TV programme that you’re watching.  
TV built-in digital  
tuner  
TV  
Direct TV  
recording*1  
Preset channel info. in D.TV cannot be  
shared by DVR even after Download from  
TV. Record TV programme that you’re  
watching.  
External input of TV  
TV  
Direct TV  
recording*1  
Record TV programme that you’re  
watching.  
DVR built-in analog  
tuner  
DVD  
DVD  
DVR built-in Pause Live TV  
analog tuner  
DVR built-in digital  
tuner  
DVR built-in Pause Live TV  
digital tuner  
*1 No Chase Play! Warning if you change input this will stop the recording.  
67  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recording  
07  
About timer recordings  
Important  
• A timer recording can’t be set if there are  
already 32 timer programmes waiting to  
be recorded.  
DVD (VR) DVD (Video) DVD+R DVD+RW DVD-RAM HDD  
Using the timer recording features you can  
program up to 32 timer recordings up to a  
month in advance. Timer recording  
programmes can be set to record just once,  
every day, or every week.  
• Timer recording will not start if:  
– The recorder is already recording.  
– A disc is being initialized, finalized or  
unfinalized.  
• Timer recording will start when the  
operation preventing timer recording  
has finished.  
You can set the recording quality for your  
timer recording in the same way as for a  
regular recording, but with the added option  
of an AUTO mode, which maximizes the  
recording quality for the space available on  
the disc (if recording to DVD), or to fit on to a  
blank DVD disc (if recording to the HDD).  
• When the front panel display is set to  
ON, the timer indicator ( ) lights in the  
front panel display when the timer is  
active. If the indicator is blinking it  
means that (for a DVD timer recording)  
there is no disc loaded, or the disc  
loaded is not recordable (for an HDD  
timer recording it means that the HDD is  
not recordable).  
You can set timer recordings to record to a  
recordable DVD or to the hard disk drive. For  
regular (daily or weekly) HDD timer  
recordings that you don’t need to keep, you  
can use the Auto Replace Recording feature  
to automatically replace the previous timer  
recording with the new one. Note that when  
you use this feature, the previous recording  
made on that timer programme will be  
replaced by the next one, regardless of  
whether you have watched it yet or not.  
• Approximately two minutes before a  
timer recording is set to start, the  
recorder will go into timer recording  
standby. In timer recording standby you  
cannot use some functions.  
• The maximum length for timer  
You can also set the recorder so that it will  
adjust the recording quality to try and fit the  
recording on to the disc if it would not  
otherwise fit at the recording quality you set  
(see Optimized Rec on page 135 for more on  
this).  
recordings made to the HDD is 24 hours.  
However, because one title (HDD) is  
limited to 12 hours, recordings over 12  
hours will be spread over two titles. Note  
that there will be a break in the recording  
of a few seconds between titles.  
Finally, if you set a timer recording to record  
to DVD but there isn’t a recordable DVD  
loaded at the time of the recording, the  
Recovery Recording feature will  
automatically record the programme to the  
HDD for you.  
• VPS/PDC works only with analog  
stations; it does not work with digital TV  
stations.  
• VPS/PDC may not work with all  
broadcast stations in your country/area.  
Check with the stations for compatibility.  
This recorder is compatible with VPS (Video  
Programming System) and PDC  
(Programme Delivery Control) systems used  
by many analog TV stations to ensure that a  
timer recording catches the whole  
programme even when the programme is  
not running to schedule. Up to eight timer  
programmes can be set with VPS/PDC on.  
• The hours between 3:00 and 5:00 in the  
morning are used by the GUIDE Plus+  
system to download programme  
information. During these times, VPS/  
PDC may not work reliably; leave VPS/  
PDC off if you set a timer recording for  
these times.  
68  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recording  
07  
• If VPS/PDC is active for two timer  
programmes that are programmed to  
start at the same time, then the  
programme that actually starts first  
takes priority.  
2
[Front panel] Press and hold for  
three seconds to lock the controls.  
The front panel display briefly shows  
LOCKED. If any buttons are pressed on the  
remote or front panel, LOCKED is briefly  
displayed again.  
Extending a timer recording in  
progress  
• To unlock the recorder, press and hold  
(Stop) on the front panel (while the  
recorder is stopped) for three seconds  
until the display shows UNLOCKED.  
You can extend a timer recording beyond the  
programmed end time. This can be useful if  
a broadcast programme overruns, for  
example.  
Timer recording FAQ  
Cancelling or extending the timer  
Frequently Asked Questions  
REC  
• Even though the timer is set, the recorder  
doesn’t start recording!  
1
Press and hold for three seconds  
during a timer recording.  
Recording continues, but the timer indicator  
disappears from the front panel display  
indicating that the timer has been cancelled.  
Check that the disc loaded or HDD is  
recordable, not locked (see Lock Disc on  
page 121), and that there are fewer than  
99/999 titles already on the DVD/HDD.  
REC  
• The recorder won’t let me enter a timer  
programme! Why not?  
You can’t enter a timer programme if the  
clock isn’t set.  
• What happens when two or more timer  
programmes overlap?  
2
Press repeatedly to extend  
recording in 30 minute blocks.  
Stopping a timer recording  
STOP REC  
Basically, the programme with the earlier  
recording start time has priority.  
1
Press during a timer recording.  
However, the recorder will start recording  
the programme with the later start time  
after the earlier programme is finished. If  
schedule to record two programmes  
have the same times (but different  
channels, for example), then only one of  
the two programmes will be recorded. In  
this event you should cancel the  
ENTER  
2
Select ‘Yes’ to confirm.  
Preventing use of the recorder  
before a timer recording (child  
lock)  
You can make all the front panel and remote  
control buttons inoperative using the child  
lock feature. This is useful when you set a  
timer recording and want to make sure that  
the timer settings are not changed before  
recording has finished.  
scheduled recording of the lesser  
important programme. If one of the  
overlapping programmes is a regular  
timer programme for a digital broadcast,  
you may choose ‘Cancel Once’ in order  
to avoid having it overlap with a  
separately scheduled programme (see  
Skipping a regular timer programme on  
STANDBY/ON  
1
If the recorder is on, switch it  
page 56)  
.
into standby.  
69  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recording  
07  
Also, during simultaneous recording  
and playback, if the TV line system of the  
playback track/title changes then  
playback will automatically stop.  
Simultaneous recording and  
playback (Chase Play)  
HDD  
Recording from an external  
component  
Chase Play allows you to watch a recording  
that is still in progress from the start, without  
having to wait until the recording has  
finished (i.e., playback is ‘chasing’ the  
recording).  
DVD (VR) DVD (Video) DVD+R DVD+RW DVD-RAM HDD  
You can record from an external component,  
such as a camcorder or VCR, connected to  
one of the recorder’s external inputs.  
In fact, you’re not just limited to watching  
the recording in progress. You can watch  
anything else already on the HDD (or on a  
DVD if you’re recording to the HDD) by  
selecting it from the Disc Navigator screen  
(see Using the Disc Navigator with recordable  
discs and the HDD on page 78).  
1
Make sure that the component you  
want to record from is connected  
properly to the HDD/DVD recorder.  
See Chapter 2 (Connecting up) for  
connection options.  
Chase Play is not possible when DV is the  
recording input.  
INPUT SELECT  
2
Press repeatedly to select one of  
Press during recording to start  
the external inputs to record from.  
The current input is shown on-screen and in  
the front panel display:  
playback from the beginning of the  
1
current recording .  
2
AV2/L1 – Input 1  
DISC  
Press during recording to select  
NAVIGATOR  
L2 – Input 2 (front panel)  
another title to play.  
L3 – Input 3  
You can use all the usual playback controls,  
such as pause, slow-motion play, scan and  
skip.  
Check that the Audio In settings for  
External Audio and Bilingual Recording  
are as you want them (see Audio In on  
page 132).  
• To stop playback, press STOP  
(recording will continue).  
• If the aspect ratio is distorted (squashed  
or stretched), adjust on the source  
component or your TV before recording.  
• To stop recording, press STOP REC  
(playback will continue).  
• During recording or in timer recording  
standby, you can’t play an HDD title,  
DVD or Video CD/Super VCD disc if the  
Input Line System setting doesn’t match  
the TV line system of the disc/HDD title  
(see also Additional information about  
the TV system settings on page 141).  
• To watch video coming in via the DV  
input (front panel), select DV > DV  
Video Playback from the Home Menu  
(see also Playing from a DV camcorder on  
page 85).  
REC MODE  
3
Set the recording quality.  
• See Setting the picture quality/recording  
time on page 64 for detailed information.  
Note  
1 You can’t start playback immediately after recording starts. Simultaneous playback and recording doesn’t work  
while copying or backing up.  
2 This cannot be selected if AV2/L1 In is set to Decoder (see AV2/L1 In on page 132).  
70  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recording  
07  
HDD/DVD  
Finalizing a disc  
4
Select the HDD or DVD for  
DVD (VR) DVD (Video) DVD+R DVD+RW  
recording.  
REC  
Finalizing ‘fixes’ the recordings on the disc  
so that it can be played on a regular DVD  
player or computer equipped with a suitable  
5
Press to start recording.  
• If your source is copy-protected using  
Copy Guard, you will not be able to  
record it. See Restrictions on video  
recording on page 61 for more details.  
1
DVD-ROM drive.  
Note that the disc name will appear in the  
title menu after you finalize a disc. Make sure  
the disc name is as you want it before you  
finalize the disc as it can’t be changed  
afterwards. If you want to rename the disc,  
see Input Disc Name on page 121 before  
starting the steps below.  
Playing your recordings on  
other DVD players  
DVD (VR) DVD (Video) DVD+R DVD+RW  
DVD+RW discs don’t generally need  
finalizing. However, if you want a title menu  
to appear when you play the disc, then you  
will need to finalize. When using a  
DVD+RW, you can still record and edit even  
after finalizing. although the title menu will  
disappear if you do so. Finalize the disc  
again to generate a new title menu.  
Most regular DVD players can play finalized  
discs recorded in DVD-R/-RW (Video mode)  
and DVD+R discs. A number of players  
(including many Pioneer models) can also  
play DVD-RW discs recorded in VR mode,  
finalized or not. Most players will not play VR  
mode DVD-R discs, although some DVD-  
ROM drives and DVD recorders may be able  
to (finalization might be necessary). Check  
the manual that came with the player to  
check what kinds of discs it will play.  
Important  
• Once you’ve finalized a DVD-R/-RW  
(Video mode) or DVD+R disc, you can’t  
edit or record anything else on that disc.  
However, the finalization on a DVD-RW  
disc maybe ‘undone’; see Undo Finalize  
on page 122 for how to do this.  
When you finalize a DVD-R/-RW (Video  
mode) or DVD+R disc, a title menu is  
created from which you can select titles  
when you play the disc. There are a number  
of different styles of title menu to choose  
from to suit the content of the disc.  
• A VR mode DVD-R/-RW (excluding DVD-  
R DL) disc can still be recorded and  
edited on this recorder even after  
finalizing.  
All the title menus are navigated in the usual  
way, pressing MENU or TOP MENU to  
display the menu, then using the ꢁ/ꢂ/ꢃ/  
followed by ENTER to select titles and  
start playback.  
• DVD-R DL (Video mode) discs and  
DVD+R DL discs must be finalized in  
order to play in other recorders/players.  
Note however that some recorders/  
players will not play even finalized dual-  
layer discs.  
Note  
1 If the TV line system of the disc is different to the current setting of the recorder, you will not be able to finalize  
the disc. See Additional information about the TV system settings on page 141 for how to change the recorder’s  
setting.  
71  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recording  
07  
1
Load the disc you want to finalize.  
5
The recorder will now start finalizing  
Make sure that the recorder is stopped  
the disc.  
before proceeding.  
During finalization:  
2
HOME MENU  
Select ‘Disc Setup’ from the  
• If the finalization process of a DVD-RW  
or DVD+R/+RW disc is going to take  
more than around four minutes, you can  
press ENTER to cancel. Around four  
minutes before completion, the option to  
cancel disappears.  
Home Menu.  
ENTER  
3
Select ‘Finalize’ > ‘Finalize’ >  
‘Next Screen’.  
• You can’t cancel the finalization of a VR  
mode DVD-R disc.  
Disc Setup  
Next Screen  
Start  
Basic  
Finalize  
Undo Finalize  
Initialize  
Finalize  
• How long finalization takes depends on  
the type of disc, how much is recorded  
on the disc and the number of titles on  
the disc. A disc recorded in VR mode can  
take up to one hour to finalize. DVD-R/  
-RW (Video mode) and DVD+R/+RW  
discs can take up to 20 minutes.  
Optimize HDD  
ENTER  
4
For DVD-R/-RW (Video mode)  
Initializing recordable DVD  
discs  
and DVD+R/+RW discs only, select a title  
menu style, then select ‘Yes’ to start  
finalization or ‘No’ to cancel.  
The menu you select will be the one that  
appears when the ‘top menu’ (or ‘menu’ for  
a DVD+R/+RW) is selected on any DVD  
player.  
DVD-R DVD-RW DVD+RW DVD-RAM  
DVD-R/-RW discs can be initialized for either  
Video mode recording or VR mode  
1
recording.  
Finalize  
When you first load a blank DVD-RW or  
DVD+RW disc, the recorder initializes it for  
recording automatically. By default, blank  
DVD-RW discs are initialized for VR mode  
recording. See DVD-RW Auto Initialize on  
page 73 if you want to change the default to  
Video mode.  
• Discs recorded partially or fully on the  
Pioneer DVR-7000 DVD recorder do not  
support this feature. These discs will  
have only a text title menu when finalized  
on this recorder.  
DVD-R discs are ready for Video mode  
recordings out of the box; if you want to use  
a DVD-R for VR mode recording, you must  
initialize it before recording anything on the  
disc.  
DVD+RW and DVD-RAM discs can also be  
initialized in order to erase the contents of  
the disc.  
Note  
1 If a disc was previously finalized on an older DVD recorder, you may not be able to re-initialize and/or initialize  
it for Video mode recording.  
72  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recording  
07  
DVD-RW Auto Initialize  
Important  
• Initializing a DVD-RW, DVD+RW or  
DVD-RAM disc will erase everything  
recorded on it. Make sure there is  
nothing on the disc that you want to  
keep!  
DVD-RW  
• Default setting: VR Mode  
Initialization mode is automatically carried  
out when you insert a blank DVD-RW. You  
must set the desired initialization mode  
before inserting a disc.  
• You may not be able to re-initialize a  
DVD-RW disc in a different format if it  
was originally initialized on an older DVD  
recorder.  
HOME MENU  
1
Select ‘Disc Setup’ from the  
• Once initialized for VR mode recording,  
you can’t re-initialize a DVD-R back to  
Video mode.  
Home Menu.  
ENTER  
HOME MENU  
1
Select ‘Disc Setup’ from the  
2
Select ‘Basic’>’DVD-RW Auto  
Home Menu.  
Init.’, then ‘VR Mode’ or ‘Video Mode’.  
Disc Setup  
ENTER  
VR Mode  
Basic  
Input Disc Name  
Lock Disc  
2
Select ‘Initialize’ > ‘Video  
Video Mode  
Initialize  
Finalize  
DVD-RW Auto Init.  
Mode’, ‘VR Mode’ or ‘Initialize  
DVD+RW’.  
Optimize HDD  
Disc Setup  
Start  
Start  
Start  
Basic  
VR Mode  
Initialize  
Finalize  
Video Mode  
Initialize DVD+RW  
Optimize HDD  
ENTER  
3
Select ‘Start’.  
It takes about 30 seconds to initialize the  
disc (except DVD-RAM discs, which can take  
up to an hour).  
Initializing Disc  
Pr 1  
1 min left  
73  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Playback  
08  
CPhlaapteyr b8 ack  
• Some DVD-Video, DVD+R and  
DVD+RW discs don’t allow certain  
playback controls to operate at certain  
points in the disc. This is not a  
malfunction.  
Introduction  
Most of the features described in this  
chapter make use of on-screen displays.  
Navigate these using the cursor buttons and  
ENTER. To go back one level from any  
screen, use the RETURN/EXIT button.  
HDD/DVD  
1
Select the HDD or DVD for  
playback.  
• If playing video from the HDD, skip to  
step 3 below.  
Remember also that the button guide at the  
bottom of every screen shows which buttons  
do what.  
Many of the functions covered in this  
chapter apply to the HDD, DVD discs, Video  
CDs, Super VCDs, WMA/MP3/DivX discs  
and CDs, although the exact operation of  
some varies slightly with the kind of disc  
loaded.  
• Select DVD for any kind of disc playback.  
OPEN/CLOSE  
2
[Front panel] Load a disc.  
Load a disc with the label side facing up,  
using the disc tray guide to align the disc (if  
you’re loading a double-sided DVD-Video  
disc, load it with the side you want to play  
face down).  
• Many functions are not available when a  
Video CD is playing in PBC mode. Start  
playback from the Disc Navigator screen  
for non-PBC playback (see Using the  
Disc Navigator with playback-only discs  
on page 79).  
• If you want to play a DTS audio CD,  
please first read the note on page 76.  
3
Start playback.  
• If you’re playing a DVD-Video or Video  
CD, a disc menu may appear when you  
start playback. Use the ꢁ/ꢂ/ꢃ/ꢀ  
buttons, number buttons, and ENTER to  
navigate DVD disc menus, and the  
number buttons and ENTER for Video  
CD menus.  
• For discs that contain JPEG picture files,  
see The PhotoViewer on page 113.  
Basic playback  
A L L  
• When playing video from the HDD,  
playback will automatically stop after the  
end of a title is reached.  
This section shows you how to use your  
recorder for playback of discs (DVD, CD,  
etc.), and for playback of video from the  
HDD.  
• There may be a slight pause when  
playback switches from the first to the  
second layer of a dual-layer disc.  
Important  
• See the following sections for more  
details on playing specific kinds of discs.  
• Throughout this manual, the term ‘DVD’  
means any kind of playable or recordable  
DVD. If a function is specific to a  
particular kind of DVD disc, it is  
specified.  
STOP  
4
5
Press to stop playback.  
When you’ve finished using the  
recorder, eject the disc and switch the  
recorder back into standby.  
74  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Playback  
08  
Playing DVD discs  
/  
/ꢍ  
While paused, press and hold  
to start slow-motion playback.  
Press repeatedly to change the  
playback speed.  
The table below shows the basic playback  
controls for DVD-Video, and recordable DVD  
discs.  
While paused, press to advance  
a single frame in either direc-  
tion. You can also execute  
frame-by-frame playback/back-  
ward scanning via the  
Press to start playback.  
If RESUME is displayed on-  
screen, playback starts from  
the place last stopped.  
Smart Jog.  
Press to stop playback.  
STOP  
You can resume playback from  
the same point by pressing  
PLAY. (Press STOP again  
to cancel the resume function.)  
TOP MENU  
Press to display the menu of a  
DVD-Video disc. (DVD+R/+RW  
discs finalized on this recorder  
will display the Disc Navigator.  
Press MENU to display the disc  
menu.)  
MENU  
DISC  
NAVIGATOR  
PAUSE  
Pauses playback, or restarts  
playback when paused.  
Use the cursor buttons to navi-  
gate DVD-Video disc menus;  
press ENTER to select items.  
Press to start scanning. Press  
repeatedly to increase the scan-  
ning speed.  
ENTER  
RETURN/EXIT  
PREV  
NEXT  
Press to return to the previous  
level of a DVD-Video disc menu.  
Press to skip to previous/next  
chapter/title. (During playback  
you can also use the front panel  
CH +/– buttons.)  
DVD+R/DVD+RW only:  
PREV may not always skip  
to the previous title.  
Playing from the HDD  
The table below shows the basic playback  
controls when playing video recorded on the  
hard disk (HDD).  
Except VR mode: During play-  
back, enter a chapter number  
then press ENTER to skip  
directly to that chapter within  
the currently playing title.  
On some discs, you can also  
use the number buttons to  
select numbered items in the  
disc menu.  
VR mode only: During playback,  
enter a title number then press  
ENTER.  
All: Press CLEAR to clear a  
number entry and start again.  
Press to start playback.  
If RESUME is displayed on-  
screen, playback starts from  
the place last stopped. Play-  
back automatically stops after  
the end of a title is reached.  
CLEAR CLEAR  
ENTER  
Press to stop playback.  
You can resume playback from  
the same point by pressing  
PLAY. (Press STOP again  
to cancel the resume function.)  
STOP  
PAUSE  
Pauses playback, or restarts  
playback when paused.  
(Commercial back/skip)  
CM BACK  
CM SKIP  
Press to start scanning. Press  
repeatedly to increase the scan-  
ning speed.  
Turn the Smart Jog counter-  
clockwise for backward skip;  
turn clockwise for forward skip.  
You can search up to two hours  
in either direction.  
75  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Playback  
08  
PREV  
NEXT  
Press to skip to previous/next  
chapter/title. (During playback  
you can also use the front panel  
CH +/– buttons.)  
Except WMA: Press to start  
scanning. Press again to  
increase the scanning speed.  
(There are two scan speeds; the  
current scan speed is shown  
on-screen.)  
During playback, enter a title  
number then press ENTER to  
skip directly to that title.  
Press CLEAR to clear a number  
entry and start again.  
PREV  
NEXT  
Press to skip to previous/next  
track (or folder for WMA/MP3  
disc). (During playback you can  
also use the front panel CH +/–  
buttons.)  
CLEAR CLEAR  
ENTER  
During playback, enter a track  
number then press ENTER to  
skip directly to that track.  
Press CLEAR to clear a number  
entry and start again.  
(Commercial back/skip)  
CM BACK  
CM SKIP  
Turn the Smart Jog counter-  
clockwise for backward skip;  
turn clockwise for forward skip.  
You can search up to two hours  
in either direction.  
CLEAR CLEAR  
ENTER  
/  
/ꢍ  
While paused, press and hold  
to start slow-motion playback.  
Press repeatedly to change the  
playback speed.  
Playing Video CD/Super VCDs  
The table below shows the basic playback  
controls for Video CD/Super VCDs.  
While paused, press to advance  
a single frame in either direc-  
tion. You can also execute  
frame-by-frame playback/back-  
ward scanning via the  
Some discs feature Playback Control (PBC  
for short) menus. These discs show PBC in  
the display when you load them and display  
a menu on-screen from where you can select  
Smart Jog.  
2
what to watch.  
Press to start playback.  
Video CD only: If RESUME is dis-  
played on-screen, playback  
starts from the place last  
stopped.  
Playing CDs and WMA/MP3 discs  
The table below shows the basic playback  
1
controls for audio CDs , and WMA/MP3  
files.  
Press to start playback.  
Press to stop playback.  
STOP  
Video CD only: You can resume  
playback from the same point  
by pressing PLAY. (Press  
STOP again to cancel the  
resume function.)  
Press to stop playback.  
STOP  
PAUSE  
Pauses playback, or restarts  
playback when paused.  
Note  
1 If you want to play a DTS audio CD, make sure the recorder is connected to a DTS-compatible amp/receiver with  
a digital connection. Noise will be output through the analog outputs. Also make sure that STEREO is selected  
using the  
AUDIO button (see Switching audio channels on page 83).  
2 When playing in PBC mode, some playback features, such as search, repeat and programme play are not  
available. You can play a PBC Video CD/Super VCD in non-PBC mode by starting playback using the Disc  
Navigator (see Using the Disc Navigator with playback-only discs on page 79).  
76  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Playback  
08  
Playing DivX video files  
PAUSE  
Pauses playback, or restarts  
The table below shows the basic playback  
controls for DivX video files.  
playback when paused.  
Press to start scanning. Press  
repeatedly to increase the scan-  
ning speed.  
Press to start playback.  
If RESUME is displayed on-  
screen, playback starts from  
the place last stopped. Play-  
back of titles (DivX files) pro-  
ceeds in alphabetical order.  
PREV  
NEXT  
Press to skip to previous/next  
track.  
When a PBC menu is dis-  
played, press to display the pre-  
vious/next page. (During  
playback you can also use the  
front panel CH +/– buttons.)  
Press to stop playback.  
STOP  
You can resume playback from  
the same point by pressing  
PLAY. (Press STOP again  
to cancel the resume function.)  
During playback, enter a track  
number then press ENTER to  
skip directly to that track.  
Press CLEAR to clear a number  
entry and start again.  
While a PBC menu screen is  
displayed, use to select num-  
bered menu items.  
PAUSE  
Pauses playback, or restarts  
playback when paused.  
CLEAR CLEAR  
ENTER  
Press to start scanning. Press  
repeatedly to increase the scan-  
ning speed.  
PREV  
NEXT  
Press to skip to previous/next  
title. (During playback you can  
also use the front panel CH +/–  
buttons.)  
Video CD in non-PBC mode only:  
(Commercial back/skip)  
CM BACK  
CM SKIP  
Turn the Smart Jog counter-  
clockwise for backward skip;  
turn clockwise for forward skip.  
You can search up to two hours  
in either direction.  
/ꢍ  
While paused, press to advance  
one frame. Press and hold to  
start slow motion playback  
(press repeatedly to change the  
slow motion play speed). You  
can also execute frame-by-  
frame playback via the  
/ꢍ  
While paused, press and hold  
to start slow-motion playback.  
Press repeatedly to change the  
playback speed (forward only).  
While paused, press to advance  
a single frame (forward only).  
You can also execute frame-by-  
frame playback via the  
Smart Jog.  
AUDIO  
Press to display the playback  
audio type; press repeatedly to  
change the playback audio  
type.  
Smart Jog.  
RETURN/EXIT  
Press to display the disc menu  
of a Video CD/Super VCD play-  
ing in PBC mode.  
SUBTITLE  
Press to display subtitle  
information; press repeatedly to  
change subtitles.  
77  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Playback  
08  
Using the Disc Navigator to  
browse the contents of a disc  
ENTER  
4
Play the highlighted title.  
• You can also select Play from the  
command menu options.  
Use the Disc Navigator to browse the  
contents of a disc and start playback.  
Changing the display style of the  
Disc Navigator  
Using the Disc Navigator with  
recordable discs and the HDD  
You can choose to display titles in the Disc  
Navigator in various different ways, sorted  
alphabetically, by recording date, by genre,  
and so on. You can also choose whether to  
display four or eight titles on the screen at  
the same time.  
DVD-R DVD-RW DVD+R DVD+RW DVD-RAM HDD  
You can use the Disc Navigator to browse  
and edit video on recordable DVDs and the  
HDD, and to view information on titles.  
See also Editing on page 88 for more on  
editing recordable discs.  
1
Display the View Options  
panel.  
HDD/DVD  
1
2
Select the HDD or DVD.  
Open the Disc Navigator.  
The View Options panel  
DISC  
NAVIGATOR  
Disc Navigator (HDD)  
10Titles  
23:00 FRI 3/12 Pr  
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr  
4
4
SP  
SP  
Style  
4
Disc Navigator (HDD)  
10  
Titles  
10Titles  
2h00m(1.0G)
Sort order  
23:00 FRI 3/12 Pr  
4
SP  
SP  
7
20:00 FRI 3/12 Pr  
20:00 Fri 3/12 Pr  
9
9
SP  
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr  
4
SP  
2h00m(1.0G)  
SP  
SP  
1h00m(1.0G)  
Recent first  
2h00m(1.0G)
MENU  
4
Titles  
Genre  
9
8
7
20:00 FRI 3/12 Pr  
20:00 Fri 3/12 Pr  
9
9
SP  
22:00 THU 2/12 Pr  
22:00 Thu 2/12 Pr  
7
7
SP  
2h00m(1.0G)  
SP  
SP  
1h00m(1.0G)  
All Genres  
Recent first  
All Genres  
MENU  
22:00 THU 2/12 Pr  
22:00 Thu 2/12 Pr  
7
7
19:00 MON 29/11 Pr  
19:00 Mon 29/11 Pr  
2
2
SP  
SP  
HDD  
SP  
Remain  
30h30m  
1h00m(1.0G)  
19:00 MON 29/11 Pr  
19:00 Mon 29/11 Pr  
2
2
SP  
SP  
HDD  
SP  
1h00m(1.0G)  
Remain  
30h30m  
ENTER  
• You can also access the Disc Navigator  
from the Home Menu.  
2
Choose ‘Style’, ‘Sort order’ or  
‘Genre’, then press ENTER to see the  
available view options.  
Style – Select four or eight titles per  
screen view  
3
Browse the list of titles.  
• You can also use the Smart Jog to select  
titles.  
Sort order – Sort by date (most recent  
first), unwatched first, title name or  
recording date (oldest first)  
• Use the PREV/ꢇ NEXT buttons to  
display the previous/next page of titles.  
Genre – Display all genres or just a  
• To change the thumbnail picture  
displayed for a title see Set Thumbnail on  
page 93.  
selected genre  
ENTER  
3
Choose a view option, then  
• For HDD recordings, you should be able  
to see a thumbnail title digest. If it  
doesn’t display, set Set Preview to  
Normal. See Set Preview on page 139.  
press ENTER.  
The title list display is updated according to  
the new display preferences.  
78  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Playback  
08  
Using the Disc Navigator with  
playback-only discs  
1
During playback, start reverse  
or forward scanning.  
• The scanning speed is shown on-screen.  
WMA/MP3  
DVD-Video CD Video CD Super VCD  
DivX  
2
Press repeatedly to change the  
scanning speed.  
HOME MENU  
1
Display the Home Menu.  
There are four scanning speeds available  
when playing HDD video, a DVD or a DivX  
title. Reverse playback is also possible with  
ENTER  
2
Select ‘Disc Navigator’.  
2
HDD and DVD video.  
Alternatively, for a CD, Video CD, Super VCD  
or WMA/MP3/DivX disc, you can press DISC  
NAVIGATOR, which takes you straight to  
the Disc Navigator screen.  
There are two scanning speeds for other  
types of disc.  
3
Resume normal playback.  
ENTER  
3
Select what you want to play.  
Playing in slow motion  
Depending on the type of disc you have loaded,  
the Disc Navigator looks slightly different, but  
they are all navigated in the same way.  
DVD HDD Video CD Super VCD DivX  
The screen below shows a WMA/MP3/DivX  
disc. Navigate to the folder, or the track/title  
within a folder that you want to play.  
You can play video at various slow motion  
speeds. DVDs and video on the HDD can be  
played in slow motion in either direction,  
while Video CDs/Super VCDs and DivX titles  
can only be played forwards in slow motion.  
Disc Navigator  
Folder (01-03)  
01.Rock  
Track(001-004)  
001.Intro  
CD  
There is no sound when playing in slow  
motion.  
WMA/MP3  
Divx  
02.Pop  
03.Dance  
002.Escape  
003.Everything You Say  
004.What I Do  
PAUSE  
1
2
Pause playback.  
/  
/ꢍ  
Press and hold to start slow  
Playback starts after you press ENTER.  
motion reverse or forward play.  
• For discs that contain CD-Audio tracks  
and WMA/MP3 tracks or DivX titles, you  
can switch the playback area between  
CD, WMA/MP3 and DivX. This can only  
be done while the disc is stopped.  
/  
/ꢍ  
3
Press repeatedly to change  
the slow motion speed.  
The current playback speed is indicated on-  
screen.  
4
Resume normal playback.  
Scanning discs  
A L L  
(except WMA)  
You can scan discs at various speeds,  
1
forwards or backwards.  
Note  
1 • No subtitles are displayed when scanning DVDs and DivX titles.  
• No sound is output when scanning from the HDD, DVDs and DivX, except on forward SCAN 1.  
• Depending on the disc, normal playback may automatically resume when a new chapter is reached on a DVD  
disc.  
79  
En  
2 Reverse playback may not be smooth.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Playback  
08  
Frame advance/frame  
reverse  
ENTER  
1
Select ‘Search Mode’ from the  
Play Mode menu, then choose a search  
option.  
DVD HDD Video CD Super VCD DivX  
The available search options depend on the  
type of disc.  
You can advance or back up video on a DVD  
disc or the HDD frame-by-frame.  
1
With Video CDs/Super VCDs and DivX titles,  
you can only use frame advance.  
2
Enter a title/chapter/folder/  
PAUSE  
track number or a search time.  
1
2
Pause playback.  
Play Mode  
/  
/ꢍ  
Time Search  
Title Search  
Input Time  
0.01.00  
Search Mode  
A-B Repeat  
Repeat  
Back up or advance one  
Chapter Search  
frame with each press.  
• You can also do this by rotating the  
Smart Jog.  
Programme  
3
Resume normal playback.  
Time Search (HDD, DVD): For example, for 25  
minutes into the current title, press 2, 5, 0, 0.  
For 1 hour and 15 minutes and 20 seconds  
into the title, press 1, 1, 5, 2, 0.  
The Play Mode menu  
Time Search (Video CD): For example, for  
2 minutes and 30 seconds into the current  
track, press 2, 3, 0.  
A L L  
The Play Mode menu gives you access to  
search functions, repeat and programme  
play functions.  
Title/Chapter/Folder/Track Search: For  
example, for track 6, press 6.  
HOME MENU  
Select ‘Play Mode’ from the  
ENTER  
3
Start playback.  
Home Menu.  
Play Mode  
A-B Repeat  
Time Search  
Title Search  
Chapter Search  
Search Mode  
A-B Repeat  
Repeat  
DVD HDD CD Video CD DivX  
Programme  
The A-B Repeat function allows you to  
specify two points (A and B) within a track or  
title that form a loop which is played over  
3
Search Mode  
and over.  
A L L  
ENTER  
The Search Mode feature lets you start  
1
During playback, select ‘A-B  
playback from a specified point in a disc by  
Repeat’ from the Play Mode menu.  
2
time or by title/chapter/folder/track  
number.  
Note  
1 Depending on the disc, normal playback may automatically resume when a new chapter is reached.  
2 When using time search, playback may occasionally start slightly before or after the time you input.  
3 If you switch camera angles on a DVD during A-B repeat play, A-B repeat is cancelled.  
80  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Playback  
08  
ENTER  
2
With ‘A (Loop Start)’  
ENTER  
Select ‘Repeat’ from the Play  
highlighted, press at the point you want  
the loop to start.  
Mode menu, then choose a repeat play  
mode.  
Play Mode  
A (Loop Start)  
B (Loop End)  
Off  
Search Mode  
A-B Repeat  
Repeat  
Play Mode  
Repeat Title  
Repeat Chapter  
Repeat Off  
Search Mode  
A-B Repeat  
Repeat  
Programme  
Programme  
ENTER  
3
With ‘B (Loop End)’ highlighted,  
• To resume normal playback, select  
Repeat Off from the Repeat Play menu,  
or press CLEAR if no menu OSD (such as  
the Play Mode menu) is displayed.  
press at the point you want the loop to  
end.  
Playback immediately jumps back to the  
start point and plays the loop round and  
round.  
Programme play  
• When playing a DVD-Video, DVD-R/-RW  
(Video mode), DVD+R/+RW, or from  
the HDD, the start and end points of the  
loop must be in the same title.  
WMA/MP3  
HDD DVD-Video CD Video CD Super VCD  
This feature lets you program the play order  
2
of titles/chapters /folders/tracks on a disc or  
• To resume normal playback, select Off  
from the A-B Repeat menu, or press  
CLEAR if no menu OSD (such as the Play  
Mode menu) is displayed.  
the HDD.  
ENTER  
1
Select ‘Programme’ from the  
Play Mode menu, then ‘Input/Edit  
Programme’.  
The Input/Edit Programme screen varies  
according to the disc type. Below is the DVD  
input screen.  
Repeat play  
A L L  
There are various repeat play options,  
depending on the kind of disc loaded, or if  
you’re using the HDD for playback. It’s also  
possible to use repeat play together with  
programme play to repeat the tracks/  
chapters in the programme list (see  
Programme  
Step  
01.001  
02.  
03.  
04.  
05.  
06.  
07.  
08.  
Title (01-03)  
Title 01  
Title 02  
Chapter(001-015)  
Chapter 001  
Chapter 002  
Chapter 003  
Chapter 004  
Chapter 005  
Chapter 006  
Chapter 007  
Chapter 008  
Title 03  
1
Programme play below).  
ENTER  
2
Select a title, chapter, folder  
or track for the current step in the  
programme list.  
Note  
1 If you switch the camera angle during repeat play of a DVD-Video disc, repeat play is cancelled.  
2 When playing a programme list of DVD-Video chapters, chapters not included in the programme list may be  
sometimes be played, depending on the disc.  
81  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Playback  
08  
After pressing ENTER to add the title/  
chapter/folder/track, the step number  
automatically moves down one.  
• From the programme menu you can  
also:  
Start Programme Play – Starts  
playback of a saved programme list  
Cancel Programme Play – Turns off  
programme play, but does not erase the  
programme list  
Erase Programme List – Erases the  
programme list and turns off  
programme play  
• To insert a step into the programme list,  
highlight the step number where you  
want to insert another step, then select a  
chapter/title/folder/track as usual. After  
pressing ENTER, all the subsequent  
steps move down one.  
• To delete a step from the programme list,  
highlight the step you want to delete,  
then press CLEAR.  
Displaying and switching  
subtitles  
3
Repeat step 2 to build up a  
programme list.  
A programme list can contain up to 24 titles/  
chapters/folders/tracks.  
DVD-Video DivX  
Some DVD and DivX discs have subtitles in  
one or more languages; the disc box will  
usually tell you which subtitle languages are  
available. You can switch subtitle language  
4
Play the programme list.  
Programme play remains active until you  
cancel programme play, erase the  
programme list, eject the disc or switch off  
the recorder.  
1
during playback.  
Check the disc packaging for details of the  
subtitle options.  
Tip  
SUBTITLE  
• To save your programme list and exit the  
programme edit screen without starting  
playback, press HOME MENU.  
Select/change the subtitle  
language.  
The current subtitle language is shown on-  
screen and in the front panel display.  
• During programme play, press ꢇ  
NEXT to skip to the next programme  
step.  
• To switch off subtitles, press  
SUBTITLE then CLEAR.  
• To repeat play the programme list, select  
Programme Repeat from the Repeat  
Play Mode menu (see Repeat play on  
page 81).  
Switching DVD and DivX  
soundtracks  
• Press CLEAR during playback to switch  
off programme play (if no menu OSD,  
such as the Disc Navigator, is  
DVD-Video DivX  
displayed). Press while stopped to erase  
the programme list.  
When playing a DVD disc or DivX title  
recorded with two or more soundtracks  
(often in different languages), you can  
2
switch the soundtrack during playback.  
Note  
1 • Some discs only allow you to change subtitle language from the disc menu. Press MENU or TOP MENU to  
access.  
• To set subtitle preferences, see Subtitle Language on page 134.  
2 • Some discs only allow you to change audio language from the disc menu. Press MENU or TOP MENU to  
access.  
82  
En  
• To set audio language preferences, see Audio Language on page 134.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Playback  
08  
Check the disc packaging for details of the  
soundtrack options.  
HDD DVD (VR) DVD-RAM  
L+R – Both channels (default)  
L – Left channel only  
R – Right channel only  
AUDIO  
Change the audio soundtrack.  
The current audio language is shown on-  
screen and in the front panel display.  
WMA/MP3  
CD Video CD  
• The sound may drop out for a few  
seconds when switching soundtracks.  
Stereo – Stereo (default)  
1/L – Left channel only  
2/R – Right channel only  
• Some discs feature both Dolby Digital  
and DTS soundtracks. There is no analog  
audio output when DTS is selected. To  
listen to the DTS soundtrack, connect  
this recorder to a DTS decoder or AV  
amp/receiver with built-in DTS decoder  
via the digital output. See Connecting to  
an AV amplifier/receiver on page 20 for  
connection details.  
Super VCD  
1 Stereo – Soundtrack 1/Stereo (default)  
1 L – Soundtrack 1/Left channel  
1 R – Soundtrack 1/Right channel  
2 Stereo – Soundtrack 2/Stereo  
2 L – Soundtrack 2/Left channel  
2 R – Soundtrack 2/Right channel  
Switching audio channels  
DVD (VR) DVD-RAM HDD CD Video CD Super VCD  
WMA/MP3  
Switching camera angles  
DVD-Video  
1
For HDD and VR mode content recorded  
Some DVD-Video discs feature scenes shot  
from two or more angles — check the disc  
box for details: it should be marked with a  
icon if it contains multi-angle scenes.  
When a multi-angle scene is playing, the  
same icon appears on screen to let you know  
that other angles are available (this can be  
switched off if you prefer — see Angle  
Indicator on page 137).  
with bilingual audio, you can switch between  
left (L) channel, right (R) channel, or both  
2
(L+R).  
When playing Video CDs and audio CDs you  
can switch between stereo, just the left  
channel or just the right channel.  
Some Super VCDs have two soundtracks.  
With these discs you can switch between the  
two soundtracks as well as individual  
channels in each.  
ANGLE  
Switch the camera angle.  
• The angle number is displayed on-  
screen.  
AUDIO  
Press repeatedly to display/switch  
the audio channel.  
The audio channel(s) currently playing are  
indicated on-screen.  
• If the disc was paused, playback starts  
again with the new angle.  
Note  
1 Only when HDD Recording Format is set to Video Mode Off (HDD Recording Format on page 136).  
2 When playing a Bilingual recording on a VR mode disc, if you are listening to the Dolby Digital soundtrack via  
the digital output, you cannot switch the audio channel. Set Dolby Digital Out to Dolby Digital PCM (see  
Dolby Digital Out on page 133) or listen via the analog outputs if you need to switch the audio channel.  
83  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Playback  
08  
Shows recording restrictions for  
the current channel programme  
Displaying disc information  
on-screen  
Stop  
DVD-RW VR  
Original  
ABC Pr 1  
Stereo  
Copy Once  
Resume  
You can display various on-screen  
information about the disc loaded or the  
HDD.  
XP (1h00m/DVD)  
Finalized  
Rem. 0h35m  
Disc Name  
:
Comedy shows  
DVD Mode  
DISPLAY  
Indicates copy-protected material  
Indicates a multi-angle scene  
Display/change the on-screen  
information.  
Play  
3–2  
0. 00. 15  
!
• Press once to show the HDD and  
removable disc (DVD, etc.) activity  
together. Press again to show the status  
of just the currently selected playback/  
recording device (HDD or removable  
disc).  
DVD-R Video Chapter Time 0. 00. 21  
Chapter Total 0h01m52s  
ꢅꢅꢅꢅꢅꢅꢅ  
4.32Mbps  
Title Name  
:
21/11 Football match  
Indicates the data transfer rate  
• To hide the information display, press  
DISPLAY repeatedly until it disappears.  
Tip  
• See Switching camera angles on page 83  
for more on multi-angle scene  
switching.  
HDD and removable disc activity  
display  
Press DISPLAY once to see the HDD and  
removable disc (DVD, etc.) activity. Use the  
HDD/DVD button to switch between the two  
kinds of display.  
• When using the simultaneous play and  
record feature, the display shows  
information for playback only.  
• During real-time copy, the copy source  
playback information is displayed.  
The example displays below show high-  
speed copying from HDD to DVD, and HDD  
chase playback.  
• The Video mode DVD-R/-RW displays  
become the same as a DVD-Video disc  
once the disc is finalized.  
Rec Mode SP(2h00m/DVD)  
• The total recording time figure shown in  
parenthesis is calculated based on a  
12 cm/4.7 GB disc at the displayed  
record setting.  
HDD  
Hi-Speed Copy  
HDD DVD  
DVD-RW Video  
Remain 10h35m  
Stop  
Remain –h––m  
Stop  
0h08m left  
• Recording and playback times for TV  
recordings are approximately 0.1 %  
shorter than the actual time. This is  
because of the slightly different frame  
rates of TV broadcasts versus DVD.  
Rec Mode SP(2h00m/DVD)  
HDD  
DVD-RW Video  
Remain 10h35m  
Chase Play  
Rec  
Remain 0h52m  
Stop  
• The frame number is shown next to the  
elapsed time display when the disc is  
paused.  
Recording time  
Copy Once or Can’t Record messages  
may appear in the stop or recording  
displays. These indicate that the  
broadcast TV programme contains copy  
control information.  
Relative playback position  
84  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Playing and recording from a DV camcorder  
09  
Chapter 9  
Playing and recording from a  
DV camcorder  
You can play back and record video from a  
DV camcorder connected to the DV IN jack  
on the front panel of this recorder.  
• The recorder will only start recording  
from the DV IN jack if there is a valid  
signal. Recording will pause if the signal  
is interrupted during recording.  
Important  
• If your source is copy-protected using  
Copy Guard, you will not be able to  
record it. See Restrictions on video  
recording on page 61 for more details.  
• If you connect a second recorder using a  
DV cable, you cannot control the second  
unit from this one.  
• You can’t control this unit remotely from  
a component connected to the DV IN  
jack.  
Recording from a DV  
camcorder  
• The source signal must be DVC-SD  
format.  
Playing from a DV camcorder  
• You can’t record date and time  
information from DV cassette.  
1
Make sure your DV camcorder is  
connected to the front panel DV IN jack.  
From the Initial Setup menu, check  
• During DV recording, if a part of the tape  
is blank, or has copy-protected material  
on it, this recorder will pause recording.  
Recording will restart automatically  
when there is a recordable signal.  
However, if there is more than two  
minutes of blank tape, this recorder will  
stop recording and the camcorder  
should stop (depending on the  
2
that the DV audio input is setup as you  
would like.  
See DV Input on page 133 for more on this.  
• Check also that the Audio In settings for  
External Audio and Bilingual  
Recording are as you want them (see  
Audio In on page 132).  
camcorder).  
HOME MENU  
3
Select ‘DV’, then ‘DV Video  
Playback’ from the Home Menu.  
Copying from a DV source  
Using the recorder’s remote, you can control  
both the camcorder and this recorder.  
4
Start playback on the camcorder.  
Images from the camcorder should appear  
on your TV.  
• To record the incoming video, press  
HDD/DVD to select the HDD or a DVD  
for recording, then press REC. Press  
STOP REC to finish recording.  
If there is no signal from the device  
connected to the DV jack, or the signal is  
copy-protected, recording will pause. It  
will automatically restart once there is a  
recordable signal.  
Important  
• Some camcorders cannot be controlled  
using this recorder’s remote.  
• For best results when recording from a  
DV camcorder to this recorder, we  
recommend cueing the camcorder to  
the place you want to start recording  
from and setting the camcorder to  
play-pause.  
85  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Playing and recording from a DV camcorder  
09  
1
Make sure your DV camcorder is  
• If you restart recording after stopping the  
connected to the front panel DV IN jack.  
Also, set the camcorder to VTR mode.  
camcorder, the first few seconds of the  
camcorder tape will not be recorded.  
Use the pause button on your camcorder  
instead and recording will start  
immediately.  
REC MODE  
2
Set the recording quality.  
• See Setting the picture quality/recording  
time on page 64 for detailed information.  
HDD, DVD (VR Mode) and DVD-RAM only:  
A chapter marker is inserted every time  
there is a break in the timecode on the  
DV tape. This happens when the  
recording is stopped or paused then  
restarted, for example.  
3
From the Initial Setup menu, check  
that the DV audio input is setup as you  
would like.  
See DV Input on page 133 for more on this.  
• Check also that the Audio In settings for  
External Audio and Bilingual  
Recording are as you want them (see  
Audio In on page 132).  
• If you don’t want to see the DV recording  
screen during recording, press DISPLAY  
to hide it (press again to display).  
• While recording, you cannot exit the DV  
recording screen using the HOME  
MENU or RETURN/EXIT button.  
HOME MENU  
4
Select ‘DV’, then ‘Copy from a  
DV Source’ from the Home Menu.  
• DV recording only works when the DV  
camcorder is in VTR mode with a tape  
loaded.  
DV Auto Copy  
DV Auto Copy allows you to make an exact  
copy of the contents of a DV source to the  
HDD or a DVD.  
ENTER  
5
Select ‘Record to Hard Disk  
Drive’ or ‘Record to DVD’.  
Find the place on the camcorder tape  
1
Make sure your DV camcorder is  
connected to the front panel DV IN jack.  
6
that you want to start recording from.  
For best results, pause playback at the point  
from which you want to record.  
Also, set the camcorder to VTR mode.  
REC MODE  
2
Set the recording quality.  
• See Setting the picture quality/recording  
time on page 64 for detailed information.  
• Depending on your camcorder, you can  
use this recorder’s remote to control the  
camcorder using the , , , ,  
, and buttons.  
3
From the Initial Setup menu, check  
that the DV audio input is setup as you  
require.  
See DV Input on page 133 for more on this.  
ENTER  
7
Select ‘Start Rec’.  
• Check also that the Audio In settings for  
External Audio and Bilingual  
Recording are as you want them (see  
Audio In on page 132).  
Stop  
1.02.22  
Stop  
Control with these  
Start Rec  
Pause Rec  
Stop Rec  
buttons  
HOME MENU  
4
Select ‘DV’, then ‘DV Auto  
Copy’ from the Home Menu.  
• DV recording only works when the DV  
camcorder is in VTR mode with a tape  
loaded.  
HDD  
Rem.  
SP (2h00m/DVD)  
32h45m  
• You can pause or stop the recording by  
selecting Pause Rec or Stop Rec from  
the on-screen display. You cannot  
control the camcorder from this remote  
control during recording.  
86  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Playing and recording from a DV camcorder  
09  
• There’s a picture, but no sound!  
ENTER  
Try switching the DV Input setting (see  
5
Select ‘Record to Hard Disk  
DV Input on page 133) between Stereo 1  
Drive’ or ‘Record to DVD’.  
1
and Stereo 2.  
The DV tape is rewound to the beginning.  
Once it is rewound, the DV tape is played  
from the beginning and copied to either the  
HDD or a DVD.  
About DV  
Using DV, also known as i.LINK or IEEE 1394-  
1995, you can connect a DV camcorder to  
this recorder using a DV cable for input of  
audio, video, data and control signals.  
• If there is a gap of two minutes or more  
between recorded contents, the copying  
process is automatically stopped.  
• Once copying is finished, the DV tape is  
automatically rewound.  
“i.LINK” and the “i.LINK” logo are  
trademarks.  
• To cancel the copying process, press  
STOP REC for more than three  
seconds.  
• This recorder is only compatible with DV-  
format (DVC-SD) camcorders. Digital  
satellite receivers and Digital VHS video  
recorders are not compatible.  
About automatic finalization  
If you use a DVD-R/-RW (Video mode) or  
DVD+R/+RW disc for copying, it will  
automatically be finalized after copying is  
complete.  
• You cannot connect more than one DV  
camcorder at a time to this recorder.  
• You cannot control this recorder from  
external equipment connected via the  
DV IN jack.  
• You can’t customize the background for  
DVD-R/-RW or DVD+R/+RW disc  
finalization.  
• It may not always be possible to control  
the connected camcorder via the DV IN  
jack.  
• No title names are assigned.  
• DV camcorders can usually record audio  
as stereo 16-bit/48 kHz, or twin stereo  
tracks of 12-bit/32 kHz. This recorder can  
only record one stereo audio track. Set  
the DV Input setting as required (see DV  
Input on page 133).  
• If you want to give the disc a name,  
please do so before you start the copy  
(see Input Disc Name on page 121).  
• If a timer recording is scheduled to start,  
and in some other instances, the disc  
will not be finalized.  
• Audio input to the DV IN jack should be  
32 kHz or 48 kHz (not 44.1 kHz).  
Frequently Asked Questions  
• Picture disturbance in the recording  
may occur if the source component  
pauses playback or plays an unrecorded  
section of tape, or if the power fails in the  
source component, or the DV cable is  
disconnected.  
• I can’t get my DV camcorder to work with  
the recorder!  
Check that the DV cable is properly  
connected. Also make sure that what  
you’re trying to record is not copy-  
protected.  
• The DV IN jack is an input only. There is  
no output functionality.  
If it still doesn’t work, try switching off  
the camcorder then switch back on.  
Note  
1 If the audio subcode on the DV tape cannot be read correctly, the audio type will not switch automatically. You  
can switch the audio manually from the External Audio setting (page 132).  
87  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Editing  
10  
CEhdapitetri1n0 g  
Editing options  
The table below shows which commands you can use with the HDD and different disc types.  
DVD-R/-RW  
(Video mode),  
DVD+R/+RW  
DVD-R/-RW, DVD-RAM  
HDD  
(VR mode)  
Original  
Play List  
Create (page 90)  
Play (page 90)  
Erase (page 90)  
Edit > Title Name (page 91)  
Edit > Set Thumbnail  
(page 93)  
Edit > Erase Section  
(page 93)  
Edit > Divide (page 94)  
Edit > Chapter Edit  
(page 94)  
Edit > Set Genre (page 95)  
Edit > Lock (page 96)  
Edit > Move (page 96)  
Edit > Combine (page 97)  
Genre Name (page 97)  
Multi-Mode (page 98)  
Undo (page 99)  
*1  
*1  
*1 DVD-R/-RW only  
88  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Editing  
10  
PREV  
NEXT  
The Disc Navigator screen  
When in the title list, press to  
display the previous/next page if there  
are more titles than can be displayed.  
The Disc Navigator screen is where you can  
edit video content on unfinalized Video mode  
and DVD-R/-RW (VR mode) discs, DVD+R/  
+RW and DVD-RAM, as well as video  
content on the hard disk drive.  
DISPLAY  
Press to change the title  
information displayed in the title list.  
HDD/DVD  
Important  
Press to switch between the HDD  
and DVD Disc Navigator screens.  
• Titles that have been recorded with a  
Input Line System setting different to the  
current setting of the recorder are shown  
in the Disc Navigator with a blank  
thumbnail image. See also Additional  
information about the TV system settings  
on page 141.  
• If you are editing a DVD-R/-RW (VR  
mode) or DVD-RAM disc you can display  
the Play List by selecting Play List from  
the view options panel (press , then  
select Play List from the view options,  
then Play List).  
• During recording, if you display the Disc  
Navigator for the HDD, some of the titles  
Disc Navigator (DVD)  
10Titles  
23:00 FRI 3/12  
Style  
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr  
4
SP  
4
Titles  
may appear with a  
mark. These titles  
2h00m(1.0G)
20:00 FRI 3/12  
PlayList  
20:00 Fri 3/12 Pr  
9
SP  
were recorded with a Input Line System  
setting different to the current setting of  
the recorder. During recording, these  
titles cannot be played.  
Original  
MENU  
2h00m(1.0G)  
• Titles on the HDD marked with a  
icon are recently recorded titles that  
haven’t yet been played.  
HDD/DVD  
DISC  
NAVIGATOR  
1
2
Select the HDD or DVD.  
3
Press to exit the Disc Navigator.  
DISC  
NAVIGATOR  
Display the Disc Navigator  
Editing accuracy  
screen.  
Some editing commands ask you whether  
you want to keep Video mode compatibility  
or frame accuracy (Video Mode Compatible  
Editing or Frame Accurate Editing).  
Playback will automatically stop when you  
do this.  
• The Disc Navigator is also accessible  
from the Home Menu.  
Frame Accurate Editing is very precise. The  
edit point is accurate to the exact frame you  
choose. However, this accuracy is not  
preserved in any copy you make if you use  
the high-speed copy function to make a  
DVD-R/-RW (Video mode) or DVD+R/+RW.  
View options panel  
Title list  
Disc Navigator (HDD)  
10Titles  
10
23:00 FRI 3/12 Pr  
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr  
4
4
SP  
SP  
h00m(1.0G)
Selected  
title  
2
4
Titles  
9
8
7
20:00 FRI 3/12 Pr  
20:00 Fri 3/12 Pr  
9
9
SP  
SP  
Recent first  
All Genres  
MENU  
2h00m(1.0G)  
22:00 THU 2/12 Pr  
22:00 Thu 2/12 Pr  
7
7
SP  
SP  
1h00m(1.0G)  
Video Mode Compatible Editing is less  
precise. The edit point you choose will only  
be accurate to within one-half to one second.  
On the other hand, these edit points will be  
preserved if you use high-speed copy to  
make a DVD-R/-RW (Video mode) or  
DVD+R/+RW.  
19:00 MON 29/11 Pr  
19:00 Mon 29/11 Pr  
2
2
SP  
SP  
HDD  
SP  
1h00m(1.0G)  
Remain  
30h30m  
Available  
recording time  
Title thumbnail Title information Command  
menu panel  
Press to display the command  
menu panel. Use the ꢁ/ꢂ and ENTER  
buttons to navigate the menus.  
89  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Editing  
10  
HDD genres  
Play  
The large capacity of the HDD means that  
there may be many hours of video in the  
recorder. To help you organize your HDD  
video content you can assign different  
genres to titles. There are 20 genres in total,  
including five user-definable ones that you  
can name as you like.  
DVD (Video) DVD (VR) DVD+R DVD+RW DVD-RAM HDD  
Use this function to start playback of a title.  
1
Highlight the title you want  
to play.  
• You can also use the Smart Jog to select  
titles.  
Create  
DVD (VR) DVD-RAM  
Play List only  
ENTER  
Use this function to create a Play List and  
add titles to it.  
2
Select ‘Play’ from the  
command menu panel.  
Playback of the title you selected starts.  
Before you can use this command, make  
sure that the Play List is switched on in the  
view options panel on the left.  
Disc Navigator (HDD)  
10Titles  
10  
23:00 FRI 3/12 Pr SP  
4
Play  
SP  
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr  
4
Erase  
2
4
Titles  
ENTER  
Edit  
9
8
7
20:00 FRI 3/12 Pr  
20:00 Fri 3/12 Pr  
9
9
S
S
1
Select ‘Create’ from the  
Recent first  
All Genres  
Genre Name  
S
S
command menu panel.  
22:00 THU 2/12 Pr  
22:00 Thu 2/12 Pr  
7
7
M
u
lti-Mode  
Disc Navigator (DVD)  
0Titles  
19:00 MON 29/11 Pr  
19:00 Mon 29/11 Pr  
2
2
SP  
SP  
HDD  
SP  
Play  
1h00m(1.0G)  
No title  
Remain  
30h30m  
Erase  
2
Edit  
4
Titles  
Play List  
Create  
Erase  
Undo  
DVD (Video) DVD (VR) DVD+R DVD+RW DVD-RAM HDD  
DVD  
VR Mode  
Remain  
Use this function to erase unwanted titles.  
0h30m  
When you erase titles from the HDD or  
Original titles from a VR mode DVD-RW, the  
available recording space increases  
ENTER  
2
Select an original title to add  
accordingly. Erasing a title from a DVD-RW  
(Video mode) or DVD+RW disc increases  
the available recording time only if it is the  
to the Play List.  
• You can also use the Smart Jog to select  
titles.  
1
last title on the disc.  
Repeat these two steps to add as many titles  
as necessary to the Play List.  
Erasing Play List titles, or titles from a  
DVD-R (VR mode or Video mode) or DVD+R,  
will not result in any more free space on the  
disc.  
Note  
90  
En  
1 There may be cases where erasing a title from a DVD+R/+RW disc will result in incontiguous title numbers.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Editing  
10  
ENTER  
1
Highlight the title you want  
3
Input a name for the selected  
to erase.  
title.  
• You can also use the Smart Jog to select  
titles.  
Input Title Name  
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr 4 SP  
A B C D E  
F
G H  
I
J
K L M  
.
(
I
,
)
I
ß
_
}
˚
`
?
:
!
;
CAPS  
small  
N
A
D
0
O
A
N
1
P
A
O
2
Q
A
O
3
R
A
O
4
S T U V WX Y Z  
ç
ENTER  
A
O
5
[
§
·
Æ
O
6
E
U
8
ˆ
E
U
9
÷
<<  
E
U
<
x
E
U
=
I
I
#
%
ø
7
]
Y
>
{
$
2
Select ‘Erase’ from the  
&
~
+
/
@
¥
|
¡
_
a
command menu panel.  
c
£
\
µ
¨
¸
©
¬
/2  
®
/4  
< < 14  
/
o
1
3
2
3
1
¿
´
OK  
Clear  
Space  
ENTER  
3
Select ‘Yes’ to confirm or ‘No’  
to cancel.  
• A name generated automatically by the  
recorder will already be in the name  
input section of the screen. Use the  
ꢈ/ꢉ buttons to change the cursor  
position.  
Tip  
• You can erase a title quickly by pressing  
CLEAR when the title is highlighted.  
Confirm the edit by pressing ENTER.  
• Select CAPS or small to change to upper  
or lower-case, or use the  
CASE SELECTION buttons (PREV/  
NEXT).  
Title Name  
DVD (Video) DVD (VR) DVD+R DVD+RW DVD-RAM HDD  
• You can also use the CLEAR button to  
delete characters directly (press and  
hold for two seconds to delete the whole  
name). For other remote control key  
shortcuts, see Using the remote key  
shortcuts to input a name on page 92.  
You can give titles new names of up to 64  
characters long for VR mode, DVD-RAM and  
HDD recordings, and up to 40 characters for  
Video mode recordings and DVD+R/+RW  
discs.  
• For discs formatted on a different DVD  
recorder, you will see only a limited  
character set.  
1
Highlight the title you want  
to name (or rename).  
• You can also use the Smart Jog to select  
titles.  
ENTER  
4
Select ‘OK’ to enter the name  
and return to the main Disc Navigator  
screen.  
• To return to the main Disc Navigator  
screen without saving changes to the  
title name, press RETURN/EXIT.  
ENTER  
2
Select ‘Edit’ > ‘Title Name’  
from the command menu panel.  
Disc Navigator (HDD)  
10Titles  
10  
23:00 FRI 3/12 Pr SP  
4
Title Name  
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr  
4
Set Thumbnail  
4
Titles  
Erase Section  
9
8
7
20:00 FRI 3/12 Pr  
20:00 Fri 3/12 Pr  
Divide  
Chapter Edit  
Recent first  
All Genres  
Set Genre  
22:00 THU 2/12 Pr  
22:00 Thu 2/12 Pr  
Lock
Cancel
19:00 MON 29/11 Pr  
19:00 Mon 29/11 Pr  
2
2
SP  
SP  
HDD  
SP  
1h00m(1.0G)  
Remain  
30h30m  
91  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Editing  
10  
Using the remote key shortcuts to  
input a name  
The table below shows the remote control  
key shortcuts that you can use to input  
characters in the name input screen.  
Pressing a button repeatedly cycles through  
the characters shown.  
Using a USB keyboard to enter a name  
Using a USB keyboard connected to this  
recorder makes entering names very quick  
1
and convenient. When in USB keyboard  
input mode, a USB icon ( ) appears in the  
2
lower-left of the screen.  
Other than the standard alpha-numeric  
keys, use the following keys when entering  
If you want to enter two characters in  
succession that are both on the same button  
(for example a P and an R), press to  
advance the cursor one space manually  
between inputting the two characters.  
names:  
Key  
Function  
Change the cursor position  
Key  
1
Characters  
Key  
6
Characters  
ꢃ ꢀ  
. , ’ ? ! – & 1  
m n o 6 ö ô ò ó  
ø ñ  
Select CAPS  
F1  
a b c 2 ä à á â ã  
æ ç  
p q r s 7 $  
2
7
Select small  
*1  
F2  
ÿ/ß  
d e f 3 è é ë ê  
g h i 4 î ï ì í ¡  
j k l 5 £  
t u v 8 ü ù û ú  
3
4
8
9
Delete character at the current  
cursor position  
delete  
w x y z 9  
0
Delete the character at the  
previous cursor position  
back  
5
0
space  
[cursor back]  
[cursor for-  
ward]  
Enter the name  
enter  
ꢆ/ [change case] CLEAR [clear charac-  
Exit the input screen  
esc  
ter]  
<space>  
[finish name  
input]  
~
+
( ) _ / : ; ” ` ^ @ # % ¥ | + =  
{ } [ ] < >  
*1  
lower-case: ÿ; upper-case: ß  
Note  
1 • It’s possible that some USB keyboards will not work exactly as expected when connected to this recorder. See  
also Connecting a USB device on page 22 for more connection information.  
• Certain keyboards may not be able to correctly input all characters.  
2 If you use the remote control to enter a name when in the USB keyboard input mode, the recorder will  
automatically switch to remote control input mode. Press any key on the USB keyboard to return to USB  
keyboard input mode.  
92  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Editing  
10  
Set Thumbnail  
Erase Section  
HDD DVD (Video) DVD (VR) DVD+R DVD+RW DVD-RAM  
HDD DVD (VR) DVD-RAM  
You can change the thumbnail picture that  
appears in the Disc Navigator for a title to  
any frame that appears in that title.  
Using this command you can delete a part of  
a title, ideal for cutting out the commercial  
breaks in a recording made from the TV.  
1
Highlight the title you want  
1
Highlight the title containing  
to change the thumbnail picture for.  
• You can also use the Smart Jog to select  
titles.  
the section you want to erase.  
• You can also use the Smart Jog to select  
titles.  
ENTER  
ENTER  
2
Select ‘Edit’ > ‘Set Thumbnail’  
2
Select ‘Edit’ > ‘Erase Section’  
from the command menu panel.  
The thumbnail setting screen appears from  
from the command menu panel.  
which you can find the frame you want.  
ENTER  
3
edit.  
HDD only: Select the type of  
Disc Navigator (HDD)  
10Titles  
10  
23:00 FRI 3/12 Pr SP  
4
4
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr  
Title Name  
HDD/DVD RECORDER  
Set Thumbnail  
!
4
Titles  
Erase Section  
9
8
7
20:00 FRI 3/12 Pr  
20:00 Fri 3/12 Pr  
9
9
Divide  
Chapter Edit  
Please select the type of editing.  
Video Mode Compatible Editing is  
recommended for compatibility with  
high-speed copying.  
Recent first  
All Genres  
Set Genre  
22:00 THU 2/12 Pr  
22:00 Thu 2/12 Pr  
Lock
Cancel
19:00 MON 29/11 Pr  
19:00 Mon 29/11 Pr  
2
2
SP  
SP  
HDD  
SP  
Remain  
30h30m  
Video Mode Compatible Editing  
Frame Accurate Editing  
1h00m(1.0G)  
3
Use the playback controls (, , ,  
• For more information about these  
options, see Editing accuracy on page 89.  
, etc.) to find a suitable frame, then  
press ENTER to set.  
4
Highlight ‘From’ then use the  
Set Thumbnail (HDD)  
playback controls (, , , , etc.) to  
find the start of the section to erase, then  
press ENTER.  
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr 4 SP  
2h00m  
Rec. time  
The bar at the bottom of the screen indicates  
the current play position in the title. After  
pressing ENTER, a marker shows the start of  
the section.  
10-1 00.00.09.15  
Play Pause  
OK  
Exit  
You can also use the chapter and time  
search features (press the YELLOW button),  
and the Smart Jog (for CM SKIP and CM  
BACK).  
Erase Section (HDD)  
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr 4 SP  
2h00m  
Rec. time  
10-1 00.00.09.15  
Play Pause  
From  
4
Select ‘Exit’ to return to the  
To  
Exit  
Edit screen.  
93  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Editing  
10  
4
Use the playback controls (, , ,  
ENTER  
, etc.) to find the place you want to  
divide the title.  
5
Highlight ‘To’ then, in the  
same way, find the end of the section to  
erase, then press ENTER.  
Divide Title (HDD)  
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr 4 SP  
After pressing ENTER, another marker  
indicates the end of the section, with the  
section itself marked in red.  
2h00m  
Rec. time  
10–1 00.00.09.15  
Play Pause  
ENTER  
Divide  
Cancel  
6
Select ‘Yes’ to confirm, or ‘No’  
to cancel.  
In the thumbnail viewer you can see a few  
seconds of video either side of the marked  
section to see how the edit will look.  
ENTER  
5
Press to divide the title at the  
current playback position.  
• When editing VR mode Original content,  
you may not be able to erase very short  
sections (less than five seconds).  
ENTER  
6
Select ‘Yes’ to confirm or ‘No’  
to cancel.  
Divided titles cannot  
be combined.  
OK?  
!
Divide  
Yes  
No  
DVD (VR) DVD-RAM  
HDD  
Play List only  
Use this command to divide a title into two.  
Note that once divided, the two new HDD  
titles cannot be recombined into one again.  
Chapter Edit  
DVD (VR) DVD-RAM HDD  
When editing a VR mode DVD or video on  
the HDD you can edit individual chapters  
within a title, with commands for erasing,  
combining and dividing.  
1
Highlight the title you want  
to divide.  
• You can also use the Smart Jog to select  
titles.  
1
Highlight the title that contains the  
chapters you want to edit.  
• You can also use the Smart Jog to select  
titles.  
ENTER  
2
Select ‘Edit’ > ‘Divide’ from  
the command menu panel.  
3
HDD only: Select the type of edit.  
ENTER  
2
Select ‘Edit’ > ‘Chapter Edit’  
HDD/DVD RECORDER  
!
from the command menu panel.  
Please select the type of editing.  
Video Mode Compatible Editing is  
recommended for compatibility with  
high-speed copying.  
Video Mode Compatible Editing  
Frame Accurate Editing  
• For more information about these  
options, see Editing accuracy on page 89.  
94  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Editing  
10  
Move command only: Select the  
destination for the chapter, and press  
ENTER.  
ENTER  
3
edit.  
HDD only: Select the type of  
Chapter Edit (DVD VR mode Play List)  
19:00 Mon 29/11 P
HDD/DVD RECORDER  
Erase  
!
Rec. time  
Chapter  
1
Move  
0
Cancel  
Please select the type of editing.  
Video Mode Compatible Editing is  
recommended for compatibility with  
high-speed copying.  
001  
002  
003  
004  
005  
Exit  
Divide  
Erase/Move  
Combine  
3
Video Mode Compatible Editing  
Frame Accurate Editing  
Combine – Combine two adjacent  
chapters into one: Highlight the bar  
divider between two adjacent chapters  
and press ENTER.  
• For more information about these  
options, see Editing accuracy on page 89.  
Chapter Edit (DVD VR mode Play List)  
4
Select the command you want:  
Divide – Divide a chapter into two or  
more parts: Use the playback controls  
(, , , , etc.) to find the point at  
which you want to divide the chapter,  
then press ENTER.  
19:00 Mon 29/11 Pr  
2
SP  
Rec. time  
1h00m  
1
2
3
4
5
Exit  
Divide  
Erase/Move  
Combine  
Chapter Edit (DVD VR mode Play List)  
ENTER  
19:00 Mon 29/11 Pr  
2
SP  
Rec. time  
Chapters  
1h00m  
5
5
Select ‘Exit’ to get back to the  
main Disc Navigator screen.  
1–1  
Play  
0.00.00  
Exit  
Divide  
Erase/Move  
Combine  
Set Genre  
HDD  
You can keep dividing the chapter as  
many times as you wish (up to 999  
chapters per DVD-R/-RW/-RAM disc or  
99 chapters per HDD title).  
Use this command to assign a genre to a  
title.  
1
2
Erase /Move – Erase or move  
chapters: Select the chapter you want to  
erase/move and press ENTER. Select  
whether you want to erase or move the  
chapter.  
1
Highlight the title you want  
to assign a genre to.  
• You can also use the Smart Jog to select  
titles.  
Note  
1 When editing VR mode Original content, it may not be possible to erase chapters less than five seconds long.  
2 VR mode Play List only.  
3 It may not always be possible to combine two chapters, even though they are adjacent. If a chapter has been  
divided into three, then the middle chapter erased, it is not possible to combine the two remaining chapters into  
one.  
95  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Editing  
10  
ENTER  
ENTER  
2
Select ‘Edit’ > ‘Set Genre’ from  
2
Select ‘Edit’ > ‘Lock’ from the  
the command menu panel.  
command menu panel.  
Disc Navigator (HDD)  
Disc Navigator (HDD)  
10  
10Titles  
10Titles  
10  
23:00 FRI 3/12 Pr  
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr  
4
4
SP  
23:00 FRI 3/12 Pr SP  
4
4
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr  
Title Name  
Title Name  
Set Thumbnail  
Set Thumbnail  
4
Titles  
4
Titles  
Erase Section  
Erase Section  
9
9
8
7
20:00 FRI 3/12 Pr  
20:00 Fri 3/12 Pr  
9
9
20:00 FRI 3/12 Pr  
20:00 Fri 3/12 Pr  
9
9
Divide  
Divide  
Chapter Edit  
Chapter Edit  
Recent first  
All Genres  
Recent first  
All Genres  
Set Genre  
Set Genre  
8
7
22:00 THU 2/12 Pr  
22:00 Thu 2/12 Pr  
Lock  
22:00 THU 2/12 Pr  
22:00 Thu 2/12 Pr  
Lock  
Cancel
Cancel
19:00 MON 29/11 Pr  
19:00 Mon 29/11 Pr  
2
2
SP  
SP  
19:00 MON 29/11 Pr  
19:00 Mon 29/11 Pr  
2
2
SP  
SP  
HDD  
SP  
Remain  
30h30m  
HDD  
SP  
Remain  
30h30m  
1h00m(1.0G)  
1h00m(1.0G)  
An unlocked title will become locked; a  
locked title will be unlocked. Locked titles  
are shown in the Disc Navigator with a  
padlock icon.  
ENTER  
3
Select a genre for the title.  
Disc Navigator (HDD)  
10  
10Titles  
23:00 FRI 3/12 Pr SP  
4
Move  
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr  
No Category  
Movies  
4
Titles  
9
20:00 FRI 3/12 Pr  
20:00 Fri 3/12 Pr  
Drama  
DVD (VR) DVD-RAM  
Play List only  
Entertainmt.  
Recent first  
All Genres  
News  
Sport  
8
7
22:00 THU 2/12 P
22:00 Thu 2/12 P
Use this function to re-arrange the playing  
order of Play List titles.  
Comedy  
19:00 MON 29/11 Pr  
19:00 Mon 29/11 Pr  
2
2
SP  
SP  
HDD  
SP  
Remain  
30h30m  
1h00m(1.0G)  
1
Highlight the title you want  
to move.  
Lock  
• You can also use the Smart Jog to select  
titles.  
HDD DVD (Video) DVD (VR) DVD+R DVD+RW DVD-RAM  
Original only  
ENTER  
You can lock a title so that it can’t be edited  
or erased accidently. If you do need to edit it,  
you can always unlock it later.  
2
Select ‘Edit’ > ‘Move’ from the  
command menu panel.  
Disc Navigator (DVD)  
10Titles  
Important  
1
2
3
4
23:00 FRI 3/12  
23:00Fri 3/12Pr
Title Name  
Se  
EraseSection  
Divide  
t
T
humbnail
4
Titles  
• You can’t undo any edits made before  
changing the lock status. You also can’t  
undo a lock/unlock command using the  
Undo option from the Disc Navigator  
menu.  
20:00 FRI 3/12  
20:00 Fri 3/12 Pr  
Chapter Edit  
Play List  
Move  
Combine  
22:00 THU 2/12  
22:00 Thu 2/12 P
Cancel  
19:00 MON 29/11  
19:00 Mon 29/11 Pr  
DVD  
VR Mode  
2
SP  
1h00m(1.0G)  
Remain  
1
Highlight the title you want to lock  
0h30m  
(or unlock).  
• You can also use the Smart Jog to select  
titles.  
96  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Editing  
10  
ENTER  
ENTER  
3
Select a new position for the  
3
Select another title to  
title.  
combine with the first.  
This title will be appended to the first title  
selected.  
Title to move  
Disc Navigator (DVD)  
10Titles  
The screen below shows title 3 selected to be  
appended to title 1.  
1
23:00 FRI 3/12  
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr  
4
SP  
2h00m(1.0G)
4
Titles  
2
3
4
20:00 FRI 3/12  
20:00 Fri 3/12 Pr  
Disc Navigator (DVD)  
10Titles  
9
SP  
Play List  
MENU  
2h00m(1.0G)  
1
23:00 FRI 3/12  
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr  
22:00 THU 2/12  
22:00 Thu 2/12 Pr  
4
SP  
7
SP  
2h00m(1.0G)  
4
Titles  
1h00m(1.0G)  
2
20:00 FRI 3/12  
19:00 MON 29/11  
19:00 Mon 29/11 Pr  
20:00 Fri 3/12 Pr  
9
SP  
2h00m(1.0G)  
DVD  
VR Mode  
Remain  
0h30m  
2
SP  
Play List  
MENU  
1h00m(1.0G)  
3
22:00 THU 2/12  
22:00 Thu 2/12 Pr  
7
SP  
1h00m(1.0G)  
Insert position  
4
19:00 MON 29/11  
19:00 Mon 29/11 Pr  
DVD  
2
SP  
VR Mode  
After pressing ENTER, the new, updated Play  
1h00m(1.0G)  
Remain  
0h30m  
List is displayed.  
ENTER  
Combine  
4
Select ‘Yes’ to confirm or ‘No’  
DVD (VR) DVD-RAM  
Play List only  
to cancel.  
Use this function to combine two Play List  
titles into one.  
OK to combine titles  
1 and 3 ?  
!
Yes  
No  
1
Highlight the title you want  
Genre Name  
to combine.  
HDD  
• You can also use the Smart Jog to select  
titles.  
Use this command to rename one of the five  
user-definable genres (Free 1 to Free 5).  
This title will remain in the same place after  
combining with another title.  
ENTER  
ENTER  
1
Select ‘Genre Name’ from the  
2
Select ‘Edit’ > ‘Combine’ from  
command menu panel.  
the command menu panel.  
Disc Navigator (HDD)  
10Titles  
Disc Navigator (DVD)  
10Titles  
10  
23:00 FRI 3/12 Pr  
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr  
Erase  
4
4
SP  
SP  
Play  
1
23:00 FRI 3/12  
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr  
Title Name  
2
Edit  
4
Titles  
Set  
T
h
u
m
b
ail
n
4
Titles  
9
8
7
20:00 FRI 3/12 Pr  
20:00 Fri 3/12 Pr  
9
9
S
S
EraseSection  
Divide  
Chapter Edit  
2
3
4
20:00 FRI 3/12  
Recent first  
All Genres  
20:00 Fri 3/12 Pr  
Genre Name  
S
S
Play List  
22:00 THU 2/12 Pr  
22:00 Thu 2/12 Pr  
7
7
Move  
Combine  
22:00 THU 2/12  
22:00 Thu 2/12 P
Multi-Mode  
Cancel  
19:00 MON 29/11 Pr  
19:00 Mon 29/11 Pr  
2 SP  
2
HDD  
SP  
SP  
19:00 MON 29/11  
19:00 Mon 29/11 Pr  
DVD  
VR Mode  
2
SP  
1h00m(1.0G)  
Remain  
30h30m  
1h00m(1.0G)  
Remain  
0h30m  
97  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Editing  
10  
Multi-Mode  
ENTER  
HDD  
2
Select one of the user-  
definable genre names.  
Multi-Mode allows you to select several  
titles, then select a command that will be  
applied to all of them. In this way you can  
select multiple titles and then erase them all  
at once, for example.  
Disc Navigator (HDD)  
10Titles  
10  
23:00 FRI 3/12 Pr  
4
4
SP  
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr  
Free1  
Free2  
Free3  
4
Titles  
9
8
7
20:00 FRI 3/12 Pr  
20:00 Fri 3/12 Pr  
9
9
Free4  
Free5  
Recent first  
All Genres  
22:00 THU 2/12 Pr  
22:00 Thu 2/12 Pr  
C
a
ncel  
ENTER  
1
Select ‘Multi-Mode’ from the  
19:00 MON 29/11 Pr  
19:00 Mon 29/11 Pr  
2 SP  
2
HDD  
SP  
SP  
command menu panel.  
1h00m(1.0G)  
Remain  
30h30m  
Disc Navigator (HDD)  
10Titles  
10  
23:00 FRI 3/12 Pr SP  
Play  
4
4
ENTER  
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr  
SP  
Erase  
3
Input a name for the genre.  
2
Edit  
4
Titles  
9
8
7
20:00 FRI 3/12 Pr  
20:00 Fri 3/12 Pr  
9
9
S
S
• The name can be up to 12 characters  
long.  
Recent first  
All Genres  
Genre Name  
S
S
22:00 THU 2/12 Pr  
22:00 Thu 2/12 Pr  
7
7
• For information on remote control key  
short cuts, see Using the remote key  
shortcuts to input a name on page 92.  
Multi-Mode  
19:00 MON 29/11 Pr  
19:00 Mon 29/11 Pr  
2 SP  
HDD  
SP  
2
SP  
1h00m(1.0G)  
Remain  
30h30m  
Input Genre Name  
Free  
1
ENTER  
A B C D E  
F
G H  
I
J
K L M  
.
(
I
,
)
I
ß
_
}
˚
`
?
:
!
;
CAPS  
small  
2
Select titles from the title list.  
N
A
D
0
O
A
N
1
P
A
O
2
Q
A
O
3
R
A
O
4
S T U V WX Y Z  
ç
A
O
5
[
§
·
Æ
O
6
E
U
8
ˆ
E
U
9
÷
<<  
E
U
<
x
E
U
=
I
I
#
%
ø
7
]
Y
>
{
$
Selected titles are marked with a .  
&
~
+
/
@
¥
|
¡
_
a
• You can also use the Smart Jog to select  
c
£
\
µ
¨
¸
©
¬
/2  
®
/4  
< < 14  
/
o
1
3
2
3
1
¿
´
titles.  
Space  
OK  
Clear  
ENTER  
3
Select the command that you  
ENTER  
want applied to all the marked titles.  
For example, select Erase to erase all the  
marked titles.  
4
and exit.  
Select ‘OK’ to enter the name  
Disc Navigator (HDD)  
Multi-Mode  
10Titles  
23:00 FRI 3/12 Pr  
23:00 Fri 3/12 Pr  
4
4
SP  
SP  
Erase  
Lock  
2
4
Titles  
Unlock  
9
Change Genre  
20:00 FRI 3/12 Pr  
20:00 Fri 3/12 Pr  
9
9
S
S
Recent first  
All Genres  
22:00 THU 2/12 Pr  
22:00 Thu 2/12 Pr  
7
7
SSingle Mode  
19:00 MON 29/11 Pr  
19:00 Mon 29/11 Pr  
2
2
SP  
SP  
HDD  
SP  
Remain  
30h30m  
1h00m(1.0G)  
Once the command is completed, Multi-  
Mode is automatically exited.  
98  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Editing  
10  
Undo  
DVD (Video) DVD (VR) DVD+R DVD+RW  
If you make a mistake while editing, you can  
generally undo it. There is one level of undo  
(in other words, you can only undo the last  
edit you made).  
ENTER  
Select ‘Undo’ from the  
command menu panel.  
• You can’t undo anything after exiting the  
Disc Navigator screen.  
Disc Navigator (DVD)  
0Titles  
No title  
Play  
Erase  
2
4
Titles  
Edit  
Play List  
Create  
Undo  
DVD  
VR Mode  
Remain  
0h30m  
Frequently asked questions  
• Why doesn’t the available recording time  
increase when I erase titles from a VR  
mode DVD-R?  
When you erase titles from a DVD-R (or  
DVD+R), the titles are no longer  
displayed, but the content remains on  
the disc. DVD-R/+R are write-once  
media; they can’t be erased or rewritten.  
• I can’t edit my disc!  
You may find that as the available  
recording time is reduced on a VR mode  
DVD-R disc, editing is no longer  
possible. This is because information  
about your edits requires a certain  
amount of disc space. As you edit, this  
information builds up, eventually  
preventing you from editing further.  
99  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Copying and backup  
11  
CChaoptpery11ing and backup  
Restrictions on copying  
Introduction  
Commercial DVD-Video discs are protected  
using Copy Guard. These discs cannot be  
copied to the HDD.  
Use the copying features of this recorder to:  
• Back up important recordings stored on  
the HDD to a DVD.  
Some video material is copy-once protected.  
This means that it can be recorded to HDD,  
but it can’t then be freely copied again. If you  
want to transfer copy-once protected  
material from HDD to DVD, you’ll need to a  
CPRM ver. 1.1 or higher VR mode DVD-RW,  
ver. 2.0 or 2.1 VR mode DVD-R, or CPRM-  
compatible DVD-RAM disc (see CPRM on  
page 61 for more on this). Only one instance  
of a copy-once protected title can be added  
to the Copy List, and after it’s been copied,  
the title is erased from the HDD (it is  
• Make a DVD copy of a recording on the  
HDD to play in another player.  
• Transfer video from a DVD to the HDD  
for editing.  
• Transfer edited video from the HDD to  
DVD.  
The simplest way to copy a title is to use the  
One Touch Copy feature. This copies the  
currently playing HDD title to DVD, or DVD  
title to the HDD. See One Touch Copy below  
for detailed instructions.  
therefore not possible to copy a locked title  
that is copy-once protected).  
For more sophisticated copying tasks you  
can build a Copy List of titles to copy, and  
edit titles so that you only copy the bits you  
want. See Using Copy Lists on page 102 for  
detailed instructions.  
You can identify copy-once protected  
material during playback by displaying disc  
information on-screen. If the current title is  
copy-once protected, an exclamation mark  
( ! ) is shown.  
Where possible, the recorder will copy your  
recordings at high-speed. Depending on the  
recording mode, the kind of disc loaded and  
various other factors, copying can be as fast  
as one minute per hour of video. See  
Minimum copying times on page 144 for  
more on copying times.  
Copyright  
Recording equipment should be used only  
for lawful copying and you are advised to  
check carefully what is lawful copying in the  
country in which you are making a copy.  
Copying of copyright material such as films  
or music is unlawful unless permitted by a  
legal exception or consented to by the  
rightowners.  
If you want to save disc space you can copy  
video at a lower recording quality (for  
example, an XP recording on the HDD  
copied to SP on a DVD). Copying in this way  
is always done in real-time.  
When real-time copying from the HDD to a  
DVD-R/-RW (Video mode) or DVD+R/+RW,  
the chapter markers in the original material  
are not copied. Chapter markers are put into  
the copy at intervals, according to the Auto  
Chapter settings (see also Auto Chapter  
(Video) and Auto Chapter (DVD+R/+RW) on  
page 136).  
One Touch Copy  
* See also Copyright above.  
The One Touch Copy feature copies the  
currently playing or selected (in the Disc  
Navigator) HDD title to DVD, or DVD title to  
HDD. The whole title is copied, regardless of  
where in the title you start the copy.  
100  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Copying and backup  
11  
HDD to DVD copies are made in the same  
recording mode. When copying DVD to  
HDD, the copy is made in whatever  
recording mode is currently set.  
characters of a name are copied.  
• The chapter markers in the copy may not  
be in exactly the same positions as the  
original when recording on to a DVD-R/  
-RW (Video mode) or DVD+R/+RW.  
Make sure that a recordable DVD disc is  
loaded when trying to copy from the HDD.  
• You can’t use the One Touch Copy  
function to copy a title if any part of the  
title is copy-once protected.  
REC MODE  
1
If you’re copying from DVD to the  
HDD, select a recording mode.  
Note that selecting a recording mode higher  
than the title playing will not result in a better  
quality recording.  
• A title that contains mixed aspect ratios  
can’t be copied to a DVD-R/-RW (Video  
mode) or DVD+R/+RW. Use a DVD-R/  
-RW (VR mode) or DVD-RAM disc for  
this type of material.  
ONE TOUCH  
COPY  
1
2
Press during playback to copy  
• Low resolution (SEP through LP modes )  
the current title.  
The front panel display indicates that the title  
is being copied.  
widescreen material can’t be copied to a  
DVD-R/-RW (Video mode) or DVD+R/  
+RW. Use a DVD-R/-RW (VR mode) or  
DVD-RAM disc for this type of material.  
• High-speed copying is used when  
copying from the HDD to DVD. Playback  
continues while copying.  
• When HDD Recording Format is set to  
Video Mode Off, titles recorded in LP/  
MN9 to MN15 modes cannot be high-  
speed copied to a DVD-R/  
-RW (Video mode) or DVD+R/+RW.  
Please use a DVD-R/-RW (VR mode) or  
DVD-RAM.  
• Real-time copying is used when copying  
from DVD to the HDD. Playback restarts  
from the beginning of the title.  
Cancelling One Touch Copy  
You can cancel a One Touch Copy once it’s  
started.  
• Recordings of bilingual broadcasts  
cannot be high-speed copied to a  
DVD-R/-RW (Video mode) or DVD+R/  
+RW. Please use a DVD-R/-RW (VR  
mode) or DVD-RAM.  
ONE TOUCH  
COPY  
Press and hold for more than a  
second.  
XP+ titles cannot be copied to DVD via  
One Touch Copy.  
Copying is cancelled and the video already  
copied is erased.  
• Titles over eight hours cannot be copied  
to single-layer DVD+R/+RW discs using  
One Touch Copy. Use DVD+R DL discs  
for titles over eight hours.  
• If you cancel a HDD to DVD-R/+R copy,  
the space available for recording does  
not return to the pre-copy figure.  
• Titles recorded in MN1 to MN6, SEP, SLP  
or EP mode cannot be copied to DVD+R/  
+RW using One Touch Copy.  
Notes on copying using One Touch  
Copy  
Copying to DVD  
Copying to the HDD  
• Title name, chapter markers, as well as  
thumbnail picture markers for the Disc  
Navigator, are also copied. However, if  
you copy to a DVD-R/-RW (Video mode)  
or DVD+R/+RW, only the first 40  
• The maximum title length for copying is  
12 hours.  
• Title name and chapter markers are also  
copied, except when copying from a  
finalized Video mode DVD-R/-RW.  
Note  
101  
En  
1 In manual recording mode these equate to MN1 to MN15 (Video Mode Off) or MN1 to MN8 (Video Mode On).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Copying and backup  
11  
• Thumbnail picture markers and chapter  
markers for the Disc Navigator are  
copied, but their position in the copy  
may be slightly changed from the  
original.  
HOME MENU  
2
Select ‘Copy’ from the Home  
Menu.  
ENTER  
3
Select ‘HDD DVD’.  
• If some part of the title being copied is  
copy-protected, copying will start, but  
the copy-protected portions will not be  
copied.  
HDD  
DVD  
HDD  
DVD/CD  
Disc Back-up  
• If this is the first time to create a Copy  
List, skip to step 5 below.  
Using Copy Lists  
4
If there is already a Copy List stored  
* See also Copyright on page 100.  
in the recorder, choose whether to  
‘Create New Copy List’ or ‘Continue  
Using Previous Copy List’.  
At its simplest, a Copy List is just a list of  
HDD or DVD titles that you want to copy.  
When copying HDD titles to DVD, you can,  
however, edit the titles in your copy list,  
erasing chapters you don’t need, or re-  
naming titles, for example. Edits you make to  
titles in the Copy List do not affect the actual  
video content; only the ‘virtual’ content of the  
Copy List. So you can freely erase and modify  
anything in your Copy List safe in the  
knowledge that the actual content is not  
being altered.  
Continue Using Previous Copy List  
Create New Copy List  
• If you select Continue Using Previous  
Copy List, skip to step 10 below.  
• Selecting Create New Copy List will  
erase any Copy List already stored in the  
recorder.  
Copying from HDD to DVD  
ENTER  
Important  
5
Add titles to the Copy List  
• The recorder can only store one Copy List  
at a time.  
(highlight a title and press ENTER to add).  
8
Title  
Copy  
Select Title  
HDD DVD (Video mode)  
1 > 2 > 3  
• The Copy List is erased if the Input Line  
System setting is changed (see  
Additional information about the TV  
system settings on page 141).  
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
WED 29/03 20:00 Wed29/03 Pr 2 SP  
MON 27/03 21:00 Mon27/03 Pr 4 SP  
S AT 25/03 23:00 S a t 25/03 Pr 9 SP  
THU 23/03 22:00 Thu 23/03 Pr 6 SP  
WED 22/03 20:00 Wed22/03 Pr 2 SP  
MON 20/03 13:00 Mon20/03 Pr 9 SP  
F R I 17/03 21:00 F r i 17/03 Pr 4 SP  
WED 15/03 20:00 Wed15/03 Pr 2 SP  
Pr 2  
Pr 4  
Pr 9  
Pr 6  
Pr 2  
Pr 9  
Pr 4  
Pr 2  
Back  
Next  
Recent first  
All Genres  
• Resetting the recorder to its factory  
settings (see Resetting the recorder on  
page 157) will erase the Copy List.  
20:00 Wed29/03 Pr 2 SP  
20:00  
1h00m(2.0G)  
Pr 2  
Sports  
SP  
Copy List Total  
Current DVD Remain  
0.0G  
4.3G  
1
Load a recordable DVD.  
• It is possible to complete the following  
steps without having a recordable DVD  
loaded (or having an uninitialized DVD  
loaded); however, the steps are slightly  
different.  
Titles you’ve added to the Copy List are  
highlighted in pink.  
There are some restrictions on titles that can  
be added to the Copy List if you are copying  
to a DVD-R/-RW (Video mode) or DVD+R/  
+RW:  
• If you want to use a DVD-RW (VR mode)  
disc for the copy, make sure it is  
initialized before you start.  
102  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Copying and backup  
11  
• When adding titles that contain copy-  
once protected material, the copy-once  
parts will not be added.  
8
To edit a title, highlight it using the  
ꢁ/ꢂ buttons, then press ENTER.  
2
Title  
Copy  
Title Edit  
HDD DVD (Video mode)  
1 > 2 > 3  
20:00 Wed29/03 Pr 2
• When adding titles that contain material  
of more than one aspect ratio (screen  
size), each part with a different aspect  
ratio will be added as a separate title if  
high-speed copying is possible.  
1
2
Erase  
20:00 Wed22/03 Pr 2
Title Name  
Back  
Next  
Erase Section  
Move  
Preview  
Cancel  
20:00 Wed29/03 Pr 2 SP  
1
Depending on the title , high-speed copying  
1h00m(2.0G)  
may not be possible to DVDs.  
Copy List Total  
4.3G  
4.3G  
Current DVD Remain  
6
Press to display the command  
menu panel.  
A menu of editing commands appears:  
Erase – Erase individual titles from the  
The Command Menu panel  
Copy List (see Erase on page 90).  
8
Title  
Copy  
Select Title  
HDD  
DVD (Video mode)  
Title Name – Name or rename a title in  
the Copy List (see Title Name on  
page 91).  
1
>
2
>
3
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
WED 29/03 20:00 Wed29/03 Pr  
MON 27/03 21:00 Mon27/03 Pr  
S A T 25/03 23:00 S a t 25/03 Pr  
THU 23/03 22:00 Thu 23/03 Pr  
WED 22/03 20:00 Wed22/03 Pr  
MON 20/03 13:00 Mon20/03 Pr  
F R I 17/03 21:00 F r i 17/03 Pr  
WED 15/03 20:00 Wed15/03 Pr  
2
4
9
6
2
9
4
2
SP  
SP  
SP  
SP  
SP  
SP  
SP  
SP  
Pr  
Pr  
Pr  
Pr  
Pr  
Pr  
Pr  
Pr  
2
4
9
6
2
9
4
2
Back  
Next  
Recent first  
All Genres  
Erase Section – Erase part of a title (see  
Erase Section on page 93).  
20:00  
20:00  
Wed29/03  
Pr  
1h00m(2.0G)  
Sports SP  
2
SP  
Move – Change the order of titles in the  
Pr  
2
Copy List (see Move on page 96).  
Copy List Total  
Current DVD Remain  
4.3G  
4.3G  
Preview – Check the content of a title in  
the Copy List.  
7
Select ‘Next’ to move on to the Title  
Edit screen.  
Divide – Divide a title in the Copy List  
into two (see Divide on page 94).  
2
Title  
Copy  
HDD DVD (Video mode)  
1 > 2 > 3  
Title Edit  
Combine – Combine two titles in the  
Copy List into one (see Combine on  
page 97).  
1
2
20:00 Wed29/03 Pr 2 SP  
20:00 Wed22/03 Pr 2 SP  
Back  
Next  
Chapter Edit – Edit chapters within a  
Copy List title (see Chapter Edit on  
page 94):  
20:00 Wed29/03 Pr 2 SP  
1h00m(2.0G)  
Divide – Divide a chapter into two.  
Erase/Move – Erase a chapter/  
Change the chapter order.  
Combine – Combine two chapters  
into one.  
Copy List Total  
Current DVD Remain  
4.3G  
4.3G  
Note  
1 The following titles cannot be copied at high-speed for DVD+R/+RW:  
• Titles recorded in MN1 to MN6, SEP, SLP or EP mode.  
The following titles cannot be copied at high-speed for DVD-R/-RW (Video Mode) and DVD+R/+RW:  
• Widescreen titles recorded at low resolution (SEP through LP/MN1 to MN15 (Video Mode Off) or MN1 to MN8  
(Video Mode On)).  
LP/MN9 to MN15 recordings when HDD Recording Format is set to Video Mode Off.  
• Bilingual recordings.  
• Combined titles that were originally recorded using different recording modes.  
The following titles cannot be copied at high-speed for any types of DVD:  
XP+ titles.  
103  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Copying and backup  
11  
Set Thumbnail – Set the thumbnail  
frame for a title (see Set Thumbnail on  
page 93).  
• Select Finalize if you want to  
automatically finalize a DVD-R/-RW  
(Video mode) or DVD+R after copying.  
Select a title menu style from the  
following screen.  
1
Recording Mode – Set the picture  
quality of the copy (see Recording Mode  
on page 105).  
ENTER  
Bilingual – Set how bilingual audio  
should be copied when copying from  
HDD to DVD-R/-RW (Video mode) and  
DVD+R/+RW (see Bilingual on  
page 106).  
11  
Select ‘Start Copy’ to start  
copying.  
Copy  
HDD DVD (Video Mode)  
1 > 2 > 3  
Start Copy  
HDD  
DVD-RW  
Video Mode  
Cancel – Exit the menu.  
Back  
Recording Mode  
Input Disc Name  
Finalize  
Copy Time 0h 16m  
Repeat this step for as many titles you have  
that need editing.  
Recording Mode  
Disc Name  
High-Speed  
Off  
Finalize  
Start Copy  
Copy List Total  
Current DVD Remain  
4.3G  
4.3G  
9
Display the command menu  
Select ‘Next’ to proceed.  
• If you’re using a DVD-R DL or DVD+R DL  
disc and the copy will span both layers,  
the Copy List Total bar will be purple.  
panel.  
ENTER  
• The Current DVD Remain bar will be  
half-length if the first layer of a DVD-R DL  
or DVD+R DL disc is already full.  
10  
2
Title  
Copy  
Title Edit  
HDD DVD (Video mode)  
1 > 2 > 3  
1
2
20:00 Wed29/03 Pr 2 SP  
20:00 Wed22/03 Pr 2 SP  
Copying from DVD to HDD  
Back  
Next  
Important  
• The DVD to HDD Copy screen isn’t  
accessible when a finalized Video mode  
DVD-R/-RW or a DVD-Video is loaded. As  
long as the disc is not Copy Guard  
protected, you can still use the One  
Touch Copy function, however (See One  
Touch Copy on page 100).  
20:00 Wed29/03 Pr 2 SP  
1h00m(2.0G)  
Copy List Total  
4.3G  
4.3G  
Current DVD Remain  
There are several options available from the  
next screen:  
• Select Recording Mode if you want to  
change the recording quality (see  
Recording Mode on page 105).  
• The recorder can only store one Copy List  
at a time.  
• Select Input Disc Name if you want to  
change the disc name. Input a name of  
up to 64 characters for a VR mode disc or  
40 characters for a Video mode disc or  
DVD+R/+RW. (The input method is  
similar to that of naming titles; see Title  
Name on page 91.)  
• The Copy List will be erased if:  
– any of the titles on the DVD disc are  
erased or edited.  
– the disc tray is opened.  
– playback is switched between Play List  
and Original.  
– the DVD disc is re-initialized or  
finalized.  
Note  
104  
En  
1 If a timer recording is scheduled to start during copying, the disc will not be finalized.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Copying and backup  
11  
– the recorder is reset to its factory  
settings (see Resetting the recorder on  
page 157).  
Repeat this step for as many titles you have  
that need editing.  
ENTER  
• It may not be possible to copy from a  
DVD disc that was recorded on a  
different DVD recorder or a PC.  
7
Select ‘Next’ from the  
command menu panel to proceed to the  
copy options screen.  
• Select Recording Mode if you want to  
change the recording quality (see  
Recording Mode below).  
HOME MENU  
1
Select ‘Copy’ from the Home  
Menu.  
ENTER  
2
3
Select ‘DVD/CD HDD’.  
ENTER  
8
Select ‘Start Copy’ to start  
ENTER  
copying.  
Select a Copy List type.  
• Selecting Create New Copy List will  
erase any Copy List already stored in the  
recorder.  
Recording Mode  
ENTER  
1
Select ‘Recording Mode’ from  
ENTER  
the command menu panel.  
4
Add titles to the Copy List  
(highlight a title and press ENTER to add).  
Titles you’ve added to the Copy List are  
highlighted in pink.  
ENTER  
2
Select a recording mode for  
the copy.  
1
High-Speed Copy – The Copy List is  
copied at the same recording quality as  
the original.  
ENTER  
5
Select ‘Next’ from the  
command menu panel to proceed to the  
title edit screen.  
2
XP, SP, LP, EP, SLP, SEP, MN – The Copy  
List is copied at the specified recording  
quality in real-time. (Note that if you copy  
at a higher quality setting than the  
original, the copy will not be better  
quality than the original.)  
ENTER  
6
Select a title to edit.  
A menu appears of Copy List editing  
commands:  
Erase – Erase individual titles from the  
Copy List (see Erase on page 90).  
If you select MN above, you can also  
change the level setting (MN1 to  
3
4
Move – Change the order of titles in the  
Copy List (see Move on page 96).  
MN32 , LPCM or XP+ ) from the  
Recording Quality box that appears.  
Preview – Check the content of a title in  
the Copy List.  
Cancel – Exit the menu.  
Note  
1 When copying to a DVD-R/-RW (Video mode) or DVD+R/+RW, the chapter markers in the copy may not be in  
exactly the same position as the original.  
2 When the copy mode is set to something other than High-Speed Copy for copying to a DVD-R/-RW (Video mode)  
or DVD+R/+RW, the chapter markers of the original are not copied. Chapter markers are put into the copy at  
regular intervals, according to the Auto Chapter setting (see also Auto Chapter (Video) and Auto Chapter  
(DVD+R/+RW) on page 136).  
3 When copying to a DVD+R/+RW, MN1 to MN3 and SEP modes are not available.  
4 XP+ mode available only when copying to HDD.  
105  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Copying and backup  
11  
1,2  
Optimized – The recording quality is  
ENTER  
automatically adjusted so that the Copy  
List fits on to the space available on the  
disc. Copying is carried out in real-time.  
2
Select a backup option.  
Start new disc back-up  
Resume writing data  
Erase back-up data  
When you change the recording mode  
setting, you can see how much disc space it  
will require. If this is more than is available,  
it shows up in red and you won’t be able to  
start copying. In this case, either change the  
recording quality, or press RETURN/EXIT to  
go back to the Copy List screen and erase  
one or more titles from the Copy List.  
There are three backup options:  
Start new disc back-up – Start making  
a backup of a disc.  
Resume writing data – Record the  
backup data already on the HDD to a  
recordable DVD.  
Bilingual  
Erase back-up data – Erase the backup  
data on the HDD.  
1
Select the title containing the  
audio you want to change.  
3
Load the disc you want to make a  
backup of.  
You can only make backup copies of  
finalized Video mode DVD-R/-RW discs,  
finalized DVD+R or DVD+RW discs  
(excluding DVD-R DL/DVD+R DL discs).  
ENTER  
2
Select ‘Bilingual’ from the  
command menu panel.  
ENTER  
Disc Back-up  
3
Select a bilingual audio  
No disc.  
option.  
Please load a disc to be backed-up.  
Cancel  
Start  
Using disc backup  
* See also Copyright on page 100.  
ENTER  
This feature offers a simple way to make a  
backup copy of finalized DVD-R/-RW (Video  
mode) discs or DVD+R/+RW discs. The  
data is copied first to the hard disk drive ,  
then on to another recordable DVD disc.  
4
Select ‘Start’.  
Disc Back-up  
3
Read from disc and save to HDD.  
Start reading?  
HOME MENU  
Cancel  
Start  
1
Select ‘Copy’, then ‘Disc  
backup’ from the Home Menu.  
• To see the progress of the backup, press  
DISPLAY.  
Note  
1 When the copy mode is set to something other than High-Speed Copy for copying to a DVD-R/-RW ( Video mode)  
or DVD+R/+RW, the chapter markers of the original are not copied. Chapter markers are put into the copy at  
regular intervals, according to the Auto Chapter setting (see also Auto Chapter (Video) and Auto Chapter  
(DVD+R/+RW) on page 136).  
2 Optimized mode only available when copying to DVD. Due to remaining space on the disc or the title that you  
copy, this mode does not always exactly fill a disc.  
3 It is not possible to play this material directly from the HDD.  
106  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Copying and backup  
11  
• You can cancel the backup process by  
pressing ONE TOUCH COPY for more  
than one second.  
are using a DVD-RW or DVD+RW disc  
you can re-initialize it in order to make it  
usable again — see Initializing recordable  
DVD discs on page 72.)  
5
When the data has been copied, take  
out the disc and load a blank* recordable  
DVD.  
* If you’re using a DVD-RW or DVD+RW, the  
disc doesn’t have to be blank, although the  
previous contents of the disc will be erased in  
the backup process.  
7
After the recorder has finished  
recording the backup disc, you can select  
whether to make another backup of the  
same data or exit.  
Disc Back-up  
Disc back-up finished.  
To make another back-up copy, please load  
a recordable disc.  
Disc Back-up  
Disc content saved to Hard Disk Drive.  
Please eject the disc and load a  
recordable disc  
Cancel  
Start  
• Select Start to make another backup  
copy or Cancel to finish. If you want to  
make another backup copy, return to  
step 6 above.  
Cancel  
Start  
You can use a DVD-R ver. 2.0, 2.1 or 2.2 disc,  
or DVD-RW ver. 1.1 or ver. 1.2 disc for the  
backup.  
8
If you don’t need to keep the backup  
data on the HDD, you can delete it now.  
Select Yes to delete the data from the HDD;  
select No to keep it (you can delete it later if  
you want to).  
• If you backup a DVD-R disc to DVD-RW,  
you cannot undo the finalization later.  
• Actual recordable capacity of discs vary  
so there may be cases where the  
contents of the disc you’re backing-up  
will not fit on to a particular blank disc. If  
this happens, please try another brand of  
disc.  
Disc Back-up  
The backed-up data is still on the HDD.  
Erasing it will increase the free space  
available. OK to Erase?  
No  
Yes  
• DVD-R/-RW discs can only be backed up  
to DVD-R/-RW discs; DVD+R/+RW  
discs can only be backed up to DVD+R/  
+RW discs.  
• If you decide to leave the backup data on  
the HDD, you can make backup copies  
to recordable DVD discs anytime from  
the Disc Back-up menu.  
6
Select ‘Start’ to start writing the  
backed-up data to the blank disc.  
Disc Back-up  
Write back-up data from Hard Disk Drive.  
The disc contents will be overwritten.  
OK to start?  
Cancel  
Start  
• To see the progress of the backup, press  
DISPLAY.  
• You can cancel the backup process by  
pressing ONE TOUCH COPY for more  
than one second. However, this will  
make the disc unusable (although if you  
107  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Jukebox  
12  
Chapter 12  
Using the Jukebox  
The Jukebox feature allows you to use the  
ENTER  
recorder’s HDD to store and playback music  
from up to 999 of your CDs. You can also  
transfer WMA/MP3 files stored on CD-R/  
-RW/-ROM, DVD, USB device or PC. Once on  
the HDD, you can name albums and tracks,  
assign them a genre, and set tracks that you  
don’t want to play to Jump.  
3
Select ‘DVD/CD to HDD’.  
On pressing ENTER all tracks (or files) on the  
CD or all WMA/MP3 files on the DVD are  
copied to the HDD.  
• You can also start copying by starting  
playback of the CD/DVD and then  
pressing ONE TOUCH COPY.  
Copying music to the HDD  
• To cancel copying press ENTER.  
• If the CD loaded contains both CD audio  
tracks and WMA/MP3 files, the part  
currently selected will play.  
The first step is to copy some music to the  
HDD. CD audio, WMA and MP3 files are  
copied at high speed. All tracks are copied  
1
from each CD/DVD as an album.  
Copying files via USB  
WMA/MP3 album and track names are  
copied along with the audio. CD album and  
track names are not copied, but you can add  
these later (see Editing Jukebox albums on  
page 112).  
Connecting a regular USB device  
You can copy WMA or MP3 files from a  
connected USB device, such as a USB drive,  
to the HDD.  
Usually, the tracks are copied to the HDD in  
the order they appear on the CD/DVD.  
1
2
Connect the USB device.  
Note that once copied to the HDD, audio tracks  
cannot be copied to a recordable DVD disc.  
HOME MENU  
Select ‘Jukebox’ from the Home  
Menu.  
Important  
ENTER  
3
Select ‘Listen to Music from  
• While copying, no other recorder  
operation is possible.  
USB Device’.  
• When copying, scheduled timer  
recordings will not start until copying is  
complete.  
ENTER  
4
Select ‘Copy Album’ from the  
command menu panel.  
• Copy protected CDs may not copy  
successfully.  
ENTER  
5
Select ‘Yes’ to confirm or ‘No’  
1
Load the CD/DVD you want to copy  
to the HDD.  
to cancel.  
The selected folder on the USB device will be  
copied to the HDD.  
HOME MENU  
2
Select ‘Copy’ from the Home  
Menu.  
Note  
1 • Up to 999 albums can be created in the Jukebox. If you copy via Connect PC, the total number of albums you  
are able to create may be less than 999 (for more information, see page 110).  
• Sound quality is not worsened when you copy data from another source.  
• When playing back an album copied from a source whose original audio track plays continuously (such as a  
live recording), there will be a brief pause in sound between tracks.  
108  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Jukebox  
12  
• Up to 99 folders/999 files on the USB  
device can be copied/displayed.  
HOME MENU  
2
Select ‘Jukebox’ from the Home  
Menu.  
Connect PC  
ENTER  
Using a USB connection, you can copy  
WMA and MP3 files from a PC to the HDD of  
this device. Operations carried out on the PC  
require Windows Media Player 10.  
3
Select ‘Connect PC’.  
ENTER  
4
Select ‘Yes’ to confirm, or ‘No’  
to cancel.  
5
Verify that the import screen is  
Important  
displayed on the device.  
• If the PC you are using does not currently  
have Windows Media Player 10 installed,  
you must first install the program and  
make sure it functions correctly before  
connecting the USB cable and attempting  
to use the Connect PC function.  
If no actions are carried out for 20 minutes,  
the import screen is automatically closed. To  
reopen it, you will have to repeat steps 2  
through 4.  
Number of copied  
folders  
Number of files  
unable to be copied  
Status  
• For more information on Connect PC,  
see Using a PC on page 23.  
Connect PC  
Standby  
• You cannot edit or delete albums from  
this device when it is connected to a PC  
via USB. If you wish to edit or delete  
albums via the Jukebox, you must first  
disconnect the USB cable.  
000 Folders  
000000 Files  
( 000 error  
( 000 error  
)
)
Exit  
1
Connect the PC via USB cable.  
The screen below is displayed. Choose ‘Take  
Number of copied files  
Open Windows Media Player 10 on  
the PC.  
The device settings screen appears. Click  
‘Cancel’.  
no action’ and click ‘OK’.  
6
*Depending on the settings for Windows  
Media Player 10, the screen shown below  
may not be displayed.  
'Take no action'  
*Depending on the settings for Windows  
Media Player 10, the screen shown below  
may not be displayed.  
'Cancel'  
109  
En  
'OK'  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Jukebox  
12  
From the PC, in Windows Media Player 10:  
7
When you have finished copying  
files, close Windows Media Player 10 on  
the PC.  
1. Click ‘Library’.  
2. Choose the artist, album or song  
you would like to copy, and press the  
right mouse button.  
3. Click ‘Add to Sync list’ (when  
choosing songs, click ‘Add to’ then  
‘Sync list’).  
ENTER  
8
Close the import screen on this  
device.  
• If no actions are carried out for 20  
minutes after copying, the import screen  
is automatically closed.  
4. Click ‘Start Sync’.  
This begins the synchronization process.  
When finished, the message ‘Synchronized  
to Device’ is displayed in Windows Media  
Player 10.  
Note  
• When using the sync function of  
Windows Media Player 10, music, artist  
and album folders are created as  
follows:  
Root  
music1.mp3  
music2.mp3  
Music  
Artist 1  
Album 1  
music1.wma  
Album 2  
Album 1  
music1.mp3  
Artist 2  
'Start Sync'  
• Folders containing no files are not  
displayed in the Jukebox (such as the  
above ‘Artist1’ and ‘Artist2’ folders), but  
do count toward the maximum of 999  
folders allowed in Jukebox.  
For more information refer to the Help menu  
of Windows Media Player 10.  
Progress Bar  
• Up to 999 tracks can be included in one  
album. Note that when there are many  
tracks contained in one album, it may  
take time to display and transfer these  
tracks.  
Connect PC  
Copying  
001 Folders  
000003 Files  
( 000 error  
( 000 error  
)
)
Exit  
• Albums and tracks with no set name that  
are transferred from CD/DVD/USB are  
displayed as ‘UnknownAlbum’ and  
‘UnknownFile’ in Windows Media Player  
10.  
• To cancel the synchronization process  
while it is underway, press ENTER on the  
remote control. The Connect PC screen  
is closed.  
• Album and track names that do not  
conform to the ISO8859-1 standard may  
display differently in Windows Media  
Player 10 and the Jukebox.  
• If synchronization fails, make sure that  
the Pioneer. HDD/DVD-Recorder device  
is selected at the synchronization screen  
of Windows Media Player 10, and try  
again.  
• When albums are deleted in the  
Jukebox, their file hierarchy as displayed  
in Windows Media Player may change.  
110  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Jukebox  
12  
• File whose extensions are not supported  
by the Jukebox (i.e. files that are not  
.mp3 or .wma) cannot be transferred.  
• If you want to start playback from a  
selected track in an album, or play a  
track that is set to Jump, press to  
enter the track list then select a track to  
play.  
• Files imported to this recorder via  
Connect PC cannot be exported from  
this recorder.  
Track name  
• Note that no recording functions,  
including timer recordings, will be  
carried out when you are using the  
Connect PC function.  
Jukebox  
10Albums  
3
4
Album1  
Album2  
ALL  
1
Play  
Erase  
Edit  
Mars  
By number  
5
6
7
8
9
Album3  
Album4  
Album5  
Album6  
Album7  
2
Venus  
3
Mercury  
Jupiter  
Saturn  
Uranus  
Neptune  
Play Mode  
4
All Genres  
5
Genre Name  
6
7
Playing music from the  
Jukebox  
10 Album8  
Jupiter  
HDD  
3-10  
classical  
MP3  
8 MB  
0.03.58  
Remain  
47.0  
G
You can select albums or individual tracks  
from the Jukebox to play.  
• Press  
change the page.  
SUBTITLE or  
ANGLE to  
HOME MENU  
1
Select ‘Jukebox’ from the Home  
Menu.  
Changing the album view  
ENTER  
2
Select a Jukebox option.  
1
From the album list, display  
Listen to Music/Edit – Listen to CDs or  
WMA/MP3 files that have been copied to  
the HDD.  
the view options menu panel.  
ENTER  
Listen to Music from USB device –  
Listen to music from an external USB  
device.  
2
Select a view option.  
Jukebox  
10Albums  
bum1  
ALL  
1
Play  
Sort
By number m2  
Erase  
Edit  
By
By favourite  
ENTER  
m3  
m4  
m5  
m6  
m7  
2
By album  
Genr
3
3
Select what you want to play.  
Play Mode  
4
A
Cancel  
5
The screen below shows albums stored on  
the HDD:  
Genre Name  
6
7
m8  
Album1 The Planets/Mars-Venus-Mercury-Jup  
iter-Saturn-Uranus-Nep classical  
Total 12 70 MB  
HDD  
G
3-10  
0.03.58  
Album name  
Remain  
47.0  
Jukebox  
10Albums  
Sort order  
3
4
Album1  
Album2  
ALL  
1
Play  
Erase  
Edit  
By number – Albums are listed by the  
album number.  
By number  
5
6
7
8
9
Album3  
Album4  
Album5  
Album6  
Album7  
2
3
Play Mode  
4
All Genres  
By favourite – Most often listened to  
music appears at the top of the list.  
5
Genre Name  
6
7
10 Album8  
By album – Albums are listed  
alphabetically.  
Album1 The Planets/Mars-Venus-Mercury-Jup  
HDD  
3-10  
0.03.58  
iter-Saturn-Uranus-Nep  
Total 12 70 MB  
classical  
Remain  
47.0  
G
Info for selected album  
Playback status  
• If you select a whole album to play, all  
tracks that are not set to Jump will play.  
111  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Jukebox  
12  
Genre  
Editing Jukebox albums  
Jukebox  
10Albums  
A number of commands are available for  
editing and changing the playback behavior  
of albums.  
bum1  
m2  
ALL  
1
Play  
Erase  
Edit  
Sort
All Genre  
s
By
No Category  
m3  
m4  
m5  
m6  
m7  
2
Best  
Genr
3
Rock  
Play Mode  
Pop  
4
A
Jazz  
HOME MENU  
5
1
Select ‘Jukebox’ from the Home  
Genre Name  
Classical  
6
Menu.  
7
m8  
Album1 The Planets/Mars-Venus-Mercury-Jup  
iter-Saturn-Uranus-Nep classical  
Total 12 70 MB  
HDD  
G
3-10  
0.03.58  
ENTER  
ENTER  
ENTER  
Remain  
47.0  
2
3
4
Select ‘Listen to Music/Edit’.  
Select what you want to edit.  
Select an edit function from  
All Genres – All albums are displayed.  
Genre – Only albums in the selected  
genre are displayed.  
the command menu panel.  
Erase – Erase the selected track (if all  
tracks in an album are selected, the  
whole album is erased).  
Edit > Album name – Enter a name of  
up to 64 characters for the album. See  
Title Name on page 91 for how to enter  
names.  
Edit > Track name – Enter a name of up  
to 64 characters for the track. See Title  
Name on page 91 for how to enter  
names.  
Edit > Set Genre – Set or change the  
genre for the album.  
1
Edit > Jump Set – Set a track to jump  
so that it doesn’t play (choose this  
command again to cancel the Jump  
setting).  
Play Mode – Change the playback order  
for albums and tracks.  
Genre Name – Enter a name of up to 12  
characters for a genre. See Title Name  
on page 91 for how to enter names.  
Note  
112  
En  
1 Tracks set to Jump will be skipped during consecutive track playback.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The PhotoViewer  
13  
Chapter 13  
The PhotoViewer  
From the PhotoViewer you can view JPEG  
photos and picture files stored on the HDD,  
recordable DVD or CD-R/-RW/-ROM, or on a  
USB-equipped digital camera. You can also  
import files and save them to the recorder’s  
HDD or a DVD-R/-RW disc.  
The first image from the selected folder is  
displayed as thumbnail at the bottom of the  
screen. From the Folder Information  
column, you can change thumbnails via the  
ꢈ/ꢉ buttons.  
1
Currently selected  
folder in folder list  
PhotoViewer HDD  
Locating JPEG picture files  
Select Folder  
001 Folder1  
002  
003  
004  
005  
Folder2  
Folder3  
Folder4  
Folder5  
HOME MENU  
Folder  
1
Select ‘PhotoViewer’ from the  
Home Menu.  
FOLDER  
MENU  
006 Folder6  
007  
008  
Folder7  
Folder8  
ENTER  
2
Select the location of the files  
HDD  
002 Folder2  
Files  
Folder  
999  
999 MB  
Remain  
100.0  
you want to view or edit.  
1/3  
G
Pages in  
folder list  
View/Edit Photos on the HDD  
View Photos on a CD/DVD  
Folder information  
View Photos on a USB Device  
Copy Files from a Digital Camera  
4
Select the file you want to  
view, copy or edit.  
View/Edit Photos on the HDD – View  
or edit photos already stored on the  
recorder’s HDD.  
Currently selected  
thumbnail  
PhotoViewer HDD  
Folder2  
View Photos on a CD/DVD – View  
photos on a Fujicolor CD, CD-ROM,  
CD-R/-RW, or DVD-R/-RW.  
Folder Size 999 MB  
001 PIOR0000  
002 PIOR0001  
003 PIOR0002  
File  
004 PIOR0003  
005 PIOR0004  
FILE  
MENU  
View Photos on a USB Device – View  
photos on a digital camera (or other USB  
device) connected to the USB port.  
12 Files  
006 PIOR0005  
007 PIOR0006  
008 PIOR0007  
009 PIOR0008  
010 PIOR0009  
011 PIOR0010  
012 PIOR0011  
HDD  
Copy Files from a Digital Camera –  
Copy all DCF files directly from a  
connected digital camera to a  
recordable DVD-R/-RW.  
Remain  
100.0  
1/84  
G
Pages in  
file list  
• The larger the file size, the longer it takes  
the recorder to load the file.  
ENTER  
3
Select the folder containing  
• You can change folders via the ꢈ/ꢉ  
buttons.  
the files you want to view, copy or edit.  
Note  
1 Up to 999 files or 99 folders are viewable, but if there are more files/folders than this on the disc or connected  
USB camera it is still possible to view them all using the Reload function (see Reloading files from a disc or USB  
device on page 115).  
113  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The PhotoViewer  
13  
• If you encounter a disc that will not play,  
check that the disc and file formats are  
compatible with this recorder (see JPEG  
file compatibility and PC-created disc  
compatibility on page 11).  
Playing a slideshow  
ENTER  
1
Select a folder from the folder  
• The thumbnail of files that cannot be  
list.  
played is displayed as the  
logo.  
To start the slideshow from the first file in the  
folder, skip to step 3 after choosing the  
desired folder and pressing .  
Changing the display style of  
the PhotoViewer  
You can choose to display photos by  
grouping them by folder, file, or number of  
thumbnails.  
2
Select a thumbnail.  
• Use PREV and NEXT to display  
the previous/next page of thumbnails.  
ENTER  
3
Select ‘Start Slideshow’ or  
1
Display the View Options  
‘Start Audio Slideshow’ from the menu.  
When you select ‘Start Audio Slideshow’,  
you are prompted to select the Genre of  
music you would like to hear, and when you  
press ENTER, music of that Genre stored on  
the Jukebox will be played during the  
slideshow.  
panel.  
The View Options panel  
PhotoViewer HDD  
Folder2  
Folder Size 999 MB  
PIOR0000  
Display Mode  
PIOR0001  
PIOR0002  
PIOR0003  
PIOR0004  
PIOR0005  
PIOR0006  
PIOR0007  
PIOR0008  
010 PIOR0009  
011 PIOR0010  
012 PIOR0011  
File  
Style  
For more information on adding music to the  
HDD, see Using the Jukebox on page 108.  
12 Files  
FILE  
MENU  
• You can also select a file or folder then  
press PLAY to start playing the  
slideshow.  
HDD  
Remain  
100.0  
1/84  
G
• Use PREV/NEXT to display the  
previous/next picture, or PAUSE to  
pause the slideshow.  
ENTER  
2
Choose ‘Display Mode’ or  
• Depending on the aspect ratio, some  
pictures may be displayed with black  
bars top and bottom, or left and right.  
‘Style’ then press ENTER to see the  
available view options.  
Display Mode – Choose between folder  
and file display modes.  
• Large picture files may take a few  
seconds to display. This is normal.  
Style – Choose between displays of 1, 4  
and 12 thumbnails.  
STOP  
4
5
Press to return to the thumbnail.  
• You can also use the RETURN/EXIT  
button.  
ENTER  
3
Choose a view option, then  
press ENTER.  
The display mode will change to that which  
HOME MENU  
Press to exit the PhotoViewer.  
you have chosen.  
114  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The PhotoViewer  
13  
Zooming an image  
Importing files to the HDD  
During a slideshow you can zoom in to  
enlarge a portion of the picture by a factor of  
two or four. You can also move the area of  
the picture displayed.  
You can import files and save them to the  
2
HDD from a CD, DVD or a connected USB  
camera. Once on the HDD you can edit and  
organize your pictures and print them out if  
you’ve connected a PictBridge-compatible  
printer.  
ENTER  
1
Press during the slideshow to  
zoom the picture.  
Repeated presses cycle between zoom off,  
2x zoom and 4x zoom. The zoom factor is  
displayed on-screen.  
ENTER  
1
Select the location of folders/  
files you want to import.  
To import a whole folder, select the desired  
folder, press , and skip to step 3 below.  
2
Use to move the zoomed  
area.  
• To import multiple folders, use the Multi-  
Mode; see Selecting multiple files or  
folders on page 116.  
Rotating an image  
You can rotate the displayed picture during a  
slideshow so you can always view pictures  
the right way up, whichever way they were  
taken.  
2
Select a file to import, then  
press ꢀ  
.
ANGLE  
• To import multiple files, use the Multi-  
Mode; see Selecting multiple files or  
folders on page 116.  
Press during the slideshow to  
rotate the displayed picture clockwise by  
90º.  
Press repeatedly to continue rotating the  
ENTER  
picture in increments of 90º.  
3
Select ‘Copy to HDD’ from the  
menu.  
Reloading files from a disc or  
USB device  
PhotoViewer CD/DVD  
Folder2  
Folder Size 999 MB  
Start Slideshow  
001 PIOR0000  
002 PIOR0001  
Copy all to HDD  
Copy to HDD  
File  
If you have a disc with more than 1000 files  
and/or 100 folders, you can still view all the  
images using the reload function.  
003 PIOR0002  
004 PIOR0003  
005 PIOR0004  
006 PIOR0005  
007 PIOR0006  
008 PIOR0007  
009 PIOR0008  
010 PIOR0009  
011 PIOR0010  
012 PIOR0011  
Print  
Detailed Information
12 Files  
Multi-Mode  
HDD  
Remain  
100.0  
1/84  
G
1
Navigate to the last entry in  
the folder list (‘Read next: ...’).  
ENTER  
ENTER  
2
Load the next batch of up to 999  
4
Select ‘Yes’ to confirm and  
files/99 folders from the disc or  
connected USB device.  
It will take a moment (at most a few minutes)  
copy the folder(s)/file(s), or ‘No’ to  
cancel.  
• The files will be copied to the HDD with  
1
the same folder structure as the original.  
to load in the images.  
Note  
1 You can press HOME MENU to exit the PhotoViewer screen while the recorder is reloading images. (If you enter  
the PhotoViewer again, it will resume reloading.)  
2 For files you want to keep permanently, we recommend backing up to DVD-R/-RW.  
115  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The PhotoViewer  
13  
• Importing to the HDD will not work if  
there is insufficient space on the HDD,  
or if there are already the maximum  
number of files and/or folders on the  
HDD (999 folders/999 files per folder).  
ENTER  
4
list.  
Select files/folders from the  
An orange check mark box () is shown by  
the item you selected. A blue check mark  
box () appears on the folder select screen  
when files from that folder are selected.  
Selecting multiple files or  
folders  
PhotoViewer HDD  
Multi-Mode  
Select Folder  
001 Folder1  
The Multi-Mode allows you to select multiple  
folders/files at once for importing or editing.  
02  
003  
004  
005  
Folder2  
Folder3  
Folder4  
Folder5  
Folder  
FOLDER  
MENU  
ENTER  
006 Folder6  
1
Select the folder containing  
007  
008  
Folder7  
Folder8  
the files you want to import.  
HDD  
002 Folder2  
Files  
999  
Remain  
100.0  
Folder  
999 MB  
1/3  
G
2
Display the command menu.  
5
6
Display the command menu.  
Select the command you want  
ENTER  
3
Select ‘Multi-Mode’ from the  
ENTER  
menu.  
to apply to all the selected items.  
PhotoViewer HDD  
Select Folder  
001 Folder1  
Start Slideshow  
Start Audio Slideshow  
New Folder  
002  
003  
004  
005  
Folder2  
Folder3  
Folder4  
Folder5  
Copying files to a DVD-R/-RW  
Folder  
Folder Options  
Copy to DVD  
Multi-Mode  
1
Using this feature you can copy all the files  
006 Folder6  
007  
008  
Folder7  
Folder8  
(including audio and movie files) stored on a  
connected USB camera to a recordable DVD  
disc.  
HDD  
G
002 Folder2  
Files  
Folder  
999  
999 MB  
Remain  
100.0  
1/3  
A slideshow of the files is also recorded on  
the disc as a Video mode title, making it  
possible to view the photos on other DVD  
players/recorders that may not be  
compatible with JPEG file playback.  
Once the files have been copied, the disc is  
automatically finalized.  
Note  
1 • There is a limit to the number of files/amount of data that you can copy at one time.  
• Only DCF format files in DCIM folders can be copied to a recordable DVD-R/-RW.  
116  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The PhotoViewer  
13  
Important  
Important  
• A maximum of 99 slideshow titles can be  
recorded.  
• Use a blank DVD-R/-RW disc, or one that  
has already been initialized for Video  
mode recording but has nothing yet  
recorded on it. Discs that have already  
been recorded on (as well as CD-R/-RW  
discs) cannot be used.  
• One slideshow title can contain up to 99  
files. If there are more files than this in  
the slideshow, multiple slideshows are  
created on the disc.  
• If you erase a slideshow title from a DVD  
the slideshow will become unplayable  
but the free space will not increase.  
• After backing up the pictures in your  
digital camera to DVD, we recommend  
verifying that they have been recorded  
properly before deleting anything from  
the camera.  
1
Load a blank (or unfinalized Video  
mode) DVD-R or DVD-RW disc.  
1
Press HOME MENU and select  
ENTER  
‘PhotoViewer’ to display the  
PhotoViewer screen.  
2
Select ‘View/Edit Photos on  
the HDD’ from the menu.  
2
Load a blank (or unrecorded Video  
mode) DVD-R or DVD-RW disc.  
Select ‘Copy Files from a Digital  
ENTER  
3
3
Select the file(s) or folder(s)  
Camera’ from the menu.  
you want to copy.  
• Copying a folder will copy all the files  
contained in it.  
View/Edit Photos on the HDD  
View Photos on a CD/DVD  
• To copy multiple folders, use the Multi-  
Mode; see Selecting multiple files or  
folders on page 116.  
View Photos on a USB Device  
Copy Files from a Digital Camera  
4
Select ‘Yes’ to confirm, or ‘No’ to  
ENTER  
cancel.  
4
Select ‘Copy to DVD’ from the  
• Note that during copying, any timer  
programmes set to start will not begin,  
and no other operations are possible.  
menu.  
ENTER  
5
Select ‘Yes’ to confirm or ‘No’  
Copying selected files to a  
DVD-R/-RW  
to cancel.  
• Folder names on the disc will be  
number PIONR. File names will be  
PHOT number.  
This feature allows you just to copy some of  
the files stored on HDD to a DVD.  
• Note that during copying, any timer  
programmes set to start will not begin,  
and no other operation is possible.  
A slideshow of the files is also recorded on  
the disc as a Video mode title, making it  
possible to view the photos on other DVD  
players/recorders that may not be  
• While ‘Cancel’ is displayed, you can  
press ENTER to cancel.  
compatible with JPEG file playback. Note  
however that you may need to finalize the  
disc before it will play on another DVD player  
(copying selected files doesn’t automatically  
finalize the disc).  
117  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The PhotoViewer  
13  
Editing files on the HDD  
There are a number of commands you can  
use to edit and organize your pictures stored  
on the HDD.  
2
3
Display the command menu.  
Select ‘File Options’ or ‘Folder  
ENTER  
Creating a new folder  
Options’.  
PhotoViewer HDD  
Folder2  
Folder Size 999 MB  
Start Slideshow  
001 PIOR0000  
002 PIOR0001  
003 PIOR0002  
004 PIOR0003  
005 PIOR0004  
006 PIOR0005  
007 PIOR0006  
008 PIOR0007  
009 PIOR0008  
010 PIOR0009  
011 PIOR0010  
012 PIOR0011  
1
From the folder list, display  
Start Audio Slideshow  
File Options  
Print  
File  
the menu.  
Copy to DVD  
12 Files  
Detailed Information  
Multi-Mode  
ENTER  
2
Select ‘New Folder’.  
HDD  
The folder appears at the bottom of the folder  
list with the name F_number.  
Remain  
1/84  
100.0  
G
PhotoViewer HDD  
Select Folder  
ENTER  
4
Select ‘Erase’ or ‘Erase Folder’.  
001 Folder1  
Start Slideshow  
002  
003  
004  
005  
Folder2  
Folder3  
Folder4  
Folder5  
Start Audio Slideshow  
New Folder  
Folder  
PhotoViewer HDD  
Folder2  
Folder Options  
Copy to DVD  
Multi-Mode  
Folder Size 999 MB  
006 Folder6  
001 PIOR0000  
Erase  
Copy  
007  
008  
Folder7  
Folder8  
002 PIOR0001  
003 PIOR0002  
004 PIOR0003  
005 PIOR0004  
006 PIOR0005  
007 PIOR0006  
008 PIOR0007  
009 PIOR0008  
010 PIOR0009  
011 PIOR0010  
012 PIOR0011  
File  
Rename File  
HDD  
002 Folder2  
Files  
Folder  
Lock  
999  
999 MB  
12 Files  
Remain  
100.0  
1/3  
G
Cancel  
• There can be up to 999 folders on the  
HDD.  
HDD  
Remain  
100.0  
1/84  
G
Erasing a file or folder  
ENTER  
5
to cancel.  
Select ‘Yes’ to confirm, or ‘No’  
1
Select the file(s) or folder(s)  
• You can also erase a file or folder by  
pressing CLEAR when the file or folder is  
highlighted. Press ENTER to confirm.  
you want to erase.  
• To erase multiple files or folders, use the  
Multi-Mode; see Selecting multiple files  
or folders on page 116.  
Copying files  
• Erasing a folder will erase all the files  
contained in it. Please be careful!  
• You can’t erase files that have been  
locked.  
1
Select the file(s) or folder(s)  
you want to copy.  
• Folders containing locked files can’t be  
erased. Unlocked files in the folder,  
however, will be erased.  
• Copying a folder will copy all the files  
contained in it.  
• To copy multiple files or folders, use the  
Multi-Mode; see Selecting multiple files  
or folders on page 116.  
118  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The PhotoViewer  
13  
3
Select ‘Rename File’ or ‘Rename  
Folder’.  
2
3
Display the command menu.  
PhotoViewer HDD  
Folder2  
Folder Size 999 MB  
001 PIOR0000  
002 PIOR0001  
003 PIOR0002  
004 PIOR0003  
005 PIOR0004  
006 PIOR0005  
007 PIOR0006  
008 PIOR0007  
009 PIOR0008  
010 PIOR0009  
011 PIOR0010  
012 PIOR0011  
ENTER  
Erase  
Copy  
Select ‘File Options’ or ‘Folder  
Select ‘Copy’ or ‘Copy Folder  
File  
Rename File  
Options’.  
Lock  
12 Files  
Cancel  
ENTER  
4
HDD  
Remain  
100.0  
Contents’.  
1/84  
G
4
Enter a new name for the file/folder.  
PhotoViewer HDD  
Folder2  
Folder Size 999 MB  
File names or Folder names can be up to 64  
characters long.  
001 PIOR0000  
002 PIOR0001  
003 PIOR0002  
004 PIOR0003  
005 PIOR0004  
006 PIOR0005  
007 PIOR0006  
008 PIOR0007  
009 PIOR0008  
010 PIOR0009  
011 PIOR0010  
012 PIOR0011  
Erase  
Copy  
File  
See Using the remote key shortcuts to input  
a name and Using a USB keyboard to enter a  
name on page 92 for how to enter a name.  
Rename File  
Lock  
12 Files  
Cancel  
HDD  
Locking/Unlocking files  
Locking files will protect them from  
accidental erasure and prevent them from  
being renamed.  
Remain  
1/84  
100.0  
G
ENTER  
5
Select a folder to copy the  
folder(s)/file(s) to.  
Use the same process to both lock and  
unlock files. Locked files are displayed in the  
PhotoViewer with a padlock icon.  
ENTER  
6
Select ‘Yes’ to confirm, or ‘No’  
to cancel.  
• Copying to the HDD will not work if there  
is insufficient space on the HDD; if there  
are already the maximum number of  
files and/or folders on the HDD.  
1
Select the file(s) you want to  
lock (or unlock).  
• To lock/unlock multiple files or folders,  
use the Multi-Mode; see Selecting  
multiple files or folders on page 116.  
Naming files and folders  
1
Select the file or folder you want to  
2
3
Display the command menu.  
Select ‘File Options’ or ‘Folder  
rename.  
You can’t rename files that have been  
locked.  
ENTER  
2
Select ‘File Options’ or ‘Folder  
Options’.  
Options’.  
119  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The PhotoViewer  
13  
ENTER  
4
Select ‘Lock’ or ‘Lock Folder  
2
3
Display the command menu.  
Select ‘Print’ from the menu.  
Contents’.  
PhotoViewer HDD  
ENTER  
Folder2  
Folder Size 999 MB  
001 PIOR0000  
002 PIOR0001  
003 PIOR0002  
004 PIOR0003  
005 PIOR0004  
006 PIOR0005  
007 PIOR0006  
008 PIOR0007  
009 PIOR0008  
010 PIOR0009  
011 PIOR0010  
012 PIOR0011  
Erase  
Copy  
File  
Rename File  
PhotoViewer HDD  
Folder2  
Lock  
Folder Size 999 MB  
Start Slideshow  
12 Files  
001 PIOR0000  
Cancel  
002 PIOR0001  
003 PIOR0002  
004 PIOR0003  
005 PIOR0004  
006 PIOR0005  
007 PIOR0006  
008 PIOR0007  
009 PIOR0008  
010 PIOR0009  
011 PIOR0010  
012 PIOR0011  
Start Audio Slideshow  
File Options  
Print  
File  
HDD  
Copy to DVD  
Remain  
100.0  
12 Files  
1/84  
Detailed Information  
Multi-Mode  
G
Locked files are shown with a padlock icon  
next to them. To remove all locks within a  
given folder, choose ‘Folder Option’ >  
‘Unlock Folder Contents’.  
HDD  
Remain  
100.0  
1/84  
G
ENTER  
To view detailed information  
This feature allows you to check the settings  
of the camera from which you imported the  
photos.  
4
Select ‘Start’ to confirm, or  
‘Cancel’ to cancel.  
• Once printing has started, you can  
cancel by pressing ENTER.  
1
Choose the file for which you would  
like to see detailed information.  
Choose ‘Detailed Information’.  
Tip  
2
• Paper size and layout can be set; the  
options available depend on your printer  
— check the printer manual for details.  
When no detailed information is available,  
nothing is displayed.  
• This recorder may not work correctly  
with all printers.  
Printing files  
Connecting a PictBridge-compatible printer  
to the USB port will enable you to print out  
1
picture files stored on the HDD, a CD/DVD,  
or directly from a digital camera.  
Make sure that the printer (and your digital  
camera if you are using that as a source) is  
connected to the recorder before starting.  
1
Select the file(s) you want to  
print.  
• To print multiple files, use the Multi-  
Mode; see Selecting multiple files or  
folders on page 116.  
Note  
120  
En  
1 Picture files should be standard DCF format. Non-standard files may not print properly.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Disc Setup menu  
14  
Chapter 14  
The Disc Setup menu  
From the Disc Setup menu you can name  
discs, lock the contents to prevent  
accidental recording and erasure, initialize  
and finalize discs. The Disc Setup menu is  
accessed from the Home menu.  
Lock Disc  
DVD (VR) DVD-RAM  
• Default setting: Off  
Locking the disc will prevent accidental  
recording, editing or erasing of the disc.  
Basic settings  
Important  
Input Disc Name  
• A locked disc can still be initialized  
(which will completely erase the disc).  
DVD (VR) DVD (Video) DVD+R DVD+RW DVD-RAM  
HOME MENU  
1
Select ‘Disc Setup’ from the  
When you initialize a disc for recording, the  
recorder automatically assigns a name for  
the disc ranging from DISC 1 to DISC 99. You  
can use the Input Disc Name function to  
change the default disc name to something  
more descriptive. This name appears when  
you load the disc and when you display disc  
information on-screen.  
Home Menu.  
ENTER  
2
Select ‘Basic’ > ‘Lock Disc’  
then ‘On’ or ‘Off’.  
Disc Setup  
On  
Off  
Basic  
Input Disc Name  
Initialize  
Finalize  
Lock Disc  
DVD-RW Auto Init.  
HOME MENU  
1
Select ‘Disc Setup’ from the  
Optimize HDD  
Home Menu.  
ENTER  
2
Select ‘Basic’ > ‘Input Disc  
Set to On to prevent accidental recording,  
editing or erasing of the disc loaded. If you  
need to unlock the disc to make edits, select  
Off.  
Name’ > ‘Next Screen’.  
Disc Setup  
Input Disc Name  
Lock Disc  
Next Screen  
Basic  
Initialize  
Finalize  
DVD-RW Auto Init.  
Optimize HDD  
DVD-RW Auto Initialize  
DVD-RW  
• Default setting: VR Mode  
Initialization mode is automatically carried  
out when you insert a blank DVD-RW. You  
must set the desired initialization mode  
before inserting a disc.  
ENTER  
3
Input a name for the disc.  
The disc name can be up to 64 characters  
long for a VR mode disc, or 40 for a Video  
mode discs and DVD+R/+RW.  
See DVD-RW Auto Initialize on page 73 for  
detailed instructions.  
• See Title Name on page 91 for more on  
navigating the input screen.  
121  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Disc Setup menu  
14  
Undo Finalize  
Initialize settings  
DVD-RW  
DVD-R DVD-RW DVD+RW DVD-RAM  
You can undo the finalization on DVD-RW  
discs recorded on this recorder in Video  
mode. You need to do this if you want to  
record more material or edit material already  
on the disc.  
You can initialize a recordable DVD-R/-RW  
disc for either VR mode or Video mode  
recording.  
The first time you load a new DVD-RW disc,  
it will be automatically initialized for  
recording according to the DVD-RW Auto  
Init. setting in the Disc Setup menu (see  
page 73).  
You can also undo the finalization of VR  
mode discs which have been finalized on  
other DVD recorders. If when you load a disc  
the message This disc cannot be recorded.  
Undo the finalization. is displayed, use  
this command to be able to record on the  
disc using this recorder.  
New DVD-R discs are ready for Video mode  
recording when you load them, but it is also  
possible to initialize them for VR mode  
1
recording.  
HOME MENU  
1
Select ‘Disc Setup’ from the  
DVD+RW and DVD-RAM discs can also be  
initialized as a way of erasing the entire disc.  
When initializing a DVD-RAM disc, select VR  
mode.  
Home Menu.  
ENTER  
2
Select ‘Finalize’ > ‘Undo  
See Initializing recordable DVD discs on  
page 72 for detailed instructions.  
Finalize’ then ‘Start’.  
Optimize HDD  
Finalize settings  
HDD  
Finalize  
As you record, erase and edit recordings, the  
HDD file system gradually becomes  
fragmented. Periodically, the HDD will need  
optimizing to ‘clean up’ all the fragmented  
files.  
DVD-R DVD-RW DVD+R DVD+RW  
Finalizing ‘fixes’ the recordings in place so  
that the disc can be played on a regular DVD  
player or computer equipped with a suitable  
DVD-ROM drive.  
When the HDD needs optimizing the  
recorder will automatically display a  
message recommending optimization.  
It is also possible to finalize DVD+RW discs.  
This is only necessary if you want to a player  
to display a title menu for the disc.  
Important  
See Playing your recordings on other DVD  
players on page 71 for detailed instructions.  
• Optimizing the HDD can take as long as  
eight hours. During optimization,  
playback and recording are not possible.  
• Cancelling optimization mid-way does  
not undo the optimization already done,  
so the HDD will be partly optimized.  
Note  
1 Once initialized for VR mode recording it is not possible to re-initialize the disc for Video mode recording. Also,  
once recorded in Video mode, the disc cannot be re-initialized for VR mode recording.  
122  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Disc Setup menu  
14  
HOME MENU  
1
Select ‘Disc Setup’ from the  
Home Menu.  
ENTER  
2
Select ‘Optimize HDD’ then  
‘Start’.  
Disc Setup  
Start  
Basic  
Optimize HDD  
Initialize  
Finalize  
Optimize HDD  
A progress bar indicates how long there is  
left to go. If no actions are carried out for  
more than 20 minutes after the optimization  
process is completed, the unit turns itself  
off.  
Initialize HDD  
HDD  
When your HDD/DVD recorder is working  
without a problem this option is not visible in  
the Disc Setup menu. However, if the HDD  
file system becomes corrupted for some  
reason, you can initialize the HDD to fix the  
problem. Note that initializing the HDD will  
erase all the data on it.  
HOME MENU  
1
Select ‘Disc Setup’ from the  
Home Menu.  
ENTER  
2
Select ‘Initialize HDD’ then  
‘Start’.  
Disc Setup  
Start  
Basic  
Initialize HDD  
Initialize  
Finalize  
InitializeHDD
123  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Video Adjust menu  
15  
Chapter 15  
The Video Adjust menu  
Using the Video Adjust menu you can set up  
the picture quality for the built-in tuner and  
external inputs, for disc playback, and for  
recording.  
Memory1 – user preset 1  
Memory2 – user preset 2  
Memory3 – user preset 3  
You can press DISPLAY to see the individual  
settings for the current preset (Tuner, VCR  
or DTV/LDP).  
Setting the picture quality  
for TV and external inputs  
Creating your own set  
There are three user presets in which you  
can save your own set of picture quality  
settings.  
Picture Creation lets you choose a set of  
picture quality settings for the built-in TV  
1
tuner and for each external input. There are  
several preset settings that suit various  
sources, or you can create up to three of your  
own sets.  
1
Follow Choosing a preset above and  
select one of the user presets (Memory 1,  
2 or 3).  
Choosing a preset  
ENTER  
2
Select ‘Detailed Settings’.  
HOME MENU  
1
With the recorder stopped,  
press to display the Home Menu.  
Pr 1  
Memory1  
ENTER  
Detailed Settings  
2
3
Select ‘Video Adjust’.  
ENTER  
ENTER  
3
Select the setting you want to  
Select a preset.  
adjust.  
Pr 1  
Memory1  
Pr  
1
Tuner  
Detailed Settings  
Prog. Motion  
PureCinma  
3-D Y/C  
YNR  
Motion  
Still  
Auto  
• Use the INPUT SELECT button to switch  
between the built-in TV tuner and the  
external inputs.  
Motion  
Off  
Still  
Max  
Max  
Max  
CNR  
Off  
• Use the Smart Jog to change the  
channel of the built-in TV tuner.  
Detail  
Off  
White AGC  
Off  
There are six presets available:  
You can adjust the following settings:  
Tuner – suitable for general TV  
• Prog. Motion – Adjusts the motion and  
still picture quality when video output is  
set to progressive.  
broadcasts  
VCR – suitable for video cassettes  
DTV/LDP – suitable for digital  
broadcasts and Laserdiscs  
Note  
1 When the Component Video Out (see page 131) is set to Interlace, the settings for the digital tuner cannot be  
changed.  
124  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Video Adjust menu  
15  
• PureCinema – This setting optimizes the  
picture for film material when the video  
output is set to progressive. Usually set  
to Auto; but try switching to Off if the  
picture appears unnatural.  
Setting the picture quality  
for disc playback  
This setting determines how the picture will  
look when playing discs.  
• 3-D Y/C – Adjusts the brightness/colour  
separation.  
Choosing a preset  
• YNR – Adjusts the amount of noise  
reduction (NR) applied to the Y  
(brightness) component.  
HOME MENU  
1
With a disc playing (or paused),  
press to display the Home Menu.  
• CNR – Adjusts the amount of noise  
reduction (NR) applied to the C (colour)  
component.  
ENTER  
2
3
Select ‘Video Adjust’.  
Select a setting.  
Detail – Adjusts how sharp edges  
appear.  
ENTER  
White AGC – Turn on for automatic  
white level adjustment.  
TV  
White Level – Adjusts the intensity of  
white.  
Detailed Settings  
Black Level – Adjusts the intensity of  
black.  
There are six presets available:  
TV – suitable for LCD and cathode-ray  
tube TVs  
Black Setup – Corrects the standard  
reference black level (525 Input Line  
System only).  
PDP – suitable for plasma display  
screens  
Hue – Adjusts overall balance between  
red and green.  
Professional – suitable for professional  
monitors  
Chroma Level – Adjusts how rich the  
colours appear.  
Memory1 – user preset 1  
Memory2 – user preset 2  
Memory3 – user preset 3  
ENTER  
4
Adjust the currently selected  
You can press DISPLAY to see the individual  
settings for the current preset (TV, PDP or  
Professional).  
setting.  
HOME MENU  
5
Press to exit.  
You can now use the preset for any other  
input or the built-in TV tuner.  
Creating your own set  
There are three user presets in which you  
can save your own set of picture quality  
settings for disc playback.  
Tip  
• To see more of the picture as you adjust  
different settings, press ENTER after  
selecting the setting you want to adjust.  
1
Follow Choosing a preset above and  
select one of the user presets (Memory 1,  
2 or 3).  
125  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Video Adjust menu  
15  
2
Move the cursor down and select  
White Level – Adjusts the intensity of  
white. White Level is ineffective for HDMI  
output.  
‘Detailed Settings’.  
Black Level – Adjusts the intensity of  
black. Black Level is ineffective for HDMI  
output.  
Memory1  
Detailed Settings  
3
Select the picture quality setting you  
Black Setup – Corrects the standard  
reference black level. Black Setup is  
ineffective for HDMI output.  
want to adjust.  
Memory1  
Gamma Correction – Adjusts the  
brightness of darker images. Gamma  
Correction is ineffective for HDMI  
output.  
Prog. Motion  
PureCinma  
Motion  
Still  
Auto1  
YNR  
Off  
Off  
Max  
Max  
Max  
Fine  
Fine  
BNR  
Hue – Adjusts overall balance between  
red and green. Hue is ineffective for  
HDMI output.  
MNR  
Off  
Sharpness  
Detail  
Soft  
Soft  
Chroma Level – Adjusts how rich the  
colours appear. Chroma Level is  
ineffective for HDMI output.  
You can adjust the following settings:  
• Prog. Motion – Adjusts the motion and  
still picture quality when video output is  
set to progressive. (Prog. Motion is  
4
Use the ꢃ/ꢀ buttons to adjust the  
currently selected picture quality setting.  
ineffective when PureCinema is On.)  
5
When you have all the settings as you  
want them, press HOME MENU to exit.  
• PureCinema – This setting optimizes the  
picture for film material when the video  
output is set to progressive. Usually set  
to Auto 1 but try switching to Auto 2,  
On or Off if the picture appears  
unnatural.  
Tip  
• To see more of the picture as you adjust  
different settings, press ENTER after  
selecting the setting you want to adjust.  
YNR – Adjusts the amount of noise  
reduction (NR) applied to the Y  
(brightness) component.  
• BNR – Adjusts the amount of noise  
reduction (NR) applied to the block noise  
(artefacts visible in areas of flat colour,  
caused by MPEG compression).  
MNR – Adjusts the amount of noise  
reduction (NR) applied to the mosquito  
noise (artefacts visible around the edges  
of an image, caused by MPEG  
compression).  
Sharpness – Adjusts the sharpness of  
the high-frequency (detailed) elements  
in the picture. Sharpness is ineffective  
for HDMI output.  
Detail – Adjusts how sharp edges  
appear.  
126  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Initial Setup menu  
16  
Chapter 16  
The Initial Setup menu  
Using the Initial Setup menu  
The Initial Setup menu is where you can set various recorder options for sound, picture,  
language and so on.  
Some settings can only be changed when the recorder is stopped. During playback and  
recording these settings are grayed out in the Initial Setup menu.  
Except for the Setup Navigator, menu screens are exited automatically after 20 minutes of  
inactivity.  
Press HOME MENU and select ‘Initial Setup’.  
In the table below, the default option is marked with a •.  
Setting  
Options  
Explanation  
Basic  
Clock Setting  
Auto  
Set the channel that broadcasts a clock signal and  
the clock will be set automatically.  
Manual •  
If there is no channel that broadcasts a clock signal  
in your area, you can set the time and date manually.  
• If any digital TV channels are set then the clock will automatically be set.  
• The clock must be set in order to use timer recording.  
Input Line System  
525 System  
Use for NTSC or PAL-60 recording from an external  
input.  
625 System •  
Use for standard PAL or SECAM recording.  
• This setting is applicable only when recording from an external input.  
• See also About the input line system on page 141 for more information on this setting.  
Power Save  
Mode 1  
Only signals arriving at the antenna input are passed  
through to the antenna output when the recorder is  
in standby.  
Mode 2  
Off •  
No input signals are passed through to the outputs  
when the recorder is in standby.  
When the recorder is in standby, all signals arriving  
at the SCART and antenna inputs are passed along  
to the outputs.  
HELP Setting  
On •  
Off  
Switches on the automatic Help screens for GUI  
displays.  
Switches off the automatic Help screens for GUI  
displays. (Press HELP on the remote to manually  
display the Help screen.)  
127  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Initial Setup menu  
16  
Setting  
Options  
Explanation  
EPG Type Select  
GUIDE Plus+  
Digital EPG  
Use the Gemstar GUIDE Plus+ EPG.  
Use the EPG based on information provided by D.TV  
broadcasts.  
Setup Navigator  
Start  
Select to start the Setup Navigator. See also  
Switching on and setting up on page 30.  
Digital Tuner  
Replace Channels  
Next Screen  
Scans for digital channels and replaces all the  
channel presets with the results. Before the scan  
starts you will need to select your country.  
After the scan is complete the recorder tells you  
whether any new channels were found, and if so,  
how many.  
(You can cancel the scan before it has finished by  
pressing HOME MENU or RETURN/EXIT. In this  
case, no channels are set.)  
If you execute a Replace Channels command, any timer recordings set for D.TV channels will be erased.  
Add New Channels Next Screen  
Automatically scans for new digital channels.  
After the scan is complete the recorder tells you  
whether any new channels were found, and if so,  
how many.  
(You can cancel the scan before it has finished by  
pressing HOME MENU or RETURN/EXIT. In this  
case, no new channels are set.)  
Channel Sort  
Next Screen  
Use this screen to sort channel presets into your  
prefered order. Use the ꢁ/ꢂ/ꢃ/ꢀ buttons to  
highlight the channel you want to move, press  
ENTER. Use the cursor buttons again to highlight the  
position you want to move the channel preset to,  
then press ENTER again.  
(If there are more channel presets than will fit on one  
screen, you can select the next/previous page by  
highlighting the small triangular marks and pressing  
ENTER.)  
128  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Initial Setup menu  
16  
Setting  
Options  
Explanation  
Channel Options  
Next Screen  
From this screen you can skip or lock channels.  
Locked channels will require the correct password to  
be entered before the channel can be watched. Use  
the ꢁ/ꢂ/ꢃ/ꢀ buttons to highlight a preference box  
and press ENTER to toggle the preference.  
To enter this screen, input the parental lock password  
when prompted (if one has not yet been set then the  
password you enter becomes the parental lock  
password).  
Auto Skip  
Off •  
No channels are automatically skipped.  
Radio  
Radio channels are skipped when selecting  
channels.  
Data  
Data channels are skipped when selecting channels.  
Radio & Data  
Radio and data channels are skipped when selecting  
channels.  
Signal Check  
Aerial Power  
Next Screen  
Use this screen to check the signal level and quality  
of digital channels. Use the ꢃ/ꢀ buttons to change  
the RF channel; select Add New Channels then  
press ENTER to scan for new channels; press HOME  
MENU to exit.  
On  
Power is supplied to the connected aerial (antenna)  
when this recorder is on or in standby.  
Auto  
Off •  
Power is supplied to the connected aerial (antenna)  
only when this recorder is on.  
This recorder does not supply power to the  
connected aerial (antenna).  
• If the setting keeps reverting to Off when you try to set to On or Auto, the aerial may not be connected properly,  
or it may be shorted. In either case, check the connection and try making the setting again.  
D.TV Language  
Next Screen  
From this screen you can set your Primary and  
Secondary Audio preference for multilingual digital  
broadcasts, your Primary and Secondary Subtitle  
preference for programmes that are broadcast with  
subtitles, and your Teletext language preference. Use  
the ꢁ/ꢂ buttons to highlight a field then use the ꢃ/  
buttons to change it.  
129  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Initial Setup menu  
16  
Setting  
Options  
Explanation  
Analog Tuner  
Auto Channel  
Setting  
Auto Scan  
Select your country and then wait for the recorder to  
auto tune into channels in your area. After auto scan  
has finished, the channel mapping screen appears  
showing which channels have been assigned to  
which programme numbers. You can skip unwanted  
channels using the Manual CH Setting option below.  
Press HOME MENU to exit the channel mapping  
screen.  
Download from  
TV  
If your TV supports this feature you can download all  
the channels that your TV is tuned to via the SCART  
input. Select your country and then wait for the  
download to complete. After the download is  
complete, the channel mapping screen appears, as  
above.  
See also the operating instructions that came with  
your TV for more information.  
Manual CH Setting Next Screen  
Proceed to the next screen if you need to adjust any  
of the settings made by auto tuning. Select your  
country, then proceed to the manual channel setting  
screen:  
• Change channel presets using the Smart Jog.  
To skip the displayed channel (because there is no  
station assigned to that channel), change the Skip  
setting to On.  
• Set the CH SYSTEM setting to match the channel  
system of your country or region.  
• Set the CHANNEL setting to the channel you want  
to assign to the current channel preset.  
To manually fine tune the channel, change the AFT  
setting to Off then adjust the Level setting.  
• Set the Sound System setting to match the sound  
system of your region.  
• The Name field allows you to input a name of up to  
five characters for the current channel preset.  
• If the currently selected channel is scrambled  
requiring a decoder connected to the AV2 (INPUT 1/  
DECODER), set the Decoder setting to On.  
Channel Swapping Next Screen  
Proceed to the next screen to swap channel  
assignments of different presets so that you can  
group together presets that naturally go together.  
Select two presets to swap then press ENTER.  
130  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Initial Setup menu  
16  
Setting  
Options  
Explanation  
Video In/Out  
Input Colour  
System  
Next Screen  
Proceed to the next screen to set the input colour  
system for the external input and the built-in TV  
tuner. Use the Smart Jog or INPUT SELECT buttons  
to change the preset or external input. On the default  
Auto setting the recorder can generally correctly  
detect whether the input signal is PAL, SECAM, 3.58  
NTSC or PAL-60, but in some cases you may have to  
set it manually if the picture is displayed incorrectly.  
• Input Colour System cannot be set when the recorder is in D.TV mode.  
• See also About the input colour system on page 141 for more information on this setting.  
Component Video Interlace •  
Out  
Select if your monitor/TV is not compatible with  
progressive-scan video.  
Progressive  
Select if your monitor/TV is progressive-scan  
compatible. Check the operating instructions that  
came with your monitor/TV if you’re not sure.  
For Component Video Out to be effective, the AV1 Out setting (see below) must be set to something other than  
RGB.  
If your TV is incompatible with progressive scan video and you select Progressive, you will not be able to see any  
picture at all. In this case, press OPEN/CLOSE while holding down the (Stop) button on the front panel to  
switch to Interlace (this also switches Screen Resolution on page 138 to the default setting).  
When the HDMI signal is output, no video is output from the COMPONENT VIDEO OUT.  
AV1 Out  
Video •  
S-Video  
RGB  
Sets the AV1 (RGB)-TV SCART output to standard  
composite video (compatible with all TVs).  
Sets the AV1 (RGB)-TV SCART output to S-video.  
Recommended if you are using a long SCART cable.  
Sets the AV1 (RGB)-TV SCART output to RGB. Good  
quality but check your TV for compatibility. Note that  
on this setting signals from the built-in tuner and  
from external inputs is not output when the recorder  
is in TV mode.  
If you choose a setting that is incompatible with your TV you may not be able to see any picture at all. In this case  
either switch off and reconnect using the supplied video cable, or reset the recorder (see Resetting the recorder on  
page 157).  
The Component Video Out setting (see above) has no effect when AV1 Out is set to RGB.  
When the HDMI signal is output, the AV1 Out outputs the composite video signal even when it is set to RGB.  
131  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Initial Setup menu  
16  
Setting  
Options  
Video •  
Explanation  
AV2/L1 In  
Sets the AV2 (INPUT 1/DECODER) SCART input to  
standard composite video.  
S-Video  
RGB  
Sets the AV2 (INPUT 1/DECODER) SCART input to  
S-video.  
Sets the AV2 (INPUT 1/DECODER) SCART input to  
RGB.  
Decoder  
Use this setting if you connected a decoder to the  
AV2 (INPUT 1/DECODER) SCART connector. For  
scrambled channels, make sure that the channel  
Decoder setting is set to On. (See Manual CH Setting  
on page 130.)  
NTSC on PAL TV  
On •  
Off  
NTSC discs will play correctly on PAL-only TVs.  
Use if your TV is already NTSC-compatible.  
Many recent PAL TVs are compatible with NTSC input and so this setting can be switched off. Check the operating  
instructions that came with your TV. See also About NTSC on PAL TV on page 141 for related information.  
Audio In  
NICAM Select  
NICAM •  
Record the NICAM audio in a NICAM broadcast.  
Regular Audio  
Record the non-NICAM audio in a NICAM broadcast.  
(You can still switch the audio to record using the  
AUDIO button before recording.)  
Analog Tuner Level Normal •  
Compression  
Standard setting.  
Use if the audio level from the built-in tuner is  
excessive, causing distortion.  
External Audio  
Stereo •  
Bilingual  
Select if the audio from the currently selected  
external input is standard stereo.  
Select if each channel carries a separate soundtrack.  
When the external audio is from the DV input, an audio subcode channel within the DV audio tells the recorder  
whether the audio is stereo or bilingual. This has priority over the setting you make here.  
Bilingual Recording A/L •  
Record the left (A) channel of a bilingual source  
when recording to HDD with HDD Recording Format  
set to Video Mode On, to DVD-R/-RW (Video mode) or  
DVD+R/+RW or in LPCM mode, from an external  
source.  
B/R  
As above, but for right (B) channel recording.  
When recording bilingual audio to DVD in VR mode (except in LPCM mode), or to HDD with HDD Recording Format  
set to Video Mode Off (except in LPCM mode), both audio channels are recorded and you can switch to the one you  
want on playback.  
132  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Initial Setup menu  
16  
Setting  
Options  
Explanation  
DV Input  
Stereo 1 •  
Select to use the ‘live’ audio track (recorded during  
the video shoot) from a camcorder that supports two  
stereo audio tracks.  
Stereo 2  
Mix  
Select to use the overdubbed audio track from a  
camcorder that supports two stereo audio tracks.  
Select one of the three settings to use a mix of the  
two stereo audio tracks.  
Audio Out  
Dolby Digital Out  
Dolby Digital •  
Output a Dolby Digital signal when a Dolby Digital  
source is being played.  
Dolby Digital Convert Dolby Digital sources to Linear PCM output.  
PCM  
On •  
Off  
Use if your connected equipment doesn’t have a  
Dolby Digital decoder.  
DTS Out  
Output a DTS signal when a DTS source is being  
played.  
Switch off the digital output when a DTS source is  
being played. Use when your connected equipment  
doesn’t have a DTS decoder. In this case, use the  
analog audio outputs.  
96 kHz PCM Out  
MPEG Out  
96 kHz 48 kHz • Convert 96 kHz digital audio sources to 48 kHz  
output. Use if your connected equipment doesn’t  
support 96 kHz sampling rate.  
96 kHz  
Output 96 kHz digital audio when a 96 kHz source is  
being played.  
MPEG  
Output an MPEG audio signal when a source using  
MPEG audio is being played.  
MPEG PCM •  
Convert sources with MPEG audio to Linear PCM  
output. Use if your connected equipment doesn’t  
have an MPEG audio decoder.  
Audio DRC  
On  
Switches on Audio DRC (Dynamic Range Control).  
Use when listening to Dolby Digital material at low  
volume.  
Off •  
Switches off Audio DRC.  
Audio DRC is not effective when listening via the digital output when the Dolby Digital Out setting is set to Dolby  
Digital.  
133  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Initial Setup menu  
16  
Setting  
Options  
Explanation  
Language  
OSD Language  
English •  
Sets the language of the on-screen displays to  
English.  
available languages Choose from the languages displayed for the on-  
screen displays.  
On Screen Display and D.TV Language will both reflect this setting.  
Audio Language  
English •  
Sets the default audio language for DVD-Video  
playback to English.  
available languages Choose from the languages displayed to set the  
default audio language for DVD-Video playback.  
Other  
Select to set the default audio language to  
something other than the ones listed. See Selecting  
other languages for language options on page 142.  
Discs do not necessarily have audio in your selected language. Also, some discs override the Audio Language  
preference.  
Subtitle Language English •  
Sets the default subtitle language for DVD-Video  
playback to English.  
available languages Choose from the languages displayed to set the  
default subtitle language for DVD-Video playback.  
Other  
Select to set the default subtitle language to  
something other than the ones listed. See Selecting  
other languages for language options on page 142.  
Discs do not necessarily have subtitles in your selected menu language. Also, some discs override the Subtitle  
Language preference.  
Auto Language  
On •  
On this setting:  
• DVD-Video discs whose main audio track is in your  
default language will play using that language,  
without subtitles.  
• Discs whose main audio track is not in your default  
language but that have a subtitle track in your default  
language will play the original audio track with  
subtitles.  
Off  
Select to play DVD-Video discs according to your  
audio and subtitle language preferences.  
For Auto Language to be effective, the Audio Language and Subtitle Language options must be set to the same  
language.  
134  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Initial Setup menu  
16  
Setting  
Options  
Explanation  
DVD Menu  
Language  
w/Subtitle  
Language •  
Sets the language of DVD-Video menus to the same  
as that set for the subtitle language.  
English  
Sets the language of DVD-Video menus to English.  
available languages Choose from the displayed languages to set the  
default language for DVD-Video menus.  
Other  
Select to set the DVD menu language to something  
other than the ones listed. See Selecting other  
languages for language options on page 142.  
Discs do not necessarily have menus in your selected menu language.  
Subtitle Display  
On •  
Select to have discs display subtitles according to  
your Subtitle Language and Auto Language  
preferences.  
Off  
Select to switch off subtitle display.  
Assist Subtitle  
Select to display special additional assistive  
subtitles, where available.  
Some discs may override these settings.  
Recording  
Manual Recording On (go to setup) All the standard recording modes, plus MN1 to  
MN32, LPCM and XP+ modes can be set.  
Off •  
Justthestandardrecordingmodes(XP,SP,LP, EP,SLP  
and SEP) can be set.  
See also Manual recording modes on page 145 for detailed information on manual recording levels.  
Optimized Rec  
On  
The recording quality of timer recordings is  
automatically adjusted to fit on to the selected media  
if it will not fit at the selected quality setting. If the  
recording will not fit even at MN1(MN4 for DVD+R/  
+RW), then the recording will be made to the HDD  
in the original quality selected.  
Off •  
When a timer recording is set that won’t fit on to the  
selected media, the recording starts but is cut off  
when no more recording is possible.  
Optimized Rec will only compensate for the next scheduled timer recording if more than one is set. It cannot be  
used together with VPS/PDC.  
Subtitle Recording On  
The selected subtitle language is recorded with the  
D.TV timer recording.  
Off •  
No subtitles are recorded with D.TV timer recordings.  
135  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Initial Setup menu  
16  
Setting  
Options  
Explanation  
Set Thumbnail  
0 seconds •  
Sets the default thumbnail picture in the Disc  
Navigator to the first frame of the title.  
30 seconds  
3 minutes  
On •  
Sets the default thumbnail picture to 30 seconds into  
the title.  
Sets the default thumbnail picture to three minutes  
into the title.  
Auto Chapter  
(HDD/VR)  
When recording to the HDD or in VR mode to a DVD,  
chapter marks are added at the black screen  
between commercials and main programming.  
When recording in DV, chapter marks can be  
changed by date/time.  
Off  
Automatic chapter marking is switched off.  
Automatic chapter marking is switched off.  
Auto Chapter  
(Video)  
No Separation  
10 minutes •  
When recording in Video mode, chapter markers are  
inserted every 10 minutes.  
15 minutes  
Chapter markers are inserted every 15 minutes.  
This settings applies to recording or real-time copying to Video mode DVD-R/-RW discs.  
Auto Chapter  
(DVD+R/+RW)  
No Separation  
10 minutes •  
Automatic chapter marking is switched off.  
When recording in DVD+R/+RW or in real-time  
copying, chapter markers are inserted every 10 minutes.  
15 minutes  
Chapter markers are inserted every 15 minutes.  
HDD Recording  
Format  
Video Mode Off Recordings made to the HDD are made in VR mode.  
Use this setting if you don’t need to transfer the  
recording later to a DVD-R/-RW (Video mode) or  
DVD+R/+RW.  
Video Mode On • Recordings made to the HDD are compatible with  
Video mode recordings. This setting is convenient if  
you want to transfer the recording to a DVD-R/-RW  
(Video mode) or DVD+R/+RW as high-speed copy  
can be used.  
When Video Mode On is used, you must select the audio channel you want to record when recording a bilingual  
broadcast. On the Video Mode Off setting, both channels will be recorded and you can switch between them on  
playback. See also Bilingual Recording on page 132.  
When the recording mode is set to XP+, you cannot change HDD Recording Format.  
136  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Initial Setup menu  
16  
Setting  
Options  
Explanation  
Playback  
TV Screen Size  
4:3 (Letter Box)  
Select if you have a standard 4:3 TV and prefer the  
letter box format presentation for widescreen  
material.  
4:3 (Pan & Scan) Select if you have a standard 4:3 TV and prefer the  
pan and scan presentation for widescreen material.  
16:9 •  
Select if you have a widescreen 16:9 TV. Your TV  
settings determine how 4:3 material will look.  
Selecting 4:3 (Letter Box) or 4:3 (Pan & Scan) does not guarantee that all video material will be presented in that  
format as some discs override this setting.  
Still Picture  
Field  
Produces a stable, generally shake-free image.  
Produces sharp image, but may be prone to shake.  
Frame  
Auto •  
Generates a generally less sharp but more stable still  
image.  
Seamless Playback On  
Off •  
Playback is smooth, but with a trade-off against the  
accuracy of the edit points.  
You may notice momentary interruption at edited  
points during playback of a VR mode Play List.  
This setting applies to HDD, DVD-R/-RW (VR) and DVD-RAM playback.  
Angle Indicator  
On •  
A camera icon appears on-screen during multi-angle  
scenes on a DVD-Video disc.  
Off  
Nothing is indicated on-screen when a multi-angle  
scene is showing.  
Parental Lock  
Set Password /  
Change Password  
Next Screen  
If no password has yet been set, enter a four digit  
number to become your password. If you want to  
change the password, first enter your old password,  
then enter a new one.  
DVD Playback  
D.TV Age Limit  
Next Screen  
Next Screen  
From this screen, first enter your password and then  
set a parental lock level for playback of DVDs with  
parental level coding.  
Use this screen to enter an age limit for D.TV  
programmes. Programmes that are broadcast with  
age suitability guidelines that fall above the age set  
here will require the correct password to be entered  
before the channel can be viewed.  
You must also enter your password in order to  
change the age limit setting.  
This setting is only applicable when the country is set to France, Denmark, Finland or Sweden.  
137  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Initial Setup menu  
16  
Setting  
Options  
Explanation  
HDMI Output (only available when an HDMI device is connected)  
Screen Resolution  
1920 x 1080p  
1920 x 1080i  
1280 x 720p  
Constant 1920 x 1080p output.  
Constant 1920 x 1080i output.  
Constant 1280 x 720p output.  
720 x 576p  
(720 x 480p)  
Constant 720 x 576p output (when setting the Input  
Line System to 525 System, video is output in 720 x  
480p).  
720 x 576i  
(720 x 480i)  
Constant 720 x 576i output (when setting the Input  
Line System to 525 System, video is output in 720 x  
480i).  
• If you choose a setting that is incompatible with your TV you may not be able to see any picture at all. In this  
case, press OPEN/CLOSE while holding down the (Stop) button on the front panel to switch the setting (this  
also switches Component Video Out on page 131 to the default setting).  
• If you have the Colour set to YCbCr 4:2:2, you cannot select 720 x 576i (720 x 480i).  
4:3 Video Output  
Full  
Select if your HDMI TV allows you to change the  
aspect ratio.  
Normal  
Select if your HDMI TV does not allow you to change  
the aspect ratio. 4:3 video will be shown with bars on  
each side.  
Colour  
RGB (0–255)  
RGB (16–235)  
YCbCr 4:2:2  
Use if colours are weak and black appears to ‘float’  
on the RGB (16–235) setting.  
Use this setting if colours appear overly rich and the  
black too deep on the RGB (0–255) setting.  
The video signal is output as a 10-bit YCbCr 4:2:2  
component signal. This is the standard setting for  
HDMI-compatible devices.  
YCbCr 4:4:4  
The video signal is output as a 8-bit YCbCr 4:4:4  
component signal.  
• Depending on the connected device some settings may not be available.  
• When a DVI device is connected, the YCbCr 4:2:2 and YCbCr 4:4:4 options are not available.  
• You cannot choose YCbCr 4:2:2 when the Screen Resolution is set to 720 x 576i (720 x 480i).  
Audio Output  
Auto •  
Dolby Digital, MPEG and DTS sources are output as  
a bitstream signal. However, depending on the  
Audio Out setting, number of audio channels, and  
the HDMI-connected device, Linear PCM audio may  
be output.  
PCM  
All audio signals are converted to Linear PCM  
(except DTS).  
Bitstream Priority Select if the connected device is compatible with  
bitstream audio.  
This setting is not available when a DVI device is connected.  
138  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Initial Setup menu  
16  
Setting  
Options  
Options  
Explanation  
On Screen Display On •  
The recorder displays operation displays (Stop, Play,  
etc.) on-screen.  
Off  
Switches off the on-screen operation displays.  
Front Panel Display On •  
The time is shown in the front panel display when the  
recorder is in standby.  
Off  
The front panel display is switched off in standby.  
Remote Control  
Mode  
Recorder 1–3  
If you are using more than one recorder in the same  
(default: Recorder 1) room, set them to different IDs. This setting sets the  
recorder ID; to change the remote controller ID,  
press and hold RETURN/EXIT then press 1, 2 or 3 to  
set. The remote will only control a recorder with the  
same ID.  
AV. Link  
This Recorder  
Only •  
Signals received through the AV input when the  
recorder is in standby are not passed through to the  
AV output.  
Pass Through  
Signals received when in standby are passed though  
to the output for connected devices. (Note that  
during EPG data download, the EPG data is not  
passed through.)  
When set to Pass Through, make sure to set Power Save (page 127) to Off.  
DivX VOD  
Registration Code Use to display the recorder’s DivX registration code.  
See DivX video compatibility on page 10 and DivX®  
VOD content on page 11.  
Set Preview  
(HDD only)  
Quick Preview • When in the Disc Navigator, the thumbnail video  
plays short excerpts from throughout the selected  
title. (Note that edited titles that will play normally  
from the beginning.)  
Normal  
The thumbnail video plays from the beginning of the  
title.  
CI Information  
Next Screen  
This option displays a menu of CI card functions.  
Consult your service provider for more information  
on the functions available.  
Software Update  
Next Screen  
The Software Update function can check for and  
download updated system software for the digital  
tuner. See Using Software Update (Digital tuner) on  
page 142.  
139  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Initial Setup menu  
16  
Setting  
Options 2  
USB  
Options  
Explanation  
Restart USB  
Device  
If the connected USB device does not respond to the  
recorder, try using this option to restart it. If the  
device still does not work properly try switching it off  
then back on, and/or disconnecting then  
reconnecting the USB cable.  
Confirm Printer  
TV’s Tuner  
Use this option to confirm the make and model of the  
printer connected to the recorder (does not work with  
all printers).  
Pause Live TV  
Allows you to use the Pause Live TV feature with an  
AV Link-compatible TV connected by SCART cable.  
Recorder’s  
Tuner •  
Allows you to use Pause Live TV with this recorder’s  
internal TV tuner.  
See also Pause Live TV on page 66 for more information on this setting.  
HDD Sleep Mode  
Proceed  
Puts the HDD to sleep. Using this feature when  
playing DVDs or CDs allows you to reduce noise  
produced by the unit, resulting in improved sound  
quality. When you wake the HDD back up it will take  
a few seconds to load.  
The HDD can be taken out of Sleep Mode by any  
number of actions, including:  
Turning the power off and on again.  
Pressing the HDD/DVD button and choosing the  
HDD.  
When a timer recording begins.  
When you try and make any changes to system  
settings.  
140  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Initial Setup menu  
16  
About NTSC on PAL TV  
Additional information about the  
TV system settings  
Depending on the Input Line System setting  
and the NTSC on PAL TV setting, the signal  
format output when the recorder is stopped  
varies as shown in the table below.  
About the input line system  
This recorder is compatible with PAL,  
SECAM, 3.58 NTSC and PAL-60 TV systems.  
The Input Line System and Input Colour  
System settings determine how the recorder  
treats incoming video signals from an  
external input.  
Output  
when  
stopped  
Input Line  
System  
NTSC on PAL  
TV  
625 System  
Off  
On  
Off  
On  
PAL  
Please note the following points when  
changing the input line system:  
PAL  
• When the current input is a built-in tuner  
channel preset, changing the input line  
system will usually also affect the input  
line system of the AV2 (INPUT 1/  
525 System  
NTSC  
PAL–60  
About the input colour system  
The available options of the Input Colour  
System setting depend on the Input Line  
System setting. The table below shows the  
different options available.  
DECODER) input. However if the AV2/L1  
In setting is set to Decoder, then the L2  
input is affected instead.  
• If, when the Input Line System setting is  
changed, the screen goes blank (due to  
incompatibility with your TV), you can  
switch back by pressing and holding the  
front panel (Stop) button then  
pressing INPUT SELECT (also front  
panel) while the recorder is stopped.  
Input Line  
System  
Built-in  
analog tuner input  
External  
625 System  
Auto  
PAL  
Auto  
PAL  
• When you switch the Input Line System  
setting the Copy List is erased. If you  
switch the setting using the (Stop)  
button and INPUT SELECT buttons as  
described above, there is no  
SECAM  
n/a  
SECAM  
Auto  
525 System  
3.58 NTSC  
PAL–60  
confirmation, so please use with care.  
• You can’t mix recordings of different TV  
line systems on the same disc.  
Additional information about  
component video output  
• When you change this setting, the Input  
Colour System setting also changes  
(see below).  
If you switch the Component Video Out  
setting to Progressive when using a TV that  
is not compatible with progressive-scan  
video, you will not be able to see anything  
displayed on your TV. If this happens, press  
and hold the (Stop) button on the front  
panel, then press OPEN/CLOSE. This will  
set the recorder’s video output back to  
Interlace.  
141  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Initial Setup menu  
16  
Manual Update  
Selecting other languages  
for language options  
Select Manual Update to check for updated  
software immediately. If new software is  
found then it is automatically downloaded  
and installed. The new software will take  
effect the next time the recorder is powered  
on.  
ENTER  
1
Select ‘Other’ from the  
language list.  
If for some reason the new software could  
not be downloaded successfully, a dialog  
box informs you of the error. Press HOME  
MENU to exit or RETURN/EXIT to return to  
the previous screen.  
This option appears in the settings for DVD  
Menu Language, Audio Language, and  
Subtitle Language.  
ENTER  
Note that channel information may be  
erased when software update is used, and  
that timer recording will not work during the  
update.  
2
Select the language you  
want.  
Initial Setup  
Basic  
OSD DVD Menu Language  
To cancel manual update before it has  
completed, press HOME MENU.  
Digital Tuner  
Analogue Tuner  
Video In/Out  
Audio In  
Audi
Language  
English  
Subt
0
1
4
Number  
Auto
5
DVD
Subt
Language
Auto Update  
Language  
Recording  
By default, the Auto Update option is On,  
which means that periodically the recorder  
will check for and update the digital tuner  
software if it’s available. We recommend  
that you leave this option On.  
• Select by language name: Use the ꢃ/ꢀ  
buttons to change the language.  
• Select by code number: Press then  
use the number buttons to enter the  
four-digit language code.  
If new software is found and successfully  
downloaded, the recorder automatically  
scans for new digital channels, informing  
you if any are found (this is the equivalent of  
using the Add New Channel option, found in  
the Digital Tuner section of the Initial Setup  
menu).  
See Language code list on page 154 for a list  
of available languages and corresponding  
codes.  
Using Software Update  
(Digital tuner)  
Technical Information  
This displays the current hardware and  
software version numbers of the digital  
tuner.  
The Software Update function can keep the  
built-in digital tuner up to date with the latest  
system software. You can either check for  
updates manually, or have the recorder do it  
automatically at regular intervals.  
Access the Software Update screen from the  
Options menu.  
There are three options available: Manual  
Update, Auto Update and Technical  
Information.  
142  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional information  
17  
Chapter 17  
Additional information  
Maker  
Code  
Setting up the remote to  
control your TV  
Alba  
66  
Bush  
76  
You can use the supplied remote to control  
your TV. To be able to use this feature you  
first have to program the remote with a  
maker code from the table below.  
Fisher  
61, 65  
77  
Fujitsu  
Funai  
67  
Goldstar  
Grandiente  
Grundig  
Hitachi  
ITT  
79  
1
Press and hold down the CLEAR  
87  
button, then enter the maker code for  
your TV.  
51, 82  
56, 60, 83, 86  
70  
See the table on the following page for the  
list of maker codes. If there is more than one  
code given for your make, input the first one  
in the list.  
• If the maker’s name of your TV doesn’t  
appear in the table below, you will not be  
able to use this remote to control your  
TV.  
Mitsubishi  
Nokia  
59  
53, 81  
58, 72  
57, 85, 89  
50, 80  
68  
Panasonic  
Philips  
Pioneer  
RCA  
Salora  
Samsung  
Sanyo  
71  
2
Press to check that the remote  
73, 75  
74  
works with your TV.  
If the remote is set up correctly, the TV  
should switch on/off. If it doesn’t and there is  
another code given for your maker, repeat  
step 1 with a new code.  
Sei  
78  
Sharp  
52  
Sony  
54  
Tandy  
69  
Telefunken  
Thomson  
Toshiba  
JVC  
64  
Using the TV remote control  
buttons  
The table below shows how to use this  
remote control with your TV.  
62, 89  
55  
63  
Button  
What it does  
Press to switch the TV on/off  
(standby)  
INPUT SELECT Press to change the TV’s video  
input  
VOLUME +/– Use to adjust the TV volume  
CHANNEL +/– Use to change TV channels  
143  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional information  
17  
Minimum copying times  
The table below shows the minimum HDD to DVD copying time for one hour of video.  
1
Please note that not all discs are compatible with high-speed copying. Check with the disc  
manufacturer for compatibility.  
Rec mode  
SEP  
SLP  
EP  
LP  
SP  
XP  
10 h  
8 h  
6 h  
4 h  
2 h  
1 h  
DVD disc type  
DVD-R / 1x  
DVD-RW / 1x  
1x  
2x  
6 mins.  
3 mins.  
7.5 mins.  
4 mins.  
10 mins.  
5 mins.  
15 mins.  
7.5 mins.  
30 mins.  
15 mins.  
60 mins.  
30 mins.  
DVD-RW / 2x  
DVD-R DL  
DVD-RAM / 2x  
DVD+R / 2.4x  
DVD+RW / 2.4x  
DVD+R DL  
2.4x  
3x  
*1  
*1  
*1  
6.3 mins.  
5 mins.  
12.5 mins.  
10 mins.  
25 mins.  
20 mins.  
DVD-RAM / 3x  
DVD-RAM / 5x  
2 mins.  
2.5 mins.  
3.5 mins.  
DVD-R / 4x  
DVD-RW / 4x  
DVD+R / 4x  
DVD+RW / 4x  
4x  
1.5 mins.*1  
2 mins.*1  
2.5 mins.*1  
4 mins.  
3 mins.  
7.5 mins.  
5.5 mins.  
15 mins.  
11 mins.  
DVD-R / 8x / 16x  
DVD+R / 8x / 16x  
DVD-RW / 6x  
6x 1.25 mins.*1 1.6 mins.*1  
2.2 mins.*1  
DVD+RW / 8x  
Note that all times in the above table are approximate. Also that actual copy speed varies with the part of the disc  
being recorded.  
*1 Titles recorded on DVD+R/+RW in SEP, SLP or EP modes cannot be high-speed copied.  
Note  
1 Depending on the disc, the copy speed may be reduced (for example, although a 6x disc is used, the copy may  
be made at 2x speed).  
144  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional information  
Manual recording modes  
17  
The table below shows the approximate recording times for different DVD types in each  
manual recording mode, as well as the standard recording mode equivalents. For recording  
time on the HDD, see Specifications on page 158.  
Rec. time*1  
Resolution*2  
Single-Layer  
DVD:  
DVD-R/-RW  
DVD+R/+RW  
DVD-RAM  
Video mode On (HDD)  
Video mode (DVD-R/-RW)  
DVD+R/+RW  
Video mode (DVD-R DL)  
DVD+R DL  
Dual-Layer  
DVD:  
DVD-R DL  
DVD+R DL  
Video mode Off (HDD)  
VR mode (DVD-R/-RW)  
DVD-RAM  
VR mode (DVD-R DL)  
Level  
MN 1 *3,4  
MN 2 *3,4  
MN 3 *3,4  
MN 4 *4  
MN 5 *4  
MN 6 *4  
MN 7  
802 mins. 1440 mins.  
720 mins. 1292 mins.  
600 mins. 1077 mins.  
480 mins. 861 mins.  
420 mins. 754 mins.  
360 mins. 646 mins.  
SEP  
SLP  
352 x 240 /  
352 x 288  
352 x 240 /  
352 x 288  
EP  
LP  
300 mins. 538 mins.  
270 mins. 484 mins.  
240 mins. 431 mins.  
230 mins. 413 mins.  
220 mins. 395 mins.  
210 mins. 377 mins.  
200 mins. 359 mins.  
190 mins. 341 mins.  
180 mins. 323 mins.  
170 mins. 305 mins.  
160 mins. 287 mins.  
150 mins. 269 mins.  
140 mins. 251 mins.  
130 mins. 233 mins.  
120 mins. 215 mins.  
110 mins. 197 mins.  
105 mins. 188 mins.  
100 mins. 179 mins.  
95 mins. 170 mins.  
90 mins. 161 mins.  
85 mins. 153 mins.  
80 mins. 144 mins.  
75 mins. 135 mins.  
70 mins. 126 mins.  
65 mins. 117 mins.  
61 mins. 111 mins.  
61 mins. 111 mins.  
352 x 480 /  
352 x 576  
352 x 480 /  
352 x 576  
MN 8  
MN 9  
480 x 480 /  
480 x 576  
MN 10  
MN 11  
MN 12  
MN 13  
MN 14  
MN 15  
MN 16  
MN 17  
MN 18  
MN 19  
MN 20  
MN 21  
MN 22  
MN 23  
MN 24  
MN 25  
MN 26  
MN 27  
MN 28  
MN 29  
MN 30  
MN 31  
MN 32  
LPCM  
544 x 480 /  
544 x 576  
720 x 480 /  
720 x 576  
SP  
720 x 480 /  
720 x 576  
XP  
XP+*5  
--- mins.  
--- mins.  
*1 Recording time may be slightly shorter for certain disc types or recording modes.  
*2 The first figure refers to when the Input Line System is set to 525 System; the second when set to 625 System.  
*3 Modes MN1 to MN3 not available when using DVD+R/+RW.  
*4 Titles recorded at MN6 or lower cannot be high-speed copied to DVD+R/+RW.  
*5 XP+ mode is available for HDD recordings only. If set for a DVD recording, the DVD will be automatically recorded  
in MN32 mode.  
145  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional information  
17  
Levels separated by a bold line show where there is a noticeable change in picture quality.  
Audio recording in all manual recording modes is in Dolby Digital 2 ch format, except for LPCM mode, which is  
in Linear PCM format.  
• See also Recording on page 59.  
Troubleshooting  
Incorrect operation is often mistaken for trouble and malfunction. If you think there is  
something wrong with this component, please check the points below. Sometimes the  
trouble may lie in another component. Investigate the other components and electrical  
appliances being used. If the trouble cannot be rectified even after checking the points below,  
ask your nearest Pioneer authorized service center or your dealer to carry out repair work.  
General  
Problem  
Remedy  
The disc is  
• Check that the disc is not an incompatible format disc (page 7).  
automatically ejected • Check that the disc is loaded properly (aligned in disc tray and label-  
after closing the disc  
tray  
side up).  
• Take out the disc and clean it (page 156).  
• Check that the disc has a region code compatible with the recorder.  
Can’t eject a disc  
Can’t play a disc  
Turn off the power to this device and press and hold OPEN/CLOSE  
on the front of the unit for more than three seconds.  
• Check that the disc is a compatible format disc (page 7).  
• Take out the disc and clean it (page 156).  
• Check that the disc is loaded properly (aligned in disc tray and label-  
side up).  
• Press HDD/DVD to select the DVD.  
• There may be condensation in the recorder. Leave the recorder for  
an hour or so for the condensation to evaporate.  
• During HDD recording, you can’t play discs that are recorded with a  
Line System different to the current recorder setting.  
• DVD+R/+RW discs recorded using another recorder with copy-  
once protected recordings will not play in this recorder.  
Can’t record a disc  
• Check that the disc is not an incompatible format disc (page 7).  
• Some DVD-RAM discs are not recordable until they have been  
initialized (page 72). This can take up to an hour.  
Remote control does  
not work  
• If you connected this recorder to another Pioneer product using the  
CONTROL IN jack, point the remote control at the other component to  
use (page 14).  
• Set the remote control to the same ID number as the recorder  
(page 139). (When the batteries run down, the remote mode is  
automatically reset to Recorder1.)  
• Use the remote within its operating range (page 6).  
• Replace the batteries (page 6).  
All settings are reset  
• If the recorder is unplugged (or there is a power failure) while the  
recorder is on, all the settings will be lost.  
• Make sure that you switch the recorder into standby before  
unplugging the power cord.  
146  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional information  
17  
Problem  
Remedy  
No picture  
• Check that everything is connected properly (page 14).  
• Check that the connected TV and/or the AV amp/receiver is set to  
the correct input.  
• The recorder may be set to progressive scan with an incompatible  
TV. Reset to interlace by pressing and holding the front panel (Stop)  
button then pressing OPEN/CLOSE.  
If you are using an indoor antenna that requires power, make sure that  
Aerial Power in the Initial Setup menu is set to On or Auto (page 129).  
• If the aerial/antenna is not connected properly, or if it is shorted, the  
Aerial Power setting will revert to Off automatically. Check the aerial  
connection and try making the setting again.  
• When the HDMI signal is output, no video is output from the  
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT.  
No sound or sound is  
distorted  
• Make sure that the amp/receiver or TV is set to the correct input and  
the volume turned up.  
• There is no sound when the picture is paused, or during scanning or  
slow motion play. Press PLAY to resume regular playback.  
• DTS discs can only be played if this recorder is connected to a DTS  
decoder or DTS compatible amp/receiver. If you have connected a  
suitable decoder, also make sure that the Initial Setup > Audio Out >  
DTS Out setting is On.  
• Some 96 kHz discs do not output audio through the digital jack. In  
this case, switch the input of your amp/receiver to analog.  
• Check the audio cable connections (page 14).  
• If the sound is distorted, try cleaning the cable plugs.  
Cannot switch a  
bilingual programme  
• During real-time copying it is not possible to switch audio channels.  
The main and sub channels are both output.  
The picture from the  
external input is  
distorted  
• If the video signal from the external component is copy-protected,  
you cannot connect via this recorder. Connect the component directly  
to your TV.  
The picture is distorted • Change the Input Line System setting (page 141). (You can also  
change it by pressing the (Stop) button and INPUT SELECT on the  
front panel simultaneously with the recorder stopped.)  
Screen is stretched  
vertically or  
• Make sure that the TV Screen Size setting (page 137) is correct for  
the kind of TV you have (see also page 155).  
horizontally  
• If you have a widescreen TV, check its aspect ratio settings.  
• This recorder’s input switches into wide mode automatically  
according to the input signal. When the unit connected is not  
compatible with VIDEO ID-1 (widescreen signalling), set the  
connected component to output 4:3 aspect ratio (standard) video.  
Audio/subtitle  
language cannot be  
changed  
Note that audio and subtitle languages cannot be changed  
during the recording of a digital broadcast.  
• You can only use the audio track and subtitles for the language that  
were selected at the time of recording a digital broadcast. The audio  
track and subtitles cannot be changed to other languages.  
147  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional information  
17  
Problem  
Remedy  
Can’t play a disc  
recorded using this  
recorder on another  
player  
• If the disc was recorded in DVD-R/-RW (Video mode) or DVD+R,  
make sure that it’s finalized (page 71).  
• Some players will not play recordable DVD discs, even when  
recorded in DVD-R/-RW (Video mode) or DVD+R and finalized.  
• If the disc was recorded in VR mode, the other player must be  
specifically RW compatible in order to play it (page 7).  
• Discs recorded with copy-once material cannot be played on non-  
CPRM compatible players (page 61).  
• DVD+RW discs containing only a small amount of recorded  
material may not play on other players. Finalize the disc and try again.  
During playback the  
picture is dark or  
distorted  
• When a copy-protected disc is played via a VCR, the picture will not  
display correctly. Connect the recorder directly to your TV.  
Recorded contents are • Change the recording mode to XP/SP.  
not clear or artefacts  
appear in areas of flat  
colour (due to MPEG  
compression; also  
known as block noise)  
Can’t record or does  
• Check that there is some remaining blank space on the DVD/HDD.  
not record successfully • For a DVD-R/-RW (Video mode) or DVD+R, check that the disc isn’t  
already finalized.  
• Check the limits on the number of titles and chapters on a disc:  
– HDD: 999 titles  
– VR mode: 99 titles, 999 chapters per disc  
– Video mode disc: 99 titles per disc, 99 chapters per title  
– DVD+R/+RW: 49 titles per disc, 99 chapters per title (max 254  
chapters per disc)  
• Check that the source you are trying to record is not copy protected.  
• For a VR formatted disc, check that the disc isn’t locked (page 121).  
• Check that you are recording with the same TV system (PAL, NTSC,  
etc.) as the disc has already been recorded in. All recordings on a disc  
must be in the same TV system. When recording to the HDD, it is also  
necessary to set the Input Line System setting to match what you want  
to record (page 141).  
• The power may have failed during recording.  
Timer programme  
doesn’t record  
successfully  
• When setting the recording channel, make sure you set the  
recorder’s built-in TV tuner, not the TV’s built-in tuner.  
• When recording to a DVD-R/-RW (Video mode) or DVD+R/+RW,  
programmes that are copy-once protected cannot be recorded. Use a  
VR mode formatted disc for copy-once material (page 61).  
Two timer programmes may have overlapped, in which case only the  
earlier one will record completely.  
• The power may have failed during recording.  
148  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional information  
17  
Problem  
Remedy  
After briefly  
• A backup battery inside the recorder keeps the clock and other  
unplugging or after a settings from being reset when there is no power to the recorder. After  
power failure the front unplugging or a power failure, the battery keeps all settings for a  
panel display shows  
‘--:--’  
period of several minutes. Reset the clock and other recorder settings  
to use the recorder again.  
Front panel display  
shows ‘LOCKED’ when  
a button is pressed  
• The Child Lock is on; turn off in order to use the recorder (page 69).  
Can’t use One Touch  
Copy (HDD to DVD)  
• Make sure that there is a recordable DVD-R/-RW loaded with some  
free space for recording and fewer than 99 titles already on the disc.  
Also make sure that for a DVD-R/-RW (Video mode) or a DVD+R, the  
disc isn’t finalized.  
• Make sure there is a recordable DVD+R/+RW loaded with some  
free space for recording and fewer than 49 titles already on the disc.  
• If you delete a title from a DVD+R/+RW disc, the number of  
remaining recordable titles may not decrease.  
• Further recording is not possible on a finalized DVD+R. Check that  
there isn’t a disc menu on the disc you’re trying to use.  
• If the title currently playing contains material that is copy-once  
protected, One Touch Copy will not work.  
• If the currently playing HDD content was recorded in XP+ mode, the  
One Touch Copy feature can’t be used.  
• One Touch Copy can’t be used for titles over eight hours long when  
copying to DVD+R/+RW (though you can use a DVD+R DL).  
• One Touch Copy can’t be used for MN1 to MN6, SEP, SLP or EP titles  
when copying to DVD+R/+RW.  
• One Touch Copy doesn’t work if the recorder is already recording to  
DVD.  
Can’t use One Touch  
Copy (DVD to HDD)  
• Make sure that there is space available on the HDD and that there  
are fewer than 999 titles on the HDD.  
• One Touch Copy doesn’t work if the recorder is already recording to  
the HDD.  
The device connected • Check that the device is compatible with this recorder (page 22).  
to the USB port is not • Use a USB cable less than 5 m in length.  
recognized  
• Check that the USB cable is inserted fully.  
• Check that the USB device is powered on.  
• Try switching this recorder into standby mode and then back on.  
• Try using the Restart USB Device option from the Initial Setup  
menu (page 140).  
• If several USB devices (camera, USB memory, card reader, etc.) are  
connected at the same time, it’s possible that only the first device  
connected to this recorder will be recognized.  
File names are not  
displayed properly.  
• Files names that do not conform to the ISO8859-1 standard may not  
display correctly on this unit.  
149  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional information  
17  
HDMI  
Problem  
Remedy  
The connected HDMI or • Try disconnecting then reconnecting the HDMI cable (while the  
DVI device does not  
display any picture  
(and the front panel  
HDMI indicator does  
not light)  
power of both components is on).  
• Try switching the power of the HDMI/DVI device off then back on.  
• Try switching off the HDMI/DVI device and this recorder. Next,  
switch on the HDMI/DVI device and leave it for around 30 seconds,  
then switch on this recorder.  
• When you connect an HDMI-compatible device make sure of the  
following:  
– The connected device’s video input is set correctly for this unit.  
– The cable you’re using is fully HDMI-compliant. Using a non-  
standard cable may result in no picture being output.  
– Don’t use several HDMI cables connected together. Use a single  
cable to connect devices together.  
When you connect a DVI-compatible device make sure of the following:  
– The connected device’s video input is set correctly for this unit.  
– The DVI terminal on the connected device is HDCP-compatible.  
– The connected device is compatible with NTSC (720 x 480i/p,  
1280 x 720p, 1920 x 1080i/p) and PAL (720 x 576i/p, 1280 x 720p, 1920 x  
1080i/p) video input.  
• If the recorder’s internal HDD is damaged or broken, there will be no  
HDMI output.  
• Not all HDCP-compatible DVI devices will work with this recorder.  
No video from the  
HDMI output  
• If you choose a setting that is incompatible with your TV you may not  
be able to see any picture at all. In this case, press OPEN/CLOSE  
while holding down the (Stop) button on the front panel to switch  
the setting (this also switches Component Video Out on page 131 to  
the default setting).  
There’s no sound from • There is no sound when using a DVI terminal.  
the connected HDMI or • Some HDMI-compatible devices do not output sound (check with  
DVI device  
the manual that came with the connected device).  
If the unit does not operate normally due to external effects such as static electricity, disconnect  
the power plug from the outlet and insert again to return to normal operating conditions.  
If the picture freezes and the front panel and remote control  
buttons stop working  
• Press (Stop) then try restarting  
STANDBY/ON  
playback.  
• Press the front panel STANDBY/ON  
button to switch the power off, then  
HDD/DVD  
COPY  
OPEN/CLOSE  
switch back on and restart playback. If  
the power fails to switch off, press and  
hold STANDBY/ON for five seconds  
until the power switches off.  
A.TV  
D.TV  
PLTV  
DivX  
COMMON INTERFACE  
STANDBY/ON  
DV IN  
USB  
STOP REC  
INPUT  
SELECT  
CH  
150  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional information  
On-screen displays  
17  
The table below shows a list of error messages that you may encounter when using the  
recorder and an explanation of their meaning.  
Message  
Explanation/Action  
• Initializing disc. Please wait a  
moment.  
When you load a blank DVD-RW or DVD+RW disc,  
the recorder automatically initializes it.  
• Incompatible region number.  
The disc loaded has an incompatible region  
number for the recorder and so will not play.  
• Cannot record any more titles.  
• No more space for file management  
data.  
The disc control data limit has been reached, or  
the maximum number of chapters and/or titles  
has been reached. Erase titles/chapters or  
combine chapters.  
• This disc cannot be recorded. Undo  
the finalization.  
The disc was finalized on a non-Pioneer DVD  
recorder. Undo the finalization in order to  
recording/editing.  
• Cannot play this disc.  
• This disc cannot be recorded.  
• Cannot read the CPRM information.  
• Could not record the information to  
the disc.  
The disc may be dirty or damaged. Take out the  
disc, clean it and retry. If the error persists, use a  
new disc. If the error appears even with a new disc,  
please ask your nearest Pioneer-authorized service  
center or your dealer to carry out repairs.  
• Cannot edit.  
• Could not initialize disc.  
• Could not complete finalization  
successfully.  
• Could not undo finalization  
successfully.  
• Could not successfully unlock the  
disc.  
• Incompatible or unreadable disc.  
The disc loaded is a playback-only disc type. This  
display may also appear if the disc is dirty or  
damaged.  
• Cannot record to a disc that is not  
CPRM compatible.  
The video source is copy-once protected. Use a VR  
mode DVD-R/-RW disc with CPRM for recording.  
• Cannot record this content using  
Video mode recording.  
• This video cannot be recorded to  
DVD+R/+RW.  
• This content is copy protected.  
The video source is copy-protected and cannot be  
recorded.  
• Incorrect CPRM information.  
The recorder could not read the CPRM  
information. The recorder may be damaged —  
please ask your nearest Pioneer-authorized service  
center or your dealer to carry out repairs.  
151  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional information  
17  
Message  
Explanation/Action  
• Repairing disc.  
• Repairing the HDD.  
During recording, the power was cut. This display  
appears when the power is restored.  
• Could not repair the disc.  
The recorder was unable to repair the disc after a  
power cut. The contents of the recording will be lost.  
• Overheating has stopped operation.  
Press DISPLAY to clear message.  
The internal temperature of the recorder has  
exceeded the operating limit. If this message  
reappears, please ask your nearest Pioneer-  
authorized service center or your dealer to carry  
out repairs.  
• HDD optimization is recommended.  
This can be done using Disc Setup.  
The HDD should be optimized (basically, HDD  
housekeeping) to maintain playback and recording  
performance.  
• Please perform HDD optimization.  
This can be done using Disc Setup.  
The HDD is in more urgent need of optimization in  
order to maintain performance.  
• The HDD has not been sufficiently  
optimized. Please optimize again.  
If this message appears repeatedly after  
optimizing the HDD it is likely that there is not  
enough free space on the HDD for optimization to  
complete properly. Please erase some titles from  
the HDD and optimize again.  
• An error occurred. Please consult the This message is displayed when information from  
service center. Note that contents on the HDD cannot be read. The HDD may be  
the HDD may be erased when servicing damaged or broken. Please ask your nearest  
Pioneer-authorized service center or your dealer to  
carry out repairs.  
this unit.  
As the HDD info cannot be properly read, no new  
recordings can be made. Reinitializing the HDD  
(page 123) may result in your being able to make  
recording again. Note that reinitializing the HDD  
will erase all recorded contents, including  
protected files.  
• The Hard Disk Drive info is incorrect.  
Use the Disc Setup menu to reinitialize.  
• This signal’s TV system is different  
from the recorder’s setting.  
The TV system (PAL, NTSC, etc.) of the current  
channel is different from the TV system settings of  
this recorder.  
• Recording failed due to a TV system  
mismatch. Press DISPLAY to clear  
message.  
The timer recording failed because the TV system  
of the channel set for recording was different from  
the setting of the recorder.  
• Playback has stopped because the TV During recording or timer recording standby, the  
system is different than the recording. TV System (PAL, NTSC, etc.) of the playback video  
changed, causing playback to stop automatically.  
152  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional information  
17  
Message  
Explanation/Action  
You are not allowed to watch this  
Conditional Access Programme.  
A CA module or smart card (obtained from your  
service provider) is required to watch the selected  
programme. Insert the supplied module or card  
into the Common Interface card slot on the front  
panel of the recorder (page 25).  
• There is no DV input or the input  
signal is unrecordable.  
No signal was detected at the DV IN jack. This may  
appear if a blank section of DV tape is playing in  
the connected camcorder.  
• No DV camcorder connected.  
The camcorder is not connected properly, or the  
camcorder is switched off.  
You cannot connect more than one  
DV camcorder at a time.  
This recorder’s DV jack supports connection to  
just one camcorder.  
• Cannot operate the DV camcorder.  
This recorder cannot operate the DV camcorder.  
Try switching off the camcorder then turn it back  
on again.  
• Could not operate the DV camcorder. This recorder was not able to operate the DV  
camcorder.  
• The DV camcorder is not set for  
The camcorder is in camera mode. Switch it to  
playback. Please select playback mode playback mode.  
on the DV camcorder.  
• The printer is not ready or is not  
connected. Please check the printer.  
This message is displayed when communication  
could not be established with the printer. See the  
Troubleshooting section if you do not know the  
cause.  
• Printing has been cancelled  
because ...  
This message is displayed when there is a printer  
error during printing. After checking the printer for  
the cause of the error, either reconnect the printer  
and start the printing job again, or select “Yes” to  
resume printing (select “No” to cancel the print  
job). See also the operating instructions that came  
with your printer for possible causes of print  
errors.  
153  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional information  
Front-panel displays  
17  
The table below shows a list of error messages that you may encounter when using the  
recorder and an explanation of their meaning.  
Message  
• E01  
Explanation/Action  
The HDD may be damaged or broken. Please ask  
your nearest Pioneer-authorized service center or  
your dealer to carry out repairs.  
• E02  
As the HDD info cannot be properly read, no new  
recordings can be made. Reinitializing the HDD  
(page 123) may result in your being able to make  
recording again. Note that reinitializing the HDD will  
erase all recorded contents, including protected files.  
Language code list  
Language (Language code letter), Language code  
Japanese (ja), 1001  
English (en), 0514  
French (fr), 0618  
German (de), 0405  
Italian (it), 0920  
Spanish (es), 0519  
Chinese (zh), 2608  
Dutch (nl), 1412  
Portuguese (pt), 1620  
Swedish (sv), 1922  
Russian (ru), 1821  
Greek (el), 0512  
Bhutani (dz), 0426  
Esperanto (eo), 0515  
Estonian (et), 0520  
Basque (eu), 0521  
Persian (fa), 0601  
Finnish (fi), 0609  
Fiji (fj), 0610  
Faroese (fo), 0615  
Frisian (fy), 0625  
Kirghiz (ky), 1125  
Latin (la), 1201  
Lingala (ln), 1214  
Laotian (lo), 1215  
Lithuanian (lt), 1220  
Latvian (lv), 1222  
Serbo-Croatian (sh), 1908  
Sinhalese (si), 1909  
Slovak (sk), 1911  
Slovenian (sl), 1912  
Samoan (sm), 1913  
Shona (sn), 1914  
Somali (so), 1915  
Albanian (sq), 1917  
Serbian (sr), 1918  
Siswati (ss), 1919  
Sesotho (st), 1920  
Sundanese (su), 1921  
Swahili (sw), 1923  
Tamil (ta), 2001  
Telugu (te), 2005  
Tajik (tg), 2007  
Thai (th), 2008  
Tigrinya (ti), 2009  
Turkmen (tk), 2011  
Tagalog (tl), 2012  
Setswana (tn), 2014  
Tonga (to), 2015  
Malagasy (mg), 1307  
Maori (mi), 1309  
Macedonian (mk), 1311  
Malayalam (ml), 1312  
Mongolian (mn), 1314  
Moldavian (mo), 1315  
Marathi (mr), 1318  
Malay (ms), 1319  
Maltese (mt), 1320  
Burmese (my), 1325  
Nauru (na), 1401  
Nepali (ne), 1405  
Occitan (oc), 1503  
Oromo (om), 1513  
Oriya (or), 1518  
Irish (ga), 0701  
Scots-Gaelic (gd), 0704  
Galician (gl), 0712  
Guarani (gn), 0714  
Gujarati (gu), 0721  
Hausa (ha), 0801  
Hindi (hi), 0809  
Croatian (hr), 0818  
Hungarian (hu), 0821  
Armenian (hy), 0825  
Interlingua (ia), 0901  
Interlingue (ie), 0905  
Inupiak (ik), 0911  
Indonesian (in), 0914  
Icelandic (is), 0919  
Hebrew (iw), 0923  
Yiddish (ji), 1009  
Javanese (jw), 1023  
Georgian (ka), 1101  
Kazakh (kk), 1111  
Greenlandic (kl), 1112  
Cambodian (km), 1113  
Kannada (kn), 1114  
Korean (ko), 1115  
Kashmiri (ks), 1119  
Kurdish (ku), 1121  
Polish (pl), 1612  
Czech (cs), 0319  
Norwegian (no), 1415  
Afar (aa), 0101  
Abkhazian (ab), 0102  
Afrikaans (af), 0106  
Amharic (am), 0113  
Arabic (ar), 0118  
Assamese (as), 0119  
Aymara (ay), 0125  
Azerbaijani (az), 0126  
Bashkir (ba), 0201  
Byelorussian (be), 0205  
Bulgarian (bg), 0207  
Bihari (bh), 0208  
Bislama (bi), 0209  
Bengali (bn), 0214  
Tibetan (bo), 0215  
Breton (br), 0218  
Catalan (ca), 0301  
Corsican (co), 0315  
Welsh (cy), 0325  
Panjabi (pa), 1601  
Pashto, Pushto (ps), 1619 Turkish (tr), 2018  
Quechua (qu), 1721  
Rhaeto-Romance (rm),  
1813  
Kirundi (rn), 1814  
Romanian (ro), 1815  
Kinyarwanda (rw), 1823  
Sanskrit (sa), 1901  
Sindhi (sd), 1904  
Sangho (sg), 1907  
Tsonga (ts), 2019  
Tatar (tt), 2020  
Twi (tw), 2023  
Ukrainian (uk), 2111  
Urdu (ur), 2118  
Uzbek (uz), 2126  
Vietnamese (vi), 2209  
Volapük (vo), 2215  
Wolof (wo), 2315  
Xhosa (xh), 2408  
Yoruba (yo), 2515  
Zulu (zu), 2621  
Danish (da), 0401  
154  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional information  
17  
Country/Area code list  
Country/Area, Country/Area code, Code letter  
Argentina, 0118, ar  
Australia, 0121, au  
Austria, 0120, at  
Belgium, 0205, be  
Brazil, 0218, br  
Canada, 0301, ca  
Chile, 0312, cl  
Finland, 0609, fi  
France, 0618, fr  
Germany, 0405, de  
Hong Kong, 0811, hk  
India, 0914, in  
Indonesia, 0904, id  
Italy, 0920, it  
Japan, 1016, jp  
Malaysia, 1325, my  
Mexico, 1324, mx  
Netherlands, 1412, nl  
New Zealand, 1426, nz  
Norway, 1415, no  
Pakistan, 1611, pk  
Philippines, 1608, ph  
Portugal, 1620, pt  
Singapore, 1907, sg  
Spain, 0519, es  
Sweden, 1905, se  
Switzerland, 0308, ch  
Taiwan, 2023, tw  
Thailand, 2008, th  
United Kingdom, 0702, gb  
USA, 2119, us  
China, 0314, cn  
Denmark, 0411, dk  
Korea, Republic of, 1118, kr  
Russian Federation, 1821, ru  
Screen sizes and disc formats  
When viewing on a standard TV or monitor  
Screen format of disc Setting  
Appearance  
16:9  
4:3 (Letter Box)  
4:3 (Pan & Scan)  
The programme is shown in widescreen with  
black bars at the top and bottom of the  
screen.  
The sides of the programme are cropped so  
that the picture fills the whole screen.  
4:3  
4:3 (Letter Box)  
4:3 (Pan & Scan)  
The programme is presented correctly on  
either setting.  
When viewing on a widescreen TV or monitor  
Screen format of disc Setting  
Appearance  
16:9  
16:9  
The programme is presented in widescreen.  
4:3  
16:9  
Your TV will determine how the picture is  
presented — check the manual that came  
with the TV for details.  
155  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional information  
Handling discs  
17  
For more detailed care information see the  
instructions that come with discs.  
When holding discs of any type, take care  
not to leave fingerprints, dirt or scratches on  
the disc surface. Hold the disc by its edge or  
by the center hole and edge.  
Do not load more than one disc into the  
recorder.  
Damaged discs  
Damaged or dirty discs can affect playback  
and recording performance. Take care also  
not to scratch the label side of the disc.  
Although not as fragile as the recorded side,  
scratches can still result in a disc becoming  
unusable.  
Discs spin at high speed inside the recorder.  
If you can see that a disc is cracked,  
chipped, warped, or otherwise damaged,  
don’t risk using it; you could end up  
damaging the recorder.  
This recorder is designed for use with  
conventional, fully circular discs only. Use of  
shaped discs is not recommended for this  
product. Pioneer disclaims all liability  
arising in connection with the use of shaped  
discs.  
Should a disc become marked with  
fingerprints, dust, etc., clean using a soft,  
dry cloth, wiping the disc lightly from the  
center to the outside edge. Do not wipe with  
a circular motion.  
If necessary, use a cloth soaked in alcohol,  
or a commercially available CD/DVD  
cleaning kit to clean a disc more thoroughly.  
Never use benzine, thinner or other cleaning  
agents, including products designed for  
cleaning vinyl records.  
Cleaning the pickup lens  
The HDD/DVD recorder’s lens should not  
become dirty in normal use, but if for some  
reason it should malfunction due to dust or  
dirt, consult your nearest Pioneer-authorized  
service center. Although lens cleaners are  
commercially available, we do not  
Storing discs  
Although CDs and DVD discs are more  
durable than vinyl records, you should still  
take care to handle and store discs correctly.  
When you’re not using a disc, return it to its  
case and store upright. Avoid leaving discs  
in excessively cold, humid, or hot  
environments (including under direct  
sunlight).  
recommend using them since some may  
damage the lens.  
Don’t glue paper or put stickers onto the  
disc, or use a pencil, ball-point pen or other  
sharp-tipped writing instrument. These  
could all damage the disc.  
Condensation  
Condensation may form inside the recorder  
if it is brought into a warm room from  
outside, or if the temperature of the room  
rises quickly. Although the condensation  
won’t damage the recorder, it may  
temporarily impair its performance. For this  
reason you should leave it to adjust to the  
warmer temperature for about an hour  
before switching on and using.  
156  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional information  
Hints on installation  
17  
Moving the recorder  
We want you to enjoy using this unit for  
years to come, so please bear in mind the  
following points when choosing a suitable  
location for it:  
If you need to move the recorder, first  
remove the disc, if loaded, and close the disc  
tray. Next, press STANDBY/ON to switch  
the power to standby, checking that the  
POWER OFF indication in the display goes  
off. Wait at least two minutes. Lastly,  
disconnect the power cord. Never lift or  
move the unit during playback or recording  
— discs rotate at a high speed and may be  
damaged.  
Do...  
Use in a well-ventilated room.  
Place on a solid, flat, level surface, such  
as a table, shelf or stereo rack.  
Don’t...  
Use in a place exposed to high  
Resetting the recorder  
temperatures or humidity, including near  
radiators and other heat-generating  
appliances.  
If you need to, you can reset the recorder to  
all its factory settings.  
Place on a window sill or other place  
1
Make sure that the recorder is on.  
where the recorder will be exposed to direct  
sunlight.  
2
Using the front panel controls, press  
and hold (Stop) and press STANDBY/  
ON.  
The recorder turns off with all settings reset.  
Use in a dusty or damp environment or  
in a room where it will be exposed to  
excessive cigarette smoke.  
Place directly on top of an amplifier, or  
other component in your stereo system that  
becomes hot in use.  
Use near a television or monitor as you  
may experience interference — especially if  
the television uses an indoor antenna.  
Use in a kitchen or other room where the  
recorder may be exposed to smoke or steam.  
Use on a thick rug or carpet, or cover  
with cloth — this may prevent proper cooling  
of the unit.  
Place on an unstable surface, or one that  
is not large enough to support all four of the  
unit’s feet.  
157  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional information  
Specifications  
17  
DVD-R DL/DVD+R DL  
Fine (XP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 1 h 51 m  
Standard Play (SP). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 3 h 35 m  
Long Play (LP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 7 h 11 m  
Extended Play (EP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 10 h 46 m  
Super Long Play (SLP). . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 14 h 21 m  
Super Extended Play (SEP). . . . . . . Approx. 17 h 57 m  
(DVD-R DL only)  
Manual Mode (MN)  
DVD-R DL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 1 h 51 m to 24 h  
DVD+R DL . . . . . . . . Approx. 1 h 51 m to 14 h 21 m  
General  
Power requirements . . . . . 220 V to 240 V, 50 Hz/60 Hz  
Power consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .58 W  
Power consumption in standby mode . . . . . . . 0.69 W  
(Front panel display: off)  
Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.8 kg  
Dimensions  
. . . . . . . . . . . .420 mm (W) x 77 mm (H) x 288 mm (D)  
Operating temperature. . . . . . . . . . . . +5 °C to +35 °C  
Operating humidity  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 % to 85 % (no condensation)  
TV system. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .NTSC (external input only)  
/PAL/SECAM  
Timer  
Programmes . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 month/32 programmes  
Clock . . . . . . . . . . Quartz lock (24-hour digital display)  
Tuner (analog)  
Readable discs  
Receivable channels  
DVD-Video, DVD-RW, DVD-R, DVD+R, DVD+RW,  
DVD-RAM, Video CD, Super VCD, CD, CD-R/-RW  
(WMA, MP3, JPEG, CD-DA, DivX)  
SECAM B/G  
PAL I  
Frequency  
PAL B/G  
Frequency  
Channel  
Channel  
VHF (low)  
VHF (high)  
47 MHz to 89 MHz  
E2 to E4  
X to Z  
44 MHz to 89 MHz  
A to C  
X to Z  
Recording discs and formats  
DVD-R/-RW: VR mode and Video mode  
DVD+R/+RW: +VR mode  
104 MHz to 300 MHz E5 to E12  
S1 to S20  
104 MHz to 300 MHz  
D to J  
11, 13  
S1 to S20  
M1 to M10  
U1 to U10  
DVD-RAM: VR mode  
DVD-R DL: VR mode and Video mode  
DVD+R DL: +VR mode  
Hyper  
UHF  
302 MHz to 470 MHz S21 to S41 302 MHz to 470 MHz S21 to S41  
470 MHz to 862 MHz E21 to E69 470 MHz to 862 MHz E21 to E69  
SECAM D/K  
SECAM L  
PAL D/K  
Channel  
Frequency  
Frequency  
49 MHz to 94 MHz  
Channel  
FB, FC1, FC  
VHF (low)  
VHF (high)  
49 MHz to 65 MHz  
R1 to R5  
Video recording format  
Sampling frequency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.5 MHz  
Compression format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .MPEG  
F1 to F6  
B to Q  
104 MHz to 300 MHz  
104 MHz to 300 MHz R6 to R12  
S1 to S20  
STEREO  
B/G - A2  
I - NICAM  
L - NICAM  
B/G - NICAM  
D/K - NICAM  
Hyper  
UHF  
300 MHz to 470 MHz  
470 MHz to 862 MHz  
302 MHz to 470 MHz S21 to S41  
470 MHz to 862 MHz E21 to E69  
S21 to S41  
21 to 69  
Audio recording format  
Sampling frequency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 kHz  
Compression format . . . . Dolby Digital or Linear PCM  
(uncompressed)  
Tuner (digital)  
Receiving system. . . . . . . . . . DVB-T (2 K/8 K COFDM)  
Tuner VHF/UHF  
Recording time  
HDD (250 GB)  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . VHF band III (174 MHz to 230 MHz)  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . UHF band IV, V (470 MHz to 862 MHz)  
Auto Channel Preset . . . . . . . . . . 999 ch, Auto Preset,  
Auto Label, Auto Sort  
Audio. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Stereo MPEG layer I/II  
Audio Decoder  
XP+ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 36 h  
Fine (XP). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 53 h  
Standard Play (SP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 106 h  
Long Play (LP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 212 h  
Extended Play (EP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 319 h  
Super Long Play (SLP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 425 h  
Super Extended Play (SEP) . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 532 h  
Manual Mode (MN). . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 36 h to 711 h  
. . . . . Sampling frequencies: 32 kHz, 44.1 kHz, 48 kHz  
This product’s digital tuner has been confirmed for use  
in the following countries: Belgium, France, Germany,  
Italy, Spain, Denmark, Finland, Netherlands, Sweden,  
Switzerland, UK.  
DVD-R/-RW, DVD+R/+RW, DVD-RAM  
Fine (XP). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 1 h  
Standard Play (SP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 2 h  
Long Play (LP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 4 h  
Extended Play (EP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 6 h  
Super Long Play (SLP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 8 h  
Super Extended Play (SEP) . . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 10 h  
(DVD-R/-RW, DVD-RAM only)  
Manual Mode (MN)  
DVD-R/-RW/-RAM . . . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 1 h to 13 h  
DVD+R/+RW. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Approx. 1 h to 8 h  
158  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional information  
17  
AV Connectors (21-pin connector assignment)  
AV connector input/output . . . . . . . . 21-pin connector  
This connector provides the video and audio signals  
for connection to a compatible colour TV or monitor.  
Input/Output  
Antenna  
. . . . 75  
IEC 169-2 connector for VHF/UHF in/out (analog)  
IEC 169-2 connector for VHF/UHF in/out (digital)  
. . . . 75  
Video input. . . . . . . . . . . .AV2 (Input 1), Input 2 (front),  
Input 3 (rear)  
Input level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 Vp-p (75 )  
Jacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AV connector (Input 1),  
RCA jack (Input 2, Input 3)  
Video output. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .AV1, Output  
Output level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 Vp-p (75 )  
Jacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .AV connector (AV1),  
RCA jack (Output)  
S-Video input . . . . . . . . . .AV2 (Input 1), Input 2 (front),  
Input 3 (rear)  
Y (luminance) - Input level. . . . . . . . . . . 1 Vp-p (75 )  
C (colour) - Input level . . . . . . . . . . 300 mVp-p (75 )  
Jacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AV connector (Input 1),  
4 pin mini DIN (Input 2, Input 3)  
S-Video output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .AV1, Output  
Y (luminance) - Output level . . . . . . . . . 1 Vp-p (75 )  
C (colour) - Output level. . . . . . . . . 300 mVp-p (75 )  
Jacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .AV connector (AV1),  
4 pin mini DIN (Output)  
PIN no.  
AV1 (RGB)-TV / AV2 (INPUT 1/DECODER)  
1. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .Audio 2/R out / Audio 2/R out  
2. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . – / Audio 2/R in  
11 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . G out / G in  
3. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Audio 1/L out / Audio 1/L out  
6. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . – / Audio 1/L in  
15 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . R or C out / R or C in  
4. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .GND  
17. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .GND  
7 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B out / B in  
19. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Video out or Y out / Video out  
20. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . – / Video in or Y in  
8. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Status  
21. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .GND  
Component video output  
Output level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Y: 1.0 Vp-p (75 )  
PB, PR: 0.7 Vp-p (75 )  
Supplied accessories  
Remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1  
Dry cell batteries (AA/R6P). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2  
Audio/Video cable (red/white/yellow) . . . . . . . . . . . . .1  
G-LINK™ cable. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1  
RF antenna cable. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2  
Power cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1  
Operating Instructions  
Jacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RCA jacks  
RGB input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AV2 (Input 1)  
Input level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.7 Vp-p (75 )  
Jacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .AV connector (Input 1)  
RGB output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .AV1  
Output level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.7 Vp-p (75 )  
Jacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AV connector (AV1)  
Audio input . . . . . . . . . . .AV2 (Input 1), Input 2 (front),  
Input 3 (rear) L/R  
Warranty card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1  
Note: The specifications and design of this product are  
subject to change without notice, due to improvement.  
During audio input. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 V rms  
(Input impedance: more than 22 k)  
Jacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AV connector (Input 1),  
RCA jacks (Input 2)  
Audio output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .AV1, Output  
During audio output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 V rms  
(Output impedance: less than 1.5 k)  
®
This product includes FontAvenue fonts licenced  
by NEC Corporation. FontAvenue is a registered  
trademark of NEC Corporation.  
Jacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .AV connector (AV1),  
RCA jacks (Output)  
Microsoft product screen shots reprinted with  
permission from Microsoft Corporation.  
Control input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mini jack  
Digital audio output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .Coaxial  
G-LINK™. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mini jack  
Common Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CA module  
DV input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 pin (front)  
(i.LINK/IEEE 1394 standard)  
USB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Type A (front), Type B (front)  
HDMI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19 pin  
159  
En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
http://www.pioneer.co.uk  
http://www.pioneer.eu  
Published by Pioneer Corporation.  
Copyright © 2007 Pioneer Corporation.  
All rights reserved.  
PIONEER CORPORATION  
4-1, Meguro 1-Chome, Meguro-ku, Tokyo 153-8654, Japan  
PIONEER ELECTRONICS (USA) INC.  
P.O. BOX 1540, Long Beach, California 90801-1540, U.S.A. TEL: (800) 421-1404  
PIONEER ELECTRONICS OF CANADA, INC.  
300 Allstate Parkway, Markham, Ontario L3R 0P2, Canada TEL: 1-877-283-5901, 905-479-4411  
PIONEER EUROPE NV  
Haven 1087, Keetberglaan 1, B-9120 Melsele, Belgium TEL: 03/570.05.11  
PIONEER ELECTRONICS ASIACENTRE PTE. LTD.  
253 Alexandra Road, #04-01, Singapore 159936 TEL: 65-6472-7555  
PIONEER ELECTRONICS AUSTRALIA PTY. LTD.  
178-184 Boundary Road, Braeside, Victoria 3195, Australia, TEL: (03) 9586-6300  
PIONEER ELECTRONICS DE MEXICO S.A. DE C.V.  
Blvd.Manuel Avila Camacho 138 10 piso Col.Lomas de Chapultepec, Mexico,D.F. 11000 TEL: 55-9178-4270  
K002_B_En  
Printed in UK  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
<VRB1459-A>  

Peavey Music Mixer SRM Series User Manual
Pelco Power Supply DAS5200 User Manual
Philips DVD Player MDV460 User Manual
Philips Home Theater System HK 0947 NP2500 FR User Manual
Philips Speaker System FW 358C User Manual
Philips Surge Protector SPP2304WC User Manual
Pioneer Indoor Furnishings PDK FS05 User Manual
Planar Car Video System PT1501MX User Manual
Poulan Blower 530164260 User Manual
Poulan Trimmer GHT225LE User Manual